Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF)                  R. Fielding, Ed.
Request for Comments: 9110                                         Adobe
STD: 97                                               M. Nottingham, Ed.
Obsoletes: 2818, 7230, 7231, 7232, 7233, 7235,                    Fastly
          7538, 7615, 7694                              J. Reschke, Ed.
Updates: 3864                                                 greenbytes
Category: Standards Track                                      June 2022
ISSN: 2070-1721


                            HTTP Semantics

Abstract

  The Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) is a stateless application-
  level protocol for distributed, collaborative, hypertext information
  systems.  This document describes the overall architecture of HTTP,
  establishes common terminology, and defines aspects of the protocol
  that are shared by all versions.  In this definition are core
  protocol elements, extensibility mechanisms, and the "http" and
  "https" Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) schemes.

  This document updates RFC 3864 and obsoletes RFCs 2818, 7231, 7232,
  7233, 7235, 7538, 7615, 7694, and portions of 7230.

Status of This Memo

  This is an Internet Standards Track document.

  This document is a product of the Internet Engineering Task Force
  (IETF).  It represents the consensus of the IETF community.  It has
  received public review and has been approved for publication by the
  Internet Engineering Steering Group (IESG).  Further information on
  Internet Standards is available in Section 2 of RFC 7841.

  Information about the current status of this document, any errata,
  and how to provide feedback on it may be obtained at
  https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc9110.

Copyright Notice

  Copyright (c) 2022 IETF Trust and the persons identified as the
  document authors.  All rights reserved.

  This document is subject to BCP 78 and the IETF Trust's Legal
  Provisions Relating to IETF Documents
  (https://trustee.ietf.org/license-info) in effect on the date of
  publication of this document.  Please review these documents
  carefully, as they describe your rights and restrictions with respect
  to this document.  Code Components extracted from this document must
  include Revised BSD License text as described in Section 4.e of the
  Trust Legal Provisions and are provided without warranty as described
  in the Revised BSD License.

  This document may contain material from IETF Documents or IETF
  Contributions published or made publicly available before November
  10, 2008.  The person(s) controlling the copyright in some of this
  material may not have granted the IETF Trust the right to allow
  modifications of such material outside the IETF Standards Process.
  Without obtaining an adequate license from the person(s) controlling
  the copyright in such materials, this document may not be modified
  outside the IETF Standards Process, and derivative works of it may
  not be created outside the IETF Standards Process, except to format
  it for publication as an RFC or to translate it into languages other
  than English.

Table of Contents

  1.  Introduction
    1.1.  Purpose
    1.2.  History and Evolution
    1.3.  Core Semantics
    1.4.  Specifications Obsoleted by This Document
  2.  Conformance
    2.1.  Syntax Notation
    2.2.  Requirements Notation
    2.3.  Length Requirements
    2.4.  Error Handling
    2.5.  Protocol Version
  3.  Terminology and Core Concepts
    3.1.  Resources
    3.2.  Representations
    3.3.  Connections, Clients, and Servers
    3.4.  Messages
    3.5.  User Agents
    3.6.  Origin Server
    3.7.  Intermediaries
    3.8.  Caches
    3.9.  Example Message Exchange
  4.  Identifiers in HTTP
    4.1.  URI References
    4.2.  HTTP-Related URI Schemes
      4.2.1.  http URI Scheme
      4.2.2.  https URI Scheme
      4.2.3.  http(s) Normalization and Comparison
      4.2.4.  Deprecation of userinfo in http(s) URIs
      4.2.5.  http(s) References with Fragment Identifiers
    4.3.  Authoritative Access
      4.3.1.  URI Origin
      4.3.2.  http Origins
      4.3.3.  https Origins
      4.3.4.  https Certificate Verification
      4.3.5.  IP-ID Reference Identity
  5.  Fields
    5.1.  Field Names
    5.2.  Field Lines and Combined Field Value
    5.3.  Field Order
    5.4.  Field Limits
    5.5.  Field Values
    5.6.  Common Rules for Defining Field Values
      5.6.1.  Lists (#rule ABNF Extension)
        5.6.1.1.  Sender Requirements
        5.6.1.2.  Recipient Requirements
      5.6.2.  Tokens
      5.6.3.  Whitespace
      5.6.4.  Quoted Strings
      5.6.5.  Comments
      5.6.6.  Parameters
      5.6.7.  Date/Time Formats
  6.  Message Abstraction
    6.1.  Framing and Completeness
    6.2.  Control Data
    6.3.  Header Fields
    6.4.  Content
      6.4.1.  Content Semantics
      6.4.2.  Identifying Content
    6.5.  Trailer Fields
      6.5.1.  Limitations on Use of Trailers
      6.5.2.  Processing Trailer Fields
    6.6.  Message Metadata
      6.6.1.  Date
      6.6.2.  Trailer
  7.  Routing HTTP Messages
    7.1.  Determining the Target Resource
    7.2.  Host and :authority
    7.3.  Routing Inbound Requests
      7.3.1.  To a Cache
      7.3.2.  To a Proxy
      7.3.3.  To the Origin
    7.4.  Rejecting Misdirected Requests
    7.5.  Response Correlation
    7.6.  Message Forwarding
      7.6.1.  Connection
      7.6.2.  Max-Forwards
      7.6.3.  Via
    7.7.  Message Transformations
    7.8.  Upgrade
  8.  Representation Data and Metadata
    8.1.  Representation Data
    8.2.  Representation Metadata
    8.3.  Content-Type
      8.3.1.  Media Type
      8.3.2.  Charset
      8.3.3.  Multipart Types
    8.4.  Content-Encoding
      8.4.1.  Content Codings
        8.4.1.1.  Compress Coding
        8.4.1.2.  Deflate Coding
        8.4.1.3.  Gzip Coding
    8.5.  Content-Language
      8.5.1.  Language Tags
    8.6.  Content-Length
    8.7.  Content-Location
    8.8.  Validator Fields
      8.8.1.  Weak versus Strong
      8.8.2.  Last-Modified
        8.8.2.1.  Generation
        8.8.2.2.  Comparison
      8.8.3.  ETag
        8.8.3.1.  Generation
        8.8.3.2.  Comparison
        8.8.3.3.  Example: Entity Tags Varying on Content-Negotiated
                Resources
  9.  Methods
    9.1.  Overview
    9.2.  Common Method Properties
      9.2.1.  Safe Methods
      9.2.2.  Idempotent Methods
      9.2.3.  Methods and Caching
    9.3.  Method Definitions
      9.3.1.  GET
      9.3.2.  HEAD
      9.3.3.  POST
      9.3.4.  PUT
      9.3.5.  DELETE
      9.3.6.  CONNECT
      9.3.7.  OPTIONS
      9.3.8.  TRACE
  10. Message Context
    10.1.  Request Context Fields
      10.1.1.  Expect
      10.1.2.  From
      10.1.3.  Referer
      10.1.4.  TE
      10.1.5.  User-Agent
    10.2.  Response Context Fields
      10.2.1.  Allow
      10.2.2.  Location
      10.2.3.  Retry-After
      10.2.4.  Server
  11. HTTP Authentication
    11.1.  Authentication Scheme
    11.2.  Authentication Parameters
    11.3.  Challenge and Response
    11.4.  Credentials
    11.5.  Establishing a Protection Space (Realm)
    11.6.  Authenticating Users to Origin Servers
      11.6.1.  WWW-Authenticate
      11.6.2.  Authorization
      11.6.3.  Authentication-Info
    11.7.  Authenticating Clients to Proxies
      11.7.1.  Proxy-Authenticate
      11.7.2.  Proxy-Authorization
      11.7.3.  Proxy-Authentication-Info
  12. Content Negotiation
    12.1.  Proactive Negotiation
    12.2.  Reactive Negotiation
    12.3.  Request Content Negotiation
    12.4.  Content Negotiation Field Features
      12.4.1.  Absence
      12.4.2.  Quality Values
      12.4.3.  Wildcard Values
    12.5.  Content Negotiation Fields
      12.5.1.  Accept
      12.5.2.  Accept-Charset
      12.5.3.  Accept-Encoding
      12.5.4.  Accept-Language
      12.5.5.  Vary
  13. Conditional Requests
    13.1.  Preconditions
      13.1.1.  If-Match
      13.1.2.  If-None-Match
      13.1.3.  If-Modified-Since
      13.1.4.  If-Unmodified-Since
      13.1.5.  If-Range
    13.2.  Evaluation of Preconditions
      13.2.1.  When to Evaluate
      13.2.2.  Precedence of Preconditions
  14. Range Requests
    14.1.  Range Units
      14.1.1.  Range Specifiers
      14.1.2.  Byte Ranges
    14.2.  Range
    14.3.  Accept-Ranges
    14.4.  Content-Range
    14.5.  Partial PUT
    14.6.  Media Type multipart/byteranges
  15. Status Codes
    15.1.  Overview of Status Codes
    15.2.  Informational 1xx
      15.2.1.  100 Continue
      15.2.2.  101 Switching Protocols
    15.3.  Successful 2xx
      15.3.1.  200 OK
      15.3.2.  201 Created
      15.3.3.  202 Accepted
      15.3.4.  203 Non-Authoritative Information
      15.3.5.  204 No Content
      15.3.6.  205 Reset Content
      15.3.7.  206 Partial Content
        15.3.7.1.  Single Part
        15.3.7.2.  Multiple Parts
        15.3.7.3.  Combining Parts
    15.4.  Redirection 3xx
      15.4.1.  300 Multiple Choices
      15.4.2.  301 Moved Permanently
      15.4.3.  302 Found
      15.4.4.  303 See Other
      15.4.5.  304 Not Modified
      15.4.6.  305 Use Proxy
      15.4.7.  306 (Unused)
      15.4.8.  307 Temporary Redirect
      15.4.9.  308 Permanent Redirect
    15.5.  Client Error 4xx
      15.5.1.  400 Bad Request
      15.5.2.  401 Unauthorized
      15.5.3.  402 Payment Required
      15.5.4.  403 Forbidden
      15.5.5.  404 Not Found
      15.5.6.  405 Method Not Allowed
      15.5.7.  406 Not Acceptable
      15.5.8.  407 Proxy Authentication Required
      15.5.9.  408 Request Timeout
      15.5.10. 409 Conflict
      15.5.11. 410 Gone
      15.5.12. 411 Length Required
      15.5.13. 412 Precondition Failed
      15.5.14. 413 Content Too Large
      15.5.15. 414 URI Too Long
      15.5.16. 415 Unsupported Media Type
      15.5.17. 416 Range Not Satisfiable
      15.5.18. 417 Expectation Failed
      15.5.19. 418 (Unused)
      15.5.20. 421 Misdirected Request
      15.5.21. 422 Unprocessable Content
      15.5.22. 426 Upgrade Required
    15.6.  Server Error 5xx
      15.6.1.  500 Internal Server Error
      15.6.2.  501 Not Implemented
      15.6.3.  502 Bad Gateway
      15.6.4.  503 Service Unavailable
      15.6.5.  504 Gateway Timeout
      15.6.6.  505 HTTP Version Not Supported
  16. Extending HTTP
    16.1.  Method Extensibility
      16.1.1.  Method Registry
      16.1.2.  Considerations for New Methods
    16.2.  Status Code Extensibility
      16.2.1.  Status Code Registry
      16.2.2.  Considerations for New Status Codes
    16.3.  Field Extensibility
      16.3.1.  Field Name Registry
      16.3.2.  Considerations for New Fields
        16.3.2.1.  Considerations for New Field Names
        16.3.2.2.  Considerations for New Field Values
    16.4.  Authentication Scheme Extensibility
      16.4.1.  Authentication Scheme Registry
      16.4.2.  Considerations for New Authentication Schemes
    16.5.  Range Unit Extensibility
      16.5.1.  Range Unit Registry
      16.5.2.  Considerations for New Range Units
    16.6.  Content Coding Extensibility
      16.6.1.  Content Coding Registry
      16.6.2.  Considerations for New Content Codings
    16.7.  Upgrade Token Registry
  17. Security Considerations
    17.1.  Establishing Authority
    17.2.  Risks of Intermediaries
    17.3.  Attacks Based on File and Path Names
    17.4.  Attacks Based on Command, Code, or Query Injection
    17.5.  Attacks via Protocol Element Length
    17.6.  Attacks Using Shared-Dictionary Compression
    17.7.  Disclosure of Personal Information
    17.8.  Privacy of Server Log Information
    17.9.  Disclosure of Sensitive Information in URIs
    17.10. Application Handling of Field Names
    17.11. Disclosure of Fragment after Redirects
    17.12. Disclosure of Product Information
    17.13. Browser Fingerprinting
    17.14. Validator Retention
    17.15. Denial-of-Service Attacks Using Range
    17.16. Authentication Considerations
      17.16.1.  Confidentiality of Credentials
      17.16.2.  Credentials and Idle Clients
      17.16.3.  Protection Spaces
      17.16.4.  Additional Response Fields
  18. IANA Considerations
    18.1.  URI Scheme Registration
    18.2.  Method Registration
    18.3.  Status Code Registration
    18.4.  Field Name Registration
    18.5.  Authentication Scheme Registration
    18.6.  Content Coding Registration
    18.7.  Range Unit Registration
    18.8.  Media Type Registration
    18.9.  Port Registration
    18.10. Upgrade Token Registration
  19. References
    19.1.  Normative References
    19.2.  Informative References
  Appendix A.  Collected ABNF
  Appendix B.  Changes from Previous RFCs
    B.1.  Changes from RFC 2818
    B.2.  Changes from RFC 7230
    B.3.  Changes from RFC 7231
    B.4.  Changes from RFC 7232
    B.5.  Changes from RFC 7233
    B.6.  Changes from RFC 7235
    B.7.  Changes from RFC 7538
    B.8.  Changes from RFC 7615
    B.9.  Changes from RFC 7694
  Acknowledgements
  Index
  Authors' Addresses

1.  Introduction

1.1.  Purpose

  The Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) is a family of stateless,
  application-level, request/response protocols that share a generic
  interface, extensible semantics, and self-descriptive messages to
  enable flexible interaction with network-based hypertext information
  systems.

  HTTP hides the details of how a service is implemented by presenting
  a uniform interface to clients that is independent of the types of
  resources provided.  Likewise, servers do not need to be aware of
  each client's purpose: a request can be considered in isolation
  rather than being associated with a specific type of client or a
  predetermined sequence of application steps.  This allows general-
  purpose implementations to be used effectively in many different
  contexts, reduces interaction complexity, and enables independent
  evolution over time.

  HTTP is also designed for use as an intermediation protocol, wherein
  proxies and gateways can translate non-HTTP information systems into
  a more generic interface.

  One consequence of this flexibility is that the protocol cannot be
  defined in terms of what occurs behind the interface.  Instead, we
  are limited to defining the syntax of communication, the intent of
  received communication, and the expected behavior of recipients.  If
  the communication is considered in isolation, then successful actions
  ought to be reflected in corresponding changes to the observable
  interface provided by servers.  However, since multiple clients might
  act in parallel and perhaps at cross-purposes, we cannot require that
  such changes be observable beyond the scope of a single response.

1.2.  History and Evolution

  HTTP has been the primary information transfer protocol for the World
  Wide Web since its introduction in 1990.  It began as a trivial
  mechanism for low-latency requests, with a single method (GET) to
  request transfer of a presumed hypertext document identified by a
  given pathname.  As the Web grew, HTTP was extended to enclose
  requests and responses within messages, transfer arbitrary data
  formats using MIME-like media types, and route requests through
  intermediaries.  These protocols were eventually defined as HTTP/0.9
  and HTTP/1.0 (see [HTTP/1.0]).

  HTTP/1.1 was designed to refine the protocol's features while
  retaining compatibility with the existing text-based messaging
  syntax, improving its interoperability, scalability, and robustness
  across the Internet.  This included length-based data delimiters for
  both fixed and dynamic (chunked) content, a consistent framework for
  content negotiation, opaque validators for conditional requests,
  cache controls for better cache consistency, range requests for
  partial updates, and default persistent connections.  HTTP/1.1 was
  introduced in 1995 and published on the Standards Track in 1997
  [RFC2068], revised in 1999 [RFC2616], and revised again in 2014
  ([RFC7230] through [RFC7235]).

  HTTP/2 ([HTTP/2]) introduced a multiplexed session layer on top of
  the existing TLS and TCP protocols for exchanging concurrent HTTP
  messages with efficient field compression and server push.  HTTP/3
  ([HTTP/3]) provides greater independence for concurrent messages by
  using QUIC as a secure multiplexed transport over UDP instead of TCP.

  All three major versions of HTTP rely on the semantics defined by
  this document.  They have not obsoleted each other because each one
  has specific benefits and limitations depending on the context of
  use.  Implementations are expected to choose the most appropriate
  transport and messaging syntax for their particular context.

  This revision of HTTP separates the definition of semantics (this
  document) and caching ([CACHING]) from the current HTTP/1.1 messaging
  syntax ([HTTP/1.1]) to allow each major protocol version to progress
  independently while referring to the same core semantics.

1.3.  Core Semantics

  HTTP provides a uniform interface for interacting with a resource
  (Section 3.1) -- regardless of its type, nature, or implementation --
  by sending messages that manipulate or transfer representations
  (Section 3.2).

  Each message is either a request or a response.  A client constructs
  request messages that communicate its intentions and routes those
  messages toward an identified origin server.  A server listens for
  requests, parses each message received, interprets the message
  semantics in relation to the identified target resource, and responds
  to that request with one or more response messages.  The client
  examines received responses to see if its intentions were carried
  out, determining what to do next based on the status codes and
  content received.

  HTTP semantics include the intentions defined by each request method
  (Section 9), extensions to those semantics that might be described in
  request header fields, status codes that describe the response
  (Section 15), and other control data and resource metadata that might
  be given in response fields.

  Semantics also include representation metadata that describe how
  content is intended to be interpreted by a recipient, request header
  fields that might influence content selection, and the various
  selection algorithms that are collectively referred to as "content
  negotiation" (Section 12).

1.4.  Specifications Obsoleted by This Document

  +============================================+===========+=====+
  | Title                                      | Reference | See |
  +============================================+===========+=====+
  | HTTP Over TLS                              | [RFC2818] | B.1 |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+
  | HTTP/1.1 Message Syntax and Routing [*]    | [RFC7230] | B.2 |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+
  | HTTP/1.1 Semantics and Content             | [RFC7231] | B.3 |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+
  | HTTP/1.1 Conditional Requests              | [RFC7232] | B.4 |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+
  | HTTP/1.1 Range Requests                    | [RFC7233] | B.5 |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+
  | HTTP/1.1 Authentication                    | [RFC7235] | B.6 |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+
  | HTTP Status Code 308 (Permanent Redirect)  | [RFC7538] | B.7 |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+
  | HTTP Authentication-Info and Proxy-        | [RFC7615] | B.8 |
  | Authentication-Info Response Header Fields |           |     |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+
  | HTTP Client-Initiated Content-Encoding     | [RFC7694] | B.9 |
  +--------------------------------------------+-----------+-----+

                              Table 1

  [*] This document only obsoletes the portions of RFC 7230 that are
  independent of the HTTP/1.1 messaging syntax and connection
  management; the remaining bits of RFC 7230 are obsoleted by
  "HTTP/1.1" [HTTP/1.1].

2.  Conformance

2.1.  Syntax Notation

  This specification uses the Augmented Backus-Naur Form (ABNF)
  notation of [RFC5234], extended with the notation for case-
  sensitivity in strings defined in [RFC7405].

  It also uses a list extension, defined in Section 5.6.1, that allows
  for compact definition of comma-separated lists using a "#" operator
  (similar to how the "*" operator indicates repetition).  Appendix A
  shows the collected grammar with all list operators expanded to
  standard ABNF notation.

  As a convention, ABNF rule names prefixed with "obs-" denote obsolete
  grammar rules that appear for historical reasons.

  The following core rules are included by reference, as defined in
  Appendix B.1 of [RFC5234]: ALPHA (letters), CR (carriage return),
  CRLF (CR LF), CTL (controls), DIGIT (decimal 0-9), DQUOTE (double
  quote), HEXDIG (hexadecimal 0-9/A-F/a-f), HTAB (horizontal tab), LF
  (line feed), OCTET (any 8-bit sequence of data), SP (space), and
  VCHAR (any visible US-ASCII character).

  Section 5.6 defines some generic syntactic components for field
  values.

  This specification uses the terms "character", "character encoding
  scheme", "charset", and "protocol element" as they are defined in
  [RFC6365].

2.2.  Requirements Notation

  The key words "MUST", "MUST NOT", "REQUIRED", "SHALL", "SHALL NOT",
  "SHOULD", "SHOULD NOT", "RECOMMENDED", "NOT RECOMMENDED", "MAY", and
  "OPTIONAL" in this document are to be interpreted as described in
  BCP 14 [RFC2119] [RFC8174] when, and only when, they appear in all
  capitals, as shown here.

  This specification targets conformance criteria according to the role
  of a participant in HTTP communication.  Hence, requirements are
  placed on senders, recipients, clients, servers, user agents,
  intermediaries, origin servers, proxies, gateways, or caches,
  depending on what behavior is being constrained by the requirement.
  Additional requirements are placed on implementations, resource
  owners, and protocol element registrations when they apply beyond the
  scope of a single communication.

  The verb "generate" is used instead of "send" where a requirement
  applies only to implementations that create the protocol element,
  rather than an implementation that forwards a received element
  downstream.

  An implementation is considered conformant if it complies with all of
  the requirements associated with the roles it partakes in HTTP.

  A sender MUST NOT generate protocol elements that do not match the
  grammar defined by the corresponding ABNF rules.  Within a given
  message, a sender MUST NOT generate protocol elements or syntax
  alternatives that are only allowed to be generated by participants in
  other roles (i.e., a role that the sender does not have for that
  message).

  Conformance to HTTP includes both conformance to the particular
  messaging syntax of the protocol version in use and conformance to
  the semantics of protocol elements sent.  For example, a client that
  claims conformance to HTTP/1.1 but fails to recognize the features
  required of HTTP/1.1 recipients will fail to interoperate with
  servers that adjust their responses in accordance with those claims.
  Features that reflect user choices, such as content negotiation and
  user-selected extensions, can impact application behavior beyond the
  protocol stream; sending protocol elements that inaccurately reflect
  a user's choices will confuse the user and inhibit choice.

  When an implementation fails semantic conformance, recipients of that
  implementation's messages will eventually develop workarounds to
  adjust their behavior accordingly.  A recipient MAY employ such
  workarounds while remaining conformant to this protocol if the
  workarounds are limited to the implementations at fault.  For
  example, servers often scan portions of the User-Agent field value,
  and user agents often scan the Server field value, to adjust their
  own behavior with respect to known bugs or poorly chosen defaults.

2.3.  Length Requirements

  A recipient SHOULD parse a received protocol element defensively,
  with only marginal expectations that the element will conform to its
  ABNF grammar and fit within a reasonable buffer size.

  HTTP does not have specific length limitations for many of its
  protocol elements because the lengths that might be appropriate will
  vary widely, depending on the deployment context and purpose of the
  implementation.  Hence, interoperability between senders and
  recipients depends on shared expectations regarding what is a
  reasonable length for each protocol element.  Furthermore, what is
  commonly understood to be a reasonable length for some protocol
  elements has changed over the course of the past three decades of
  HTTP use and is expected to continue changing in the future.

  At a minimum, a recipient MUST be able to parse and process protocol
  element lengths that are at least as long as the values that it
  generates for those same protocol elements in other messages.  For
  example, an origin server that publishes very long URI references to
  its own resources needs to be able to parse and process those same
  references when received as a target URI.

  Many received protocol elements are only parsed to the extent
  necessary to identify and forward that element downstream.  For
  example, an intermediary might parse a received field into its field
  name and field value components, but then forward the field without
  further parsing inside the field value.

2.4.  Error Handling

  A recipient MUST interpret a received protocol element according to
  the semantics defined for it by this specification, including
  extensions to this specification, unless the recipient has determined
  (through experience or configuration) that the sender incorrectly
  implements what is implied by those semantics.  For example, an
  origin server might disregard the contents of a received
  Accept-Encoding header field if inspection of the User-Agent header
  field indicates a specific implementation version that is known to
  fail on receipt of certain content codings.

  Unless noted otherwise, a recipient MAY attempt to recover a usable
  protocol element from an invalid construct.  HTTP does not define
  specific error handling mechanisms except when they have a direct
  impact on security, since different applications of the protocol
  require different error handling strategies.  For example, a Web
  browser might wish to transparently recover from a response where the
  Location header field doesn't parse according to the ABNF, whereas a
  systems control client might consider any form of error recovery to
  be dangerous.

  Some requests can be automatically retried by a client in the event
  of an underlying connection failure, as described in Section 9.2.2.

2.5.  Protocol Version

  HTTP's version number consists of two decimal digits separated by a
  "." (period or decimal point).  The first digit (major version)
  indicates the messaging syntax, whereas the second digit (minor
  version) indicates the highest minor version within that major
  version to which the sender is conformant (able to understand for
  future communication).

  While HTTP's core semantics don't change between protocol versions,
  their expression "on the wire" can change, and so the HTTP version
  number changes when incompatible changes are made to the wire format.
  Additionally, HTTP allows incremental, backwards-compatible changes
  to be made to the protocol without changing its version through the
  use of defined extension points (Section 16).

  The protocol version as a whole indicates the sender's conformance
  with the set of requirements laid out in that version's corresponding
  specification(s).  For example, the version "HTTP/1.1" is defined by
  the combined specifications of this document, "HTTP Caching"
  [CACHING], and "HTTP/1.1" [HTTP/1.1].

  HTTP's major version number is incremented when an incompatible
  message syntax is introduced.  The minor number is incremented when
  changes made to the protocol have the effect of adding to the message
  semantics or implying additional capabilities of the sender.

  The minor version advertises the sender's communication capabilities
  even when the sender is only using a backwards-compatible subset of
  the protocol, thereby letting the recipient know that more advanced
  features can be used in response (by servers) or in future requests
  (by clients).

  When a major version of HTTP does not define any minor versions, the
  minor version "0" is implied.  The "0" is used when referring to that
  protocol within elements that require a minor version identifier.

3.  Terminology and Core Concepts

  HTTP was created for the World Wide Web (WWW) architecture and has
  evolved over time to support the scalability needs of a worldwide
  hypertext system.  Much of that architecture is reflected in the
  terminology used to define HTTP.

3.1.  Resources

  The target of an HTTP request is called a "resource".  HTTP does not
  limit the nature of a resource; it merely defines an interface that
  might be used to interact with resources.  Most resources are
  identified by a Uniform Resource Identifier (URI), as described in
  Section 4.

  One design goal of HTTP is to separate resource identification from
  request semantics, which is made possible by vesting the request
  semantics in the request method (Section 9) and a few request-
  modifying header fields.  A resource cannot treat a request in a
  manner inconsistent with the semantics of the method of the request.
  For example, though the URI of a resource might imply semantics that
  are not safe, a client can expect the resource to avoid actions that
  are unsafe when processing a request with a safe method (see
  Section 9.2.1).

  HTTP relies upon the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) standard [URI]
  to indicate the target resource (Section 7.1) and relationships
  between resources.

3.2.  Representations

  A "representation" is information that is intended to reflect a past,
  current, or desired state of a given resource, in a format that can
  be readily communicated via the protocol.  A representation consists
  of a set of representation metadata and a potentially unbounded
  stream of representation data (Section 8).

  HTTP allows "information hiding" behind its uniform interface by
  defining communication with respect to a transferable representation
  of the resource state, rather than transferring the resource itself.
  This allows the resource identified by a URI to be anything,
  including temporal functions like "the current weather in Laguna
  Beach", while potentially providing information that represents that
  resource at the time a message is generated [REST].

  The uniform interface is similar to a window through which one can
  observe and act upon a thing only through the communication of
  messages to an independent actor on the other side.  A shared
  abstraction is needed to represent ("take the place of") the current
  or desired state of that thing in our communications.  When a
  representation is hypertext, it can provide both a representation of
  the resource state and processing instructions that help guide the
  recipient's future interactions.

  A target resource might be provided with, or be capable of
  generating, multiple representations that are each intended to
  reflect the resource's current state.  An algorithm, usually based on
  content negotiation (Section 12), would be used to select one of
  those representations as being most applicable to a given request.
  This "selected representation" provides the data and metadata for
  evaluating conditional requests (Section 13) and constructing the
  content for 200 (OK), 206 (Partial Content), and 304 (Not Modified)
  responses to GET (Section 9.3.1).

3.3.  Connections, Clients, and Servers

  HTTP is a client/server protocol that operates over a reliable
  transport- or session-layer "connection".

  An HTTP "client" is a program that establishes a connection to a
  server for the purpose of sending one or more HTTP requests.  An HTTP
  "server" is a program that accepts connections in order to service
  HTTP requests by sending HTTP responses.

  The terms client and server refer only to the roles that these
  programs perform for a particular connection.  The same program might
  act as a client on some connections and a server on others.

  HTTP is defined as a stateless protocol, meaning that each request
  message's semantics can be understood in isolation, and that the
  relationship between connections and messages on them has no impact
  on the interpretation of those messages.  For example, a CONNECT
  request (Section 9.3.6) or a request with the Upgrade header field
  (Section 7.8) can occur at any time, not just in the first message on
  a connection.  Many implementations depend on HTTP's stateless design
  in order to reuse proxied connections or dynamically load balance
  requests across multiple servers.

  As a result, a server MUST NOT assume that two requests on the same
  connection are from the same user agent unless the connection is
  secured and specific to that agent.  Some non-standard HTTP
  extensions (e.g., [RFC4559]) have been known to violate this
  requirement, resulting in security and interoperability problems.

3.4.  Messages

  HTTP is a stateless request/response protocol for exchanging
  "messages" across a connection.  The terms "sender" and "recipient"
  refer to any implementation that sends or receives a given message,
  respectively.

  A client sends requests to a server in the form of a "request"
  message with a method (Section 9) and request target (Section 7.1).
  The request might also contain header fields (Section 6.3) for
  request modifiers, client information, and representation metadata,
  content (Section 6.4) intended for processing in accordance with the
  method, and trailer fields (Section 6.5) to communicate information
  collected while sending the content.

  A server responds to a client's request by sending one or more
  "response" messages, each including a status code (Section 15).  The
  response might also contain header fields for server information,
  resource metadata, and representation metadata, content to be
  interpreted in accordance with the status code, and trailer fields to
  communicate information collected while sending the content.

3.5.  User Agents

  The term "user agent" refers to any of the various client programs
  that initiate a request.

  The most familiar form of user agent is the general-purpose Web
  browser, but that's only a small percentage of implementations.
  Other common user agents include spiders (web-traversing robots),
  command-line tools, billboard screens, household appliances, scales,
  light bulbs, firmware update scripts, mobile apps, and communication
  devices in a multitude of shapes and sizes.

  Being a user agent does not imply that there is a human user directly
  interacting with the software agent at the time of a request.  In
  many cases, a user agent is installed or configured to run in the
  background and save its results for later inspection (or save only a
  subset of those results that might be interesting or erroneous).
  Spiders, for example, are typically given a start URI and configured
  to follow certain behavior while crawling the Web as a hypertext
  graph.

  Many user agents cannot, or choose not to, make interactive
  suggestions to their user or provide adequate warning for security or
  privacy concerns.  In the few cases where this specification requires
  reporting of errors to the user, it is acceptable for such reporting
  to only be observable in an error console or log file.  Likewise,
  requirements that an automated action be confirmed by the user before
  proceeding might be met via advance configuration choices, run-time
  options, or simple avoidance of the unsafe action; confirmation does
  not imply any specific user interface or interruption of normal
  processing if the user has already made that choice.

3.6.  Origin Server

  The term "origin server" refers to a program that can originate
  authoritative responses for a given target resource.

  The most familiar form of origin server are large public websites.
  However, like user agents being equated with browsers, it is easy to
  be misled into thinking that all origin servers are alike.  Common
  origin servers also include home automation units, configurable
  networking components, office machines, autonomous robots, news
  feeds, traffic cameras, real-time ad selectors, and video-on-demand
  platforms.

  Most HTTP communication consists of a retrieval request (GET) for a
  representation of some resource identified by a URI.  In the simplest
  case, this might be accomplished via a single bidirectional
  connection (===) between the user agent (UA) and the origin server
  (O).

           request   >
      UA ======================================= O
                                  <   response

                                 Figure 1

3.7.  Intermediaries

  HTTP enables the use of intermediaries to satisfy requests through a
  chain of connections.  There are three common forms of HTTP
  "intermediary": proxy, gateway, and tunnel.  In some cases, a single
  intermediary might act as an origin server, proxy, gateway, or
  tunnel, switching behavior based on the nature of each request.

           >             >             >             >
      UA =========== A =========== B =========== C =========== O
                 <             <             <             <

                                 Figure 2

  The figure above shows three intermediaries (A, B, and C) between the
  user agent and origin server.  A request or response message that
  travels the whole chain will pass through four separate connections.
  Some HTTP communication options might apply only to the connection
  with the nearest, non-tunnel neighbor, only to the endpoints of the
  chain, or to all connections along the chain.  Although the diagram
  is linear, each participant might be engaged in multiple,
  simultaneous communications.  For example, B might be receiving
  requests from many clients other than A, and/or forwarding requests
  to servers other than C, at the same time that it is handling A's
  request.  Likewise, later requests might be sent through a different
  path of connections, often based on dynamic configuration for load
  balancing.

  The terms "upstream" and "downstream" are used to describe
  directional requirements in relation to the message flow: all
  messages flow from upstream to downstream.  The terms "inbound" and
  "outbound" are used to describe directional requirements in relation
  to the request route: inbound means "toward the origin server",
  whereas outbound means "toward the user agent".

  A "proxy" is a message-forwarding agent that is chosen by the client,
  usually via local configuration rules, to receive requests for some
  type(s) of absolute URI and attempt to satisfy those requests via
  translation through the HTTP interface.  Some translations are
  minimal, such as for proxy requests for "http" URIs, whereas other
  requests might require translation to and from entirely different
  application-level protocols.  Proxies are often used to group an
  organization's HTTP requests through a common intermediary for the
  sake of security services, annotation services, or shared caching.
  Some proxies are designed to apply transformations to selected
  messages or content while they are being forwarded, as described in
  Section 7.7.

  A "gateway" (a.k.a. "reverse proxy") is an intermediary that acts as
  an origin server for the outbound connection but translates received
  requests and forwards them inbound to another server or servers.
  Gateways are often used to encapsulate legacy or untrusted
  information services, to improve server performance through
  "accelerator" caching, and to enable partitioning or load balancing
  of HTTP services across multiple machines.

  All HTTP requirements applicable to an origin server also apply to
  the outbound communication of a gateway.  A gateway communicates with
  inbound servers using any protocol that it desires, including private
  extensions to HTTP that are outside the scope of this specification.
  However, an HTTP-to-HTTP gateway that wishes to interoperate with
  third-party HTTP servers needs to conform to user agent requirements
  on the gateway's inbound connection.

  A "tunnel" acts as a blind relay between two connections without
  changing the messages.  Once active, a tunnel is not considered a
  party to the HTTP communication, though the tunnel might have been
  initiated by an HTTP request.  A tunnel ceases to exist when both
  ends of the relayed connection are closed.  Tunnels are used to
  extend a virtual connection through an intermediary, such as when
  Transport Layer Security (TLS, [TLS13]) is used to establish
  confidential communication through a shared firewall proxy.

  The above categories for intermediary only consider those acting as
  participants in the HTTP communication.  There are also
  intermediaries that can act on lower layers of the network protocol
  stack, filtering or redirecting HTTP traffic without the knowledge or
  permission of message senders.  Network intermediaries are
  indistinguishable (at a protocol level) from an on-path attacker,
  often introducing security flaws or interoperability problems due to
  mistakenly violating HTTP semantics.

  For example, an "interception proxy" [RFC3040] (also commonly known
  as a "transparent proxy" [RFC1919]) differs from an HTTP proxy
  because it is not chosen by the client.  Instead, an interception
  proxy filters or redirects outgoing TCP port 80 packets (and
  occasionally other common port traffic).  Interception proxies are
  commonly found on public network access points, as a means of
  enforcing account subscription prior to allowing use of non-local
  Internet services, and within corporate firewalls to enforce network
  usage policies.

3.8.  Caches

  A "cache" is a local store of previous response messages and the
  subsystem that controls its message storage, retrieval, and deletion.
  A cache stores cacheable responses in order to reduce the response
  time and network bandwidth consumption on future, equivalent
  requests.  Any client or server MAY employ a cache, though a cache
  cannot be used while acting as a tunnel.

  The effect of a cache is that the request/response chain is shortened
  if one of the participants along the chain has a cached response
  applicable to that request.  The following illustrates the resulting
  chain if B has a cached copy of an earlier response from O (via C)
  for a request that has not been cached by UA or A.

              >             >
         UA =========== A =========== B - - - - - - C - - - - - - O
                    <             <

                                 Figure 3

  A response is "cacheable" if a cache is allowed to store a copy of
  the response message for use in answering subsequent requests.  Even
  when a response is cacheable, there might be additional constraints
  placed by the client or by the origin server on when that cached
  response can be used for a particular request.  HTTP requirements for
  cache behavior and cacheable responses are defined in [CACHING].

  There is a wide variety of architectures and configurations of caches
  deployed across the World Wide Web and inside large organizations.
  These include national hierarchies of proxy caches to save bandwidth
  and reduce latency, content delivery networks that use gateway
  caching to optimize regional and global distribution of popular
  sites, collaborative systems that broadcast or multicast cache
  entries, archives of pre-fetched cache entries for use in off-line or
  high-latency environments, and so on.

3.9.  Example Message Exchange

  The following example illustrates a typical HTTP/1.1 message exchange
  for a GET request (Section 9.3.1) on the URI "http://www.example.com/
  hello.txt":

  Client request:

  GET /hello.txt HTTP/1.1
  User-Agent: curl/7.64.1
  Host: www.example.com
  Accept-Language: en, mi

  Server response:

  HTTP/1.1 200 OK
  Date: Mon, 27 Jul 2009 12:28:53 GMT
  Server: Apache
  Last-Modified: Wed, 22 Jul 2009 19:15:56 GMT
  ETag: "34aa387-d-1568eb00"
  Accept-Ranges: bytes
  Content-Length: 51
  Vary: Accept-Encoding
  Content-Type: text/plain

  Hello World! My content includes a trailing CRLF.

4.  Identifiers in HTTP

  Uniform Resource Identifiers (URIs) [URI] are used throughout HTTP as
  the means for identifying resources (Section 3.1).

4.1.  URI References

  URI references are used to target requests, indicate redirects, and
  define relationships.

  The definitions of "URI-reference", "absolute-URI", "relative-part",
  "authority", "port", "host", "path-abempty", "segment", and "query"
  are adopted from the URI generic syntax.  An "absolute-path" rule is
  defined for protocol elements that can contain a non-empty path
  component.  (This rule differs slightly from the path-abempty rule of
  RFC 3986, which allows for an empty path, and path-absolute rule,
  which does not allow paths that begin with "//".)  A "partial-URI"
  rule is defined for protocol elements that can contain a relative URI
  but not a fragment component.

    URI-reference = <URI-reference, see [URI], Section 4.1>
    absolute-URI  = <absolute-URI, see [URI], Section 4.3>
    relative-part = <relative-part, see [URI], Section 4.2>
    authority     = <authority, see [URI], Section 3.2>
    uri-host      = <host, see [URI], Section 3.2.2>
    port          = <port, see [URI], Section 3.2.3>
    path-abempty  = <path-abempty, see [URI], Section 3.3>
    segment       = <segment, see [URI], Section 3.3>
    query         = <query, see [URI], Section 3.4>

    absolute-path = 1*( "/" segment )
    partial-URI   = relative-part [ "?" query ]

  Each protocol element in HTTP that allows a URI reference will
  indicate in its ABNF production whether the element allows any form
  of reference (URI-reference), only a URI in absolute form (absolute-
  URI), only the path and optional query components (partial-URI), or
  some combination of the above.  Unless otherwise indicated, URI
  references are parsed relative to the target URI (Section 7.1).

  It is RECOMMENDED that all senders and recipients support, at a
  minimum, URIs with lengths of 8000 octets in protocol elements.  Note
  that this implies some structures and on-wire representations (for
  example, the request line in HTTP/1.1) will necessarily be larger in
  some cases.

4.2.  HTTP-Related URI Schemes

  IANA maintains the registry of URI Schemes [BCP35] at
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/uri-schemes/>.  Although requests
  might target any URI scheme, the following schemes are inherent to
  HTTP servers:

  +============+====================================+=========+
  | URI Scheme | Description                        | Section |
  +============+====================================+=========+
  | http       | Hypertext Transfer Protocol        | 4.2.1   |
  +------------+------------------------------------+---------+
  | https      | Hypertext Transfer Protocol Secure | 4.2.2   |
  +------------+------------------------------------+---------+

                             Table 2

  Note that the presence of an "http" or "https" URI does not imply
  that there is always an HTTP server at the identified origin
  listening for connections.  Anyone can mint a URI, whether or not a
  server exists and whether or not that server currently maps that
  identifier to a resource.  The delegated nature of registered names
  and IP addresses creates a federated namespace whether or not an HTTP
  server is present.

4.2.1.  http URI Scheme

  The "http" URI scheme is hereby defined for minting identifiers
  within the hierarchical namespace governed by a potential HTTP origin
  server listening for TCP ([TCP]) connections on a given port.

    http-URI = "http" "://" authority path-abempty [ "?" query ]

  The origin server for an "http" URI is identified by the authority
  component, which includes a host identifier ([URI], Section 3.2.2)
  and optional port number ([URI], Section 3.2.3).  If the port
  subcomponent is empty or not given, TCP port 80 (the reserved port
  for WWW services) is the default.  The origin determines who has the
  right to respond authoritatively to requests that target the
  identified resource, as defined in Section 4.3.2.

  A sender MUST NOT generate an "http" URI with an empty host
  identifier.  A recipient that processes such a URI reference MUST
  reject it as invalid.

  The hierarchical path component and optional query component identify
  the target resource within that origin server's namespace.

4.2.2.  https URI Scheme

  The "https" URI scheme is hereby defined for minting identifiers
  within the hierarchical namespace governed by a potential origin
  server listening for TCP connections on a given port and capable of
  establishing a TLS ([TLS13]) connection that has been secured for
  HTTP communication.  In this context, "secured" specifically means
  that the server has been authenticated as acting on behalf of the
  identified authority and all HTTP communication with that server has
  confidentiality and integrity protection that is acceptable to both
  client and server.

    https-URI = "https" "://" authority path-abempty [ "?" query ]

  The origin server for an "https" URI is identified by the authority
  component, which includes a host identifier ([URI], Section 3.2.2)
  and optional port number ([URI], Section 3.2.3).  If the port
  subcomponent is empty or not given, TCP port 443 (the reserved port
  for HTTP over TLS) is the default.  The origin determines who has the
  right to respond authoritatively to requests that target the
  identified resource, as defined in Section 4.3.3.

  A sender MUST NOT generate an "https" URI with an empty host
  identifier.  A recipient that processes such a URI reference MUST
  reject it as invalid.

  The hierarchical path component and optional query component identify
  the target resource within that origin server's namespace.

  A client MUST ensure that its HTTP requests for an "https" resource
  are secured, prior to being communicated, and that it only accepts
  secured responses to those requests.  Note that the definition of
  what cryptographic mechanisms are acceptable to client and server are
  usually negotiated and can change over time.

  Resources made available via the "https" scheme have no shared
  identity with the "http" scheme.  They are distinct origins with
  separate namespaces.  However, extensions to HTTP that are defined as
  applying to all origins with the same host, such as the Cookie
  protocol [COOKIE], allow information set by one service to impact
  communication with other services within a matching group of host
  domains.  Such extensions ought to be designed with great care to
  prevent information obtained from a secured connection being
  inadvertently exchanged within an unsecured context.

4.2.3.  http(s) Normalization and Comparison

  URIs with an "http" or "https" scheme are normalized and compared
  according to the methods defined in Section 6 of [URI], using the
  defaults described above for each scheme.

  HTTP does not require the use of a specific method for determining
  equivalence.  For example, a cache key might be compared as a simple
  string, after syntax-based normalization, or after scheme-based
  normalization.

  Scheme-based normalization (Section 6.2.3 of [URI]) of "http" and
  "https" URIs involves the following additional rules:

  *  If the port is equal to the default port for a scheme, the normal
     form is to omit the port subcomponent.

  *  When not being used as the target of an OPTIONS request, an empty
     path component is equivalent to an absolute path of "/", so the
     normal form is to provide a path of "/" instead.

  *  The scheme and host are case-insensitive and normally provided in
     lowercase; all other components are compared in a case-sensitive
     manner.

  *  Characters other than those in the "reserved" set are equivalent
     to their percent-encoded octets: the normal form is to not encode
     them (see Sections 2.1 and 2.2 of [URI]).

  For example, the following three URIs are equivalent:

     http://example.com:80/~smith/home.html
     http://EXAMPLE.com/%7Esmith/home.html
     http://EXAMPLE.com:/%7esmith/home.html

  Two HTTP URIs that are equivalent after normalization (using any
  method) can be assumed to identify the same resource, and any HTTP
  component MAY perform normalization.  As a result, distinct resources
  SHOULD NOT be identified by HTTP URIs that are equivalent after
  normalization (using any method defined in Section 6.2 of [URI]).

4.2.4.  Deprecation of userinfo in http(s) URIs

  The URI generic syntax for authority also includes a userinfo
  subcomponent ([URI], Section 3.2.1) for including user authentication
  information in the URI.  In that subcomponent, the use of the format
  "user:password" is deprecated.

  Some implementations make use of the userinfo component for internal
  configuration of authentication information, such as within command
  invocation options, configuration files, or bookmark lists, even
  though such usage might expose a user identifier or password.

  A sender MUST NOT generate the userinfo subcomponent (and its "@"
  delimiter) when an "http" or "https" URI reference is generated
  within a message as a target URI or field value.

  Before making use of an "http" or "https" URI reference received from
  an untrusted source, a recipient SHOULD parse for userinfo and treat
  its presence as an error; it is likely being used to obscure the
  authority for the sake of phishing attacks.

4.2.5.  http(s) References with Fragment Identifiers

  Fragment identifiers allow for indirect identification of a secondary
  resource, independent of the URI scheme, as defined in Section 3.5 of
  [URI].  Some protocol elements that refer to a URI allow inclusion of
  a fragment, while others do not.  They are distinguished by use of
  the ABNF rule for elements where fragment is allowed; otherwise, a
  specific rule that excludes fragments is used.

     |  *Note:* The fragment identifier component is not part of the
     |  scheme definition for a URI scheme (see Section 4.3 of [URI]),
     |  thus does not appear in the ABNF definitions for the "http" and
     |  "https" URI schemes above.

4.3.  Authoritative Access

  Authoritative access refers to dereferencing a given identifier, for
  the sake of access to the identified resource, in a way that the
  client believes is authoritative (controlled by the resource owner).
  The process for determining whether access is granted is defined by
  the URI scheme and often uses data within the URI components, such as
  the authority component when the generic syntax is used.  However,
  authoritative access is not limited to the identified mechanism.

  Section 4.3.1 defines the concept of an origin as an aid to such
  uses, and the subsequent subsections explain how to establish that a
  peer has the authority to represent an origin.

  See Section 17.1 for security considerations related to establishing
  authority.

4.3.1.  URI Origin

  The "origin" for a given URI is the triple of scheme, host, and port
  after normalizing the scheme and host to lowercase and normalizing
  the port to remove any leading zeros.  If port is elided from the
  URI, the default port for that scheme is used.  For example, the URI

     https://Example.Com/happy.js

  would have the origin

     { "https", "example.com", "443" }

  which can also be described as the normalized URI prefix with port
  always present:

     https://example.com:443

  Each origin defines its own namespace and controls how identifiers
  within that namespace are mapped to resources.  In turn, how the
  origin responds to valid requests, consistently over time, determines
  the semantics that users will associate with a URI, and the
  usefulness of those semantics is what ultimately transforms these
  mechanisms into a resource for users to reference and access in the
  future.

  Two origins are distinct if they differ in scheme, host, or port.
  Even when it can be verified that the same entity controls two
  distinct origins, the two namespaces under those origins are distinct
  unless explicitly aliased by a server authoritative for that origin.

  Origin is also used within HTML and related Web protocols, beyond the
  scope of this document, as described in [RFC6454].

4.3.2.  http Origins

  Although HTTP is independent of the transport protocol, the "http"
  scheme (Section 4.2.1) is specific to associating authority with
  whomever controls the origin server listening for TCP connections on
  the indicated port of whatever host is identified within the
  authority component.  This is a very weak sense of authority because
  it depends on both client-specific name resolution mechanisms and
  communication that might not be secured from an on-path attacker.
  Nevertheless, it is a sufficient minimum for binding "http"
  identifiers to an origin server for consistent resolution within a
  trusted environment.

  If the host identifier is provided as an IP address, the origin
  server is the listener (if any) on the indicated TCP port at that IP
  address.  If host is a registered name, the registered name is an
  indirect identifier for use with a name resolution service, such as
  DNS, to find an address for an appropriate origin server.

  When an "http" URI is used within a context that calls for access to
  the indicated resource, a client MAY attempt access by resolving the
  host identifier to an IP address, establishing a TCP connection to
  that address on the indicated port, and sending over that connection
  an HTTP request message containing a request target that matches the
  client's target URI (Section 7.1).

  If the server responds to such a request with a non-interim HTTP
  response message, as described in Section 15, then that response is
  considered an authoritative answer to the client's request.

  Note, however, that the above is not the only means for obtaining an
  authoritative response, nor does it imply that an authoritative
  response is always necessary (see [CACHING]).  For example, the Alt-
  Svc header field [ALTSVC] allows an origin server to identify other
  services that are also authoritative for that origin.  Access to
  "http" identified resources might also be provided by protocols
  outside the scope of this document.

4.3.3.  https Origins

  The "https" scheme (Section 4.2.2) associates authority based on the
  ability of a server to use the private key corresponding to a
  certificate that the client considers to be trustworthy for the
  identified origin server.  The client usually relies upon a chain of
  trust, conveyed from some prearranged or configured trust anchor, to
  deem a certificate trustworthy (Section 4.3.4).

  In HTTP/1.1 and earlier, a client will only attribute authority to a
  server when they are communicating over a successfully established
  and secured connection specifically to that URI origin's host.  The
  connection establishment and certificate verification are used as
  proof of authority.

  In HTTP/2 and HTTP/3, a client will attribute authority to a server
  when they are communicating over a successfully established and
  secured connection if the URI origin's host matches any of the hosts
  present in the server's certificate and the client believes that it
  could open a connection to that host for that URI.  In practice, a
  client will make a DNS query to check that the origin's host contains
  the same server IP address as the established connection.  This
  restriction can be removed by the origin server sending an equivalent
  ORIGIN frame [RFC8336].

  The request target's host and port value are passed within each HTTP
  request, identifying the origin and distinguishing it from other
  namespaces that might be controlled by the same server (Section 7.2).
  It is the origin's responsibility to ensure that any services
  provided with control over its certificate's private key are equally
  responsible for managing the corresponding "https" namespaces or at
  least prepared to reject requests that appear to have been
  misdirected (Section 7.4).

  An origin server might be unwilling to process requests for certain
  target URIs even when they have the authority to do so.  For example,
  when a host operates distinct services on different ports (e.g., 443
  and 8000), checking the target URI at the origin server is necessary
  (even after the connection has been secured) because a network
  attacker might cause connections for one port to be received at some
  other port.  Failing to check the target URI might allow such an
  attacker to replace a response to one target URI (e.g.,
  "https://example.com/foo") with a seemingly authoritative response
  from the other port (e.g., "https://example.com:8000/foo").

  Note that the "https" scheme does not rely on TCP and the connected
  port number for associating authority, since both are outside the
  secured communication and thus cannot be trusted as definitive.
  Hence, the HTTP communication might take place over any channel that
  has been secured, as defined in Section 4.2.2, including protocols
  that don't use TCP.

  When an "https" URI is used within a context that calls for access to
  the indicated resource, a client MAY attempt access by resolving the
  host identifier to an IP address, establishing a TCP connection to
  that address on the indicated port, securing the connection end-to-
  end by successfully initiating TLS over TCP with confidentiality and
  integrity protection, and sending over that connection an HTTP
  request message containing a request target that matches the client's
  target URI (Section 7.1).

  If the server responds to such a request with a non-interim HTTP
  response message, as described in Section 15, then that response is
  considered an authoritative answer to the client's request.

  Note, however, that the above is not the only means for obtaining an
  authoritative response, nor does it imply that an authoritative
  response is always necessary (see [CACHING]).

4.3.4.  https Certificate Verification

  To establish a secured connection to dereference a URI, a client MUST
  verify that the service's identity is an acceptable match for the
  URI's origin server.  Certificate verification is used to prevent
  server impersonation by an on-path attacker or by an attacker that
  controls name resolution.  This process requires that a client be
  configured with a set of trust anchors.

  In general, a client MUST verify the service identity using the
  verification process defined in Section 6 of [RFC6125].  The client
  MUST construct a reference identity from the service's host: if the
  host is a literal IP address (Section 4.3.5), the reference identity
  is an IP-ID, otherwise the host is a name and the reference identity
  is a DNS-ID.

  A reference identity of type CN-ID MUST NOT be used by clients.  As
  noted in Section 6.2.1 of [RFC6125], a reference identity of type CN-
  ID might be used by older clients.

  A client might be specially configured to accept an alternative form
  of server identity verification.  For example, a client might be
  connecting to a server whose address and hostname are dynamic, with
  an expectation that the service will present a specific certificate
  (or a certificate matching some externally defined reference
  identity) rather than one matching the target URI's origin.

  In special cases, it might be appropriate for a client to simply
  ignore the server's identity, but it must be understood that this
  leaves a connection open to active attack.

  If the certificate is not valid for the target URI's origin, a user
  agent MUST either obtain confirmation from the user before proceeding
  (see Section 3.5) or terminate the connection with a bad certificate
  error.  Automated clients MUST log the error to an appropriate audit
  log (if available) and SHOULD terminate the connection (with a bad
  certificate error).  Automated clients MAY provide a configuration
  setting that disables this check, but MUST provide a setting which
  enables it.

4.3.5.  IP-ID Reference Identity

  A server that is identified using an IP address literal in the "host"
  field of an "https" URI has a reference identity of type IP-ID.  An
  IP version 4 address uses the "IPv4address" ABNF rule, and an IP
  version 6 address uses the "IP-literal" production with the
  "IPv6address" option; see Section 3.2.2 of [URI].  A reference
  identity of IP-ID contains the decoded bytes of the IP address.

  An IP version 4 address is 4 octets, and an IP version 6 address is
  16 octets.  Use of IP-ID is not defined for any other IP version.
  The iPAddress choice in the certificate subjectAltName extension does
  not explicitly include the IP version and so relies on the length of
  the address to distinguish versions; see Section 4.2.1.6 of
  [RFC5280].

  A reference identity of type IP-ID matches if the address is
  identical to an iPAddress value of the subjectAltName extension of
  the certificate.

5.  Fields

  HTTP uses "fields" to provide data in the form of extensible name/
  value pairs with a registered key namespace.  Fields are sent and
  received within the header and trailer sections of messages
  (Section 6).

5.1.  Field Names

  A field name labels the corresponding field value as having the
  semantics defined by that name.  For example, the Date header field
  is defined in Section 6.6.1 as containing the origination timestamp
  for the message in which it appears.

    field-name     = token

  Field names are case-insensitive and ought to be registered within
  the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Field Name Registry"; see
  Section 16.3.1.

  The interpretation of a field does not change between minor versions
  of the same major HTTP version, though the default behavior of a
  recipient in the absence of such a field can change.  Unless
  specified otherwise, fields are defined for all versions of HTTP.  In
  particular, the Host and Connection fields ought to be recognized by
  all HTTP implementations whether or not they advertise conformance
  with HTTP/1.1.

  New fields can be introduced without changing the protocol version if
  their defined semantics allow them to be safely ignored by recipients
  that do not recognize them; see Section 16.3.

  A proxy MUST forward unrecognized header fields unless the field name
  is listed in the Connection header field (Section 7.6.1) or the proxy
  is specifically configured to block, or otherwise transform, such
  fields.  Other recipients SHOULD ignore unrecognized header and
  trailer fields.  Adhering to these requirements allows HTTP's
  functionality to be extended without updating or removing deployed
  intermediaries.

5.2.  Field Lines and Combined Field Value

  Field sections are composed of any number of "field lines", each with
  a "field name" (see Section 5.1) identifying the field, and a "field
  line value" that conveys data for that instance of the field.

  When a field name is only present once in a section, the combined
  "field value" for that field consists of the corresponding field line
  value.  When a field name is repeated within a section, its combined
  field value consists of the list of corresponding field line values
  within that section, concatenated in order, with each field line
  value separated by a comma.

  For example, this section:

  Example-Field: Foo, Bar
  Example-Field: Baz

  contains two field lines, both with the field name "Example-Field".
  The first field line has a field line value of "Foo, Bar", while the
  second field line value is "Baz".  The field value for "Example-
  Field" is the list "Foo, Bar, Baz".

5.3.  Field Order

  A recipient MAY combine multiple field lines within a field section
  that have the same field name into one field line, without changing
  the semantics of the message, by appending each subsequent field line
  value to the initial field line value in order, separated by a comma
  (",") and optional whitespace (OWS, defined in Section 5.6.3).  For
  consistency, use comma SP.

  The order in which field lines with the same name are received is
  therefore significant to the interpretation of the field value; a
  proxy MUST NOT change the order of these field line values when
  forwarding a message.

  This means that, aside from the well-known exception noted below, a
  sender MUST NOT generate multiple field lines with the same name in a
  message (whether in the headers or trailers) or append a field line
  when a field line of the same name already exists in the message,
  unless that field's definition allows multiple field line values to
  be recombined as a comma-separated list (i.e., at least one
  alternative of the field's definition allows a comma-separated list,
  such as an ABNF rule of #(values) defined in Section 5.6.1).

     |  *Note:* In practice, the "Set-Cookie" header field ([COOKIE])
     |  often appears in a response message across multiple field lines
     |  and does not use the list syntax, violating the above
     |  requirements on multiple field lines with the same field name.
     |  Since it cannot be combined into a single field value,
     |  recipients ought to handle "Set-Cookie" as a special case while
     |  processing fields.  (See Appendix A.2.3 of [Kri2001] for
     |  details.)

  The order in which field lines with differing field names are
  received in a section is not significant.  However, it is good
  practice to send header fields that contain additional control data
  first, such as Host on requests and Date on responses, so that
  implementations can decide when not to handle a message as early as
  possible.

  A server MUST NOT apply a request to the target resource until it
  receives the entire request header section, since later header field
  lines might include conditionals, authentication credentials, or
  deliberately misleading duplicate header fields that could impact
  request processing.

5.4.  Field Limits

  HTTP does not place a predefined limit on the length of each field
  line, field value, or on the length of a header or trailer section as
  a whole, as described in Section 2.  Various ad hoc limitations on
  individual lengths are found in practice, often depending on the
  specific field's semantics.

  A server that receives a request header field line, field value, or
  set of fields larger than it wishes to process MUST respond with an
  appropriate 4xx (Client Error) status code.  Ignoring such header
  fields would increase the server's vulnerability to request smuggling
  attacks (Section 11.2 of [HTTP/1.1]).

  A client MAY discard or truncate received field lines that are larger
  than the client wishes to process if the field semantics are such
  that the dropped value(s) can be safely ignored without changing the
  message framing or response semantics.

5.5.  Field Values

  HTTP field values consist of a sequence of characters in a format
  defined by the field's grammar.  Each field's grammar is usually
  defined using ABNF ([RFC5234]).

    field-value    = *field-content
    field-content  = field-vchar
                     [ 1*( SP / HTAB / field-vchar ) field-vchar ]
    field-vchar    = VCHAR / obs-text
    obs-text       = %x80-FF

  A field value does not include leading or trailing whitespace.  When
  a specific version of HTTP allows such whitespace to appear in a
  message, a field parsing implementation MUST exclude such whitespace
  prior to evaluating the field value.

  Field values are usually constrained to the range of US-ASCII
  characters [USASCII].  Fields needing a greater range of characters
  can use an encoding, such as the one defined in [RFC8187].
  Historically, HTTP allowed field content with text in the ISO-8859-1
  charset [ISO-8859-1], supporting other charsets only through use of
  [RFC2047] encoding.  Specifications for newly defined fields SHOULD
  limit their values to visible US-ASCII octets (VCHAR), SP, and HTAB.
  A recipient SHOULD treat other allowed octets in field content (i.e.,
  obs-text) as opaque data.

  Field values containing CR, LF, or NUL characters are invalid and
  dangerous, due to the varying ways that implementations might parse
  and interpret those characters; a recipient of CR, LF, or NUL within
  a field value MUST either reject the message or replace each of those
  characters with SP before further processing or forwarding of that
  message.  Field values containing other CTL characters are also
  invalid; however, recipients MAY retain such characters for the sake
  of robustness when they appear within a safe context (e.g., an
  application-specific quoted string that will not be processed by any
  downstream HTTP parser).

  Fields that only anticipate a single member as the field value are
  referred to as "singleton fields".

  Fields that allow multiple members as the field value are referred to
  as "list-based fields".  The list operator extension of Section 5.6.1
  is used as a common notation for defining field values that can
  contain multiple members.

  Because commas (",") are used as the delimiter between members, they
  need to be treated with care if they are allowed as data within a
  member.  This is true for both list-based and singleton fields, since
  a singleton field might be erroneously sent with multiple members and
  detecting such errors improves interoperability.  Fields that expect
  to contain a comma within a member, such as within an HTTP-date or
  URI-reference element, ought to be defined with delimiters around
  that element to distinguish any comma within that data from potential
  list separators.

  For example, a textual date and a URI (either of which might contain
  a comma) could be safely carried in list-based field values like
  these:

  Example-URIs: "http://example.com/a.html,foo",
                "http://without-a-comma.example.com/"
  Example-Dates: "Sat, 04 May 1996", "Wed, 14 Sep 2005"

  Note that double-quote delimiters are almost always used with the
  quoted-string production (Section 5.6.4); using a different syntax
  inside double-quotes will likely cause unnecessary confusion.

  Many fields (such as Content-Type, defined in Section 8.3) use a
  common syntax for parameters that allows both unquoted (token) and
  quoted (quoted-string) syntax for a parameter value (Section 5.6.6).
  Use of common syntax allows recipients to reuse existing parser
  components.  When allowing both forms, the meaning of a parameter
  value ought to be the same whether it was received as a token or a
  quoted string.

     |  *Note:* For defining field value syntax, this specification
     |  uses an ABNF rule named after the field name to define the
     |  allowed grammar for that field's value (after said value has
     |  been extracted from the underlying messaging syntax and
     |  multiple instances combined into a list).

5.6.  Common Rules for Defining Field Values

5.6.1.  Lists (#rule ABNF Extension)

  A #rule extension to the ABNF rules of [RFC5234] is used to improve
  readability in the definitions of some list-based field values.

  A construct "#" is defined, similar to "*", for defining comma-
  delimited lists of elements.  The full form is "<n>#<m>element"
  indicating at least <n> and at most <m> elements, each separated by a
  single comma (",") and optional whitespace (OWS, defined in
  Section 5.6.3).

5.6.1.1.  Sender Requirements

  In any production that uses the list construct, a sender MUST NOT
  generate empty list elements.  In other words, a sender has to
  generate lists that satisfy the following syntax:

    1#element => element *( OWS "," OWS element )

  and:

    #element => [ 1#element ]

  and for n >= 1 and m > 1:

    <n>#<m>element => element <n-1>*<m-1>( OWS "," OWS element )

  Appendix A shows the collected ABNF for senders after the list
  constructs have been expanded.

5.6.1.2.  Recipient Requirements

  Empty elements do not contribute to the count of elements present.  A
  recipient MUST parse and ignore a reasonable number of empty list
  elements: enough to handle common mistakes by senders that merge
  values, but not so much that they could be used as a denial-of-
  service mechanism.  In other words, a recipient MUST accept lists
  that satisfy the following syntax:

    #element => [ element ] *( OWS "," OWS [ element ] )

  Note that because of the potential presence of empty list elements,
  the RFC 5234 ABNF cannot enforce the cardinality of list elements,
  and consequently all cases are mapped as if there was no cardinality
  specified.

  For example, given these ABNF productions:

    example-list      = 1#example-list-elmt
    example-list-elmt = token ; see Section 5.6.2

  Then the following are valid values for example-list (not including
  the double quotes, which are present for delimitation only):

    "foo,bar"
    "foo ,bar,"
    "foo , ,bar,charlie"

  In contrast, the following values would be invalid, since at least
  one non-empty element is required by the example-list production:

    ""
    ","
    ",   ,"

5.6.2.  Tokens

  Tokens are short textual identifiers that do not include whitespace
  or delimiters.

    token          = 1*tchar

    tchar          = "!" / "#" / "$" / "%" / "&" / "'" / "*"
                   / "+" / "-" / "." / "^" / "_" / "`" / "|" / "~"
                   / DIGIT / ALPHA
                   ; any VCHAR, except delimiters

  Many HTTP field values are defined using common syntax components,
  separated by whitespace or specific delimiting characters.
  Delimiters are chosen from the set of US-ASCII visual characters not
  allowed in a token (DQUOTE and "(),/:;<=>?@[\]{}").

5.6.3.  Whitespace

  This specification uses three rules to denote the use of linear
  whitespace: OWS (optional whitespace), RWS (required whitespace), and
  BWS ("bad" whitespace).

  The OWS rule is used where zero or more linear whitespace octets
  might appear.  For protocol elements where optional whitespace is
  preferred to improve readability, a sender SHOULD generate the
  optional whitespace as a single SP; otherwise, a sender SHOULD NOT
  generate optional whitespace except as needed to overwrite invalid or
  unwanted protocol elements during in-place message filtering.

  The RWS rule is used when at least one linear whitespace octet is
  required to separate field tokens.  A sender SHOULD generate RWS as a
  single SP.

  OWS and RWS have the same semantics as a single SP.  Any content
  known to be defined as OWS or RWS MAY be replaced with a single SP
  before interpreting it or forwarding the message downstream.

  The BWS rule is used where the grammar allows optional whitespace
  only for historical reasons.  A sender MUST NOT generate BWS in
  messages.  A recipient MUST parse for such bad whitespace and remove
  it before interpreting the protocol element.

  BWS has no semantics.  Any content known to be defined as BWS MAY be
  removed before interpreting it or forwarding the message downstream.

    OWS            = *( SP / HTAB )
                   ; optional whitespace
    RWS            = 1*( SP / HTAB )
                   ; required whitespace
    BWS            = OWS
                   ; "bad" whitespace

5.6.4.  Quoted Strings

  A string of text is parsed as a single value if it is quoted using
  double-quote marks.

    quoted-string  = DQUOTE *( qdtext / quoted-pair ) DQUOTE
    qdtext         = HTAB / SP / %x21 / %x23-5B / %x5D-7E / obs-text

  The backslash octet ("\") can be used as a single-octet quoting
  mechanism within quoted-string and comment constructs.  Recipients
  that process the value of a quoted-string MUST handle a quoted-pair
  as if it were replaced by the octet following the backslash.

    quoted-pair    = "\" ( HTAB / SP / VCHAR / obs-text )

  A sender SHOULD NOT generate a quoted-pair in a quoted-string except
  where necessary to quote DQUOTE and backslash octets occurring within
  that string.  A sender SHOULD NOT generate a quoted-pair in a comment
  except where necessary to quote parentheses ["(" and ")"] and
  backslash octets occurring within that comment.

5.6.5.  Comments

  Comments can be included in some HTTP fields by surrounding the
  comment text with parentheses.  Comments are only allowed in fields
  containing "comment" as part of their field value definition.

    comment        = "(" *( ctext / quoted-pair / comment ) ")"
    ctext          = HTAB / SP / %x21-27 / %x2A-5B / %x5D-7E / obs-text

5.6.6.  Parameters

  Parameters are instances of name/value pairs; they are often used in
  field values as a common syntax for appending auxiliary information
  to an item.  Each parameter is usually delimited by an immediately
  preceding semicolon.

    parameters      = *( OWS ";" OWS [ parameter ] )
    parameter       = parameter-name "=" parameter-value
    parameter-name  = token
    parameter-value = ( token / quoted-string )

  Parameter names are case-insensitive.  Parameter values might or
  might not be case-sensitive, depending on the semantics of the
  parameter name.  Examples of parameters and some equivalent forms can
  be seen in media types (Section 8.3.1) and the Accept header field
  (Section 12.5.1).

  A parameter value that matches the token production can be
  transmitted either as a token or within a quoted-string.  The quoted
  and unquoted values are equivalent.

     |  *Note:* Parameters do not allow whitespace (not even "bad"
     |  whitespace) around the "=" character.

5.6.7.  Date/Time Formats

  Prior to 1995, there were three different formats commonly used by
  servers to communicate timestamps.  For compatibility with old
  implementations, all three are defined here.  The preferred format is
  a fixed-length and single-zone subset of the date and time
  specification used by the Internet Message Format [RFC5322].

    HTTP-date    = IMF-fixdate / obs-date

  An example of the preferred format is

    Sun, 06 Nov 1994 08:49:37 GMT    ; IMF-fixdate

  Examples of the two obsolete formats are

    Sunday, 06-Nov-94 08:49:37 GMT   ; obsolete RFC 850 format
    Sun Nov  6 08:49:37 1994         ; ANSI C's asctime() format

  A recipient that parses a timestamp value in an HTTP field MUST
  accept all three HTTP-date formats.  When a sender generates a field
  that contains one or more timestamps defined as HTTP-date, the sender
  MUST generate those timestamps in the IMF-fixdate format.

  An HTTP-date value represents time as an instance of Coordinated
  Universal Time (UTC).  The first two formats indicate UTC by the
  three-letter abbreviation for Greenwich Mean Time, "GMT", a
  predecessor of the UTC name; values in the asctime format are assumed
  to be in UTC.

  A "clock" is an implementation capable of providing a reasonable
  approximation of the current instant in UTC.  A clock implementation
  ought to use NTP ([RFC5905]), or some similar protocol, to
  synchronize with UTC.

  Preferred format:

    IMF-fixdate  = day-name "," SP date1 SP time-of-day SP GMT
    ; fixed length/zone/capitalization subset of the format
    ; see Section 3.3 of [RFC5322]

    day-name     = %s"Mon" / %s"Tue" / %s"Wed"
                 / %s"Thu" / %s"Fri" / %s"Sat" / %s"Sun"

    date1        = day SP month SP year
                 ; e.g., 02 Jun 1982

    day          = 2DIGIT
    month        = %s"Jan" / %s"Feb" / %s"Mar" / %s"Apr"
                 / %s"May" / %s"Jun" / %s"Jul" / %s"Aug"
                 / %s"Sep" / %s"Oct" / %s"Nov" / %s"Dec"
    year         = 4DIGIT

    GMT          = %s"GMT"

    time-of-day  = hour ":" minute ":" second
                 ; 00:00:00 - 23:59:60 (leap second)

    hour         = 2DIGIT
    minute       = 2DIGIT
    second       = 2DIGIT

  Obsolete formats:

    obs-date     = rfc850-date / asctime-date

    rfc850-date  = day-name-l "," SP date2 SP time-of-day SP GMT
    date2        = day "-" month "-" 2DIGIT
                 ; e.g., 02-Jun-82

    day-name-l   = %s"Monday" / %s"Tuesday" / %s"Wednesday"
                 / %s"Thursday" / %s"Friday" / %s"Saturday"
                 / %s"Sunday"

    asctime-date = day-name SP date3 SP time-of-day SP year
    date3        = month SP ( 2DIGIT / ( SP 1DIGIT ))
                 ; e.g., Jun  2

  HTTP-date is case sensitive.  Note that Section 4.2 of [CACHING]
  relaxes this for cache recipients.

  A sender MUST NOT generate additional whitespace in an HTTP-date
  beyond that specifically included as SP in the grammar.  The
  semantics of day-name, day, month, year, and time-of-day are the same
  as those defined for the Internet Message Format constructs with the
  corresponding name ([RFC5322], Section 3.3).

  Recipients of a timestamp value in rfc850-date format, which uses a
  two-digit year, MUST interpret a timestamp that appears to be more
  than 50 years in the future as representing the most recent year in
  the past that had the same last two digits.

  Recipients of timestamp values are encouraged to be robust in parsing
  timestamps unless otherwise restricted by the field definition.  For
  example, messages are occasionally forwarded over HTTP from a non-
  HTTP source that might generate any of the date and time
  specifications defined by the Internet Message Format.

     |  *Note:* HTTP requirements for timestamp formats apply only to
     |  their usage within the protocol stream.  Implementations are
     |  not required to use these formats for user presentation,
     |  request logging, etc.

6.  Message Abstraction

  Each major version of HTTP defines its own syntax for communicating
  messages.  This section defines an abstract data type for HTTP
  messages based on a generalization of those message characteristics,
  common structure, and capacity for conveying semantics.  This
  abstraction is used to define requirements on senders and recipients
  that are independent of the HTTP version, such that a message in one
  version can be relayed through other versions without changing its
  meaning.

  A "message" consists of the following:

  *  control data to describe and route the message,

  *  a headers lookup table of name/value pairs for extending that
     control data and conveying additional information about the
     sender, message, content, or context,

  *  a potentially unbounded stream of content, and

  *  a trailers lookup table of name/value pairs for communicating
     information obtained while sending the content.

  Framing and control data is sent first, followed by a header section
  containing fields for the headers table.  When a message includes
  content, the content is sent after the header section, potentially
  followed by a trailer section that might contain fields for the
  trailers table.

  Messages are expected to be processed as a stream, wherein the
  purpose of that stream and its continued processing is revealed while
  being read.  Hence, control data describes what the recipient needs
  to know immediately, header fields describe what needs to be known
  before receiving content, the content (when present) presumably
  contains what the recipient wants or needs to fulfill the message
  semantics, and trailer fields provide optional metadata that was
  unknown prior to sending the content.

  Messages are intended to be "self-descriptive": everything a
  recipient needs to know about the message can be determined by
  looking at the message itself, after decoding or reconstituting parts
  that have been compressed or elided in transit, without requiring an
  understanding of the sender's current application state (established
  via prior messages).  However, a client MUST retain knowledge of the
  request when parsing, interpreting, or caching a corresponding
  response.  For example, responses to the HEAD method look just like
  the beginning of a response to GET but cannot be parsed in the same
  manner.

  Note that this message abstraction is a generalization across many
  versions of HTTP, including features that might not be found in some
  versions.  For example, trailers were introduced within the HTTP/1.1
  chunked transfer coding as a trailer section after the content.  An
  equivalent feature is present in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3 within the header
  block that terminates each stream.

6.1.  Framing and Completeness

  Message framing indicates how each message begins and ends, such that
  each message can be distinguished from other messages or noise on the
  same connection.  Each major version of HTTP defines its own framing
  mechanism.

  HTTP/0.9 and early deployments of HTTP/1.0 used closure of the
  underlying connection to end a response.  For backwards
  compatibility, this implicit framing is also allowed in HTTP/1.1.
  However, implicit framing can fail to distinguish an incomplete
  response if the connection closes early.  For that reason, almost all
  modern implementations use explicit framing in the form of length-
  delimited sequences of message data.

  A message is considered "complete" when all of the octets indicated
  by its framing are available.  Note that, when no explicit framing is
  used, a response message that is ended by the underlying connection's
  close is considered complete even though it might be
  indistinguishable from an incomplete response, unless a transport-
  level error indicates that it is not complete.

6.2.  Control Data

  Messages start with control data that describe its primary purpose.
  Request message control data includes a request method (Section 9),
  request target (Section 7.1), and protocol version (Section 2.5).
  Response message control data includes a status code (Section 15),
  optional reason phrase, and protocol version.

  In HTTP/1.1 ([HTTP/1.1]) and earlier, control data is sent as the
  first line of a message.  In HTTP/2 ([HTTP/2]) and HTTP/3 ([HTTP/3]),
  control data is sent as pseudo-header fields with a reserved name
  prefix (e.g., ":authority").

  Every HTTP message has a protocol version.  Depending on the version
  in use, it might be identified within the message explicitly or
  inferred by the connection over which the message is received.
  Recipients use that version information to determine limitations or
  potential for later communication with that sender.

  When a message is forwarded by an intermediary, the protocol version
  is updated to reflect the version used by that intermediary.  The Via
  header field (Section 7.6.3) is used to communicate upstream protocol
  information within a forwarded message.

  A client SHOULD send a request version equal to the highest version
  to which the client is conformant and whose major version is no
  higher than the highest version supported by the server, if this is
  known.  A client MUST NOT send a version to which it is not
  conformant.

  A client MAY send a lower request version if it is known that the
  server incorrectly implements the HTTP specification, but only after
  the client has attempted at least one normal request and determined
  from the response status code or header fields (e.g., Server) that
  the server improperly handles higher request versions.

  A server SHOULD send a response version equal to the highest version
  to which the server is conformant that has a major version less than
  or equal to the one received in the request.  A server MUST NOT send
  a version to which it is not conformant.  A server can send a 505
  (HTTP Version Not Supported) response if it wishes, for any reason,
  to refuse service of the client's major protocol version.

  A recipient that receives a message with a major version number that
  it implements and a minor version number higher than what it
  implements SHOULD process the message as if it were in the highest
  minor version within that major version to which the recipient is
  conformant.  A recipient can assume that a message with a higher
  minor version, when sent to a recipient that has not yet indicated
  support for that higher version, is sufficiently backwards-compatible
  to be safely processed by any implementation of the same major
  version.

6.3.  Header Fields

  Fields (Section 5) that are sent or received before the content are
  referred to as "header fields" (or just "headers", colloquially).

  The "header section" of a message consists of a sequence of header
  field lines.  Each header field might modify or extend message
  semantics, describe the sender, define the content, or provide
  additional context.

     |  *Note:* We refer to named fields specifically as a "header
     |  field" when they are only allowed to be sent in the header
     |  section.

6.4.  Content

  HTTP messages often transfer a complete or partial representation as
  the message "content": a stream of octets sent after the header
  section, as delineated by the message framing.

  This abstract definition of content reflects the data after it has
  been extracted from the message framing.  For example, an HTTP/1.1
  message body (Section 6 of [HTTP/1.1]) might consist of a stream of
  data encoded with the chunked transfer coding -- a sequence of data
  chunks, one zero-length chunk, and a trailer section -- whereas the
  content of that same message includes only the data stream after the
  transfer coding has been decoded; it does not include the chunk
  lengths, chunked framing syntax, nor the trailer fields
  (Section 6.5).

     |  *Note:* Some field names have a "Content-" prefix.  This is an
     |  informal convention; while some of these fields refer to the
     |  content of the message, as defined above, others are scoped to
     |  the selected representation (Section 3.2).  See the individual
     |  field's definition to disambiguate.

6.4.1.  Content Semantics

  The purpose of content in a request is defined by the method
  semantics (Section 9).

  For example, a representation in the content of a PUT request
  (Section 9.3.4) represents the desired state of the target resource
  after the request is successfully applied, whereas a representation
  in the content of a POST request (Section 9.3.3) represents
  information to be processed by the target resource.

  In a response, the content's purpose is defined by the request
  method, response status code (Section 15), and response fields
  describing that content.  For example, the content of a 200 (OK)
  response to GET (Section 9.3.1) represents the current state of the
  target resource, as observed at the time of the message origination
  date (Section 6.6.1), whereas the content of the same status code in
  a response to POST might represent either the processing result or
  the new state of the target resource after applying the processing.

  The content of a 206 (Partial Content) response to GET contains
  either a single part of the selected representation or a multipart
  message body containing multiple parts of that representation, as
  described in Section 15.3.7.

  Response messages with an error status code usually contain content
  that represents the error condition, such that the content describes
  the error state and what steps are suggested for resolving it.

  Responses to the HEAD request method (Section 9.3.2) never include
  content; the associated response header fields indicate only what
  their values would have been if the request method had been GET
  (Section 9.3.1).

  2xx (Successful) responses to a CONNECT request method
  (Section 9.3.6) switch the connection to tunnel mode instead of
  having content.

  All 1xx (Informational), 204 (No Content), and 304 (Not Modified)
  responses do not include content.

  All other responses do include content, although that content might
  be of zero length.

6.4.2.  Identifying Content

  When a complete or partial representation is transferred as message
  content, it is often desirable for the sender to supply, or the
  recipient to determine, an identifier for a resource corresponding to
  that specific representation.  For example, a client making a GET
  request on a resource for "the current weather report" might want an
  identifier specific to the content returned (e.g., "weather report
  for Laguna Beach at 20210720T1711").  This can be useful for sharing
  or bookmarking content from resources that are expected to have
  changing representations over time.

  For a request message:

  *  If the request has a Content-Location header field, then the
     sender asserts that the content is a representation of the
     resource identified by the Content-Location field value.  However,
     such an assertion cannot be trusted unless it can be verified by
     other means (not defined by this specification).  The information
     might still be useful for revision history links.

  *  Otherwise, the content is unidentified by HTTP, but a more
     specific identifier might be supplied within the content itself.

  For a response message, the following rules are applied in order
  until a match is found:

  1.  If the request method is HEAD or the response status code is 204
      (No Content) or 304 (Not Modified), there is no content in the
      response.

  2.  If the request method is GET and the response status code is 200
      (OK), the content is a representation of the target resource
      (Section 7.1).

  3.  If the request method is GET and the response status code is 203
      (Non-Authoritative Information), the content is a potentially
      modified or enhanced representation of the target resource as
      provided by an intermediary.

  4.  If the request method is GET and the response status code is 206
      (Partial Content), the content is one or more parts of a
      representation of the target resource.

  5.  If the response has a Content-Location header field and its field
      value is a reference to the same URI as the target URI, the
      content is a representation of the target resource.

  6.  If the response has a Content-Location header field and its field
      value is a reference to a URI different from the target URI, then
      the sender asserts that the content is a representation of the
      resource identified by the Content-Location field value.
      However, such an assertion cannot be trusted unless it can be
      verified by other means (not defined by this specification).

  7.  Otherwise, the content is unidentified by HTTP, but a more
      specific identifier might be supplied within the content itself.

6.5.  Trailer Fields

  Fields (Section 5) that are located within a "trailer section" are
  referred to as "trailer fields" (or just "trailers", colloquially).
  Trailer fields can be useful for supplying message integrity checks,
  digital signatures, delivery metrics, or post-processing status
  information.

  Trailer fields ought to be processed and stored separately from the
  fields in the header section to avoid contradicting message semantics
  known at the time the header section was complete.  The presence or
  absence of certain header fields might impact choices made for the
  routing or processing of the message as a whole before the trailers
  are received; those choices cannot be unmade by the later discovery
  of trailer fields.

6.5.1.  Limitations on Use of Trailers

  A trailer section is only possible when supported by the version of
  HTTP in use and enabled by an explicit framing mechanism.  For
  example, the chunked transfer coding in HTTP/1.1 allows a trailer
  section to be sent after the content (Section 7.1.2 of [HTTP/1.1]).

  Many fields cannot be processed outside the header section because
  their evaluation is necessary prior to receiving the content, such as
  those that describe message framing, routing, authentication, request
  modifiers, response controls, or content format.  A sender MUST NOT
  generate a trailer field unless the sender knows the corresponding
  header field name's definition permits the field to be sent in
  trailers.

  Trailer fields can be difficult to process by intermediaries that
  forward messages from one protocol version to another.  If the entire
  message can be buffered in transit, some intermediaries could merge
  trailer fields into the header section (as appropriate) before it is
  forwarded.  However, in most cases, the trailers are simply
  discarded.  A recipient MUST NOT merge a trailer field into a header
  section unless the recipient understands the corresponding header
  field definition and that definition explicitly permits and defines
  how trailer field values can be safely merged.

  The presence of the keyword "trailers" in the TE header field
  (Section 10.1.4) of a request indicates that the client is willing to
  accept trailer fields, on behalf of itself and any downstream
  clients.  For requests from an intermediary, this implies that all
  downstream clients are willing to accept trailer fields in the
  forwarded response.  Note that the presence of "trailers" does not
  mean that the client(s) will process any particular trailer field in
  the response; only that the trailer section(s) will not be dropped by
  any of the clients.

  Because of the potential for trailer fields to be discarded in
  transit, a server SHOULD NOT generate trailer fields that it believes
  are necessary for the user agent to receive.

6.5.2.  Processing Trailer Fields

  The "Trailer" header field (Section 6.6.2) can be sent to indicate
  fields likely to be sent in the trailer section, which allows
  recipients to prepare for their receipt before processing the
  content.  For example, this could be useful if a field name indicates
  that a dynamic checksum should be calculated as the content is
  received and then immediately checked upon receipt of the trailer
  field value.

  Like header fields, trailer fields with the same name are processed
  in the order received; multiple trailer field lines with the same
  name have the equivalent semantics as appending the multiple values
  as a list of members.  Trailer fields that might be generated more
  than once during a message MUST be defined as a list-based field even
  if each member value is only processed once per field line received.

  At the end of a message, a recipient MAY treat the set of received
  trailer fields as a data structure of name/value pairs, similar to
  (but separate from) the header fields.  Additional processing
  expectations, if any, can be defined within the field specification
  for a field intended for use in trailers.

6.6.  Message Metadata

  Fields that describe the message itself, such as when and how the
  message has been generated, can appear in both requests and
  responses.

6.6.1.  Date

  The "Date" header field represents the date and time at which the
  message was originated, having the same semantics as the Origination
  Date Field (orig-date) defined in Section 3.6.1 of [RFC5322].  The
  field value is an HTTP-date, as defined in Section 5.6.7.

    Date = HTTP-date

  An example is

  Date: Tue, 15 Nov 1994 08:12:31 GMT

  A sender that generates a Date header field SHOULD generate its field
  value as the best available approximation of the date and time of
  message generation.  In theory, the date ought to represent the
  moment just before generating the message content.  In practice, a
  sender can generate the date value at any time during message
  origination.

  An origin server with a clock (as defined in Section 5.6.7) MUST
  generate a Date header field in all 2xx (Successful), 3xx
  (Redirection), and 4xx (Client Error) responses, and MAY generate a
  Date header field in 1xx (Informational) and 5xx (Server Error)
  responses.

  An origin server without a clock MUST NOT generate a Date header
  field.

  A recipient with a clock that receives a response message without a
  Date header field MUST record the time it was received and append a
  corresponding Date header field to the message's header section if it
  is cached or forwarded downstream.

  A recipient with a clock that receives a response with an invalid
  Date header field value MAY replace that value with the time that
  response was received.

  A user agent MAY send a Date header field in a request, though
  generally will not do so unless it is believed to convey useful
  information to the server.  For example, custom applications of HTTP
  might convey a Date if the server is expected to adjust its
  interpretation of the user's request based on differences between the
  user agent and server clocks.

6.6.2.  Trailer

  The "Trailer" header field provides a list of field names that the
  sender anticipates sending as trailer fields within that message.
  This allows a recipient to prepare for receipt of the indicated
  metadata before it starts processing the content.

    Trailer = #field-name

  For example, a sender might indicate that a signature will be
  computed as the content is being streamed and provide the final
  signature as a trailer field.  This allows a recipient to perform the
  same check on the fly as it receives the content.

  A sender that intends to generate one or more trailer fields in a
  message SHOULD generate a Trailer header field in the header section
  of that message to indicate which fields might be present in the
  trailers.

  If an intermediary discards the trailer section in transit, the
  Trailer field could provide a hint of what metadata was lost, though
  there is no guarantee that a sender of Trailer will always follow
  through by sending the named fields.

7.  Routing HTTP Messages

  HTTP request message routing is determined by each client based on
  the target resource, the client's proxy configuration, and
  establishment or reuse of an inbound connection.  The corresponding
  response routing follows the same connection chain back to the
  client.

7.1.  Determining the Target Resource

  Although HTTP is used in a wide variety of applications, most clients
  rely on the same resource identification mechanism and configuration
  techniques as general-purpose Web browsers.  Even when communication
  options are hard-coded in a client's configuration, we can think of
  their combined effect as a URI reference (Section 4.1).

  A URI reference is resolved to its absolute form in order to obtain
  the "target URI".  The target URI excludes the reference's fragment
  component, if any, since fragment identifiers are reserved for
  client-side processing ([URI], Section 3.5).

  To perform an action on a "target resource", the client sends a
  request message containing enough components of its parsed target URI
  to enable recipients to identify that same resource.  For historical
  reasons, the parsed target URI components, collectively referred to
  as the "request target", are sent within the message control data and
  the Host header field (Section 7.2).

  There are two unusual cases for which the request target components
  are in a method-specific form:

  *  For CONNECT (Section 9.3.6), the request target is the host name
     and port number of the tunnel destination, separated by a colon.

  *  For OPTIONS (Section 9.3.7), the request target can be a single
     asterisk ("*").

  See the respective method definitions for details.  These forms MUST
  NOT be used with other methods.

  Upon receipt of a client's request, a server reconstructs the target
  URI from the received components in accordance with their local
  configuration and incoming connection context.  This reconstruction
  is specific to each major protocol version.  For example, Section 3.3
  of [HTTP/1.1] defines how a server determines the target URI of an
  HTTP/1.1 request.

     |  *Note:* Previous specifications defined the recomposed target
     |  URI as a distinct concept, the "effective request URI".

7.2.  Host and :authority

  The "Host" header field in a request provides the host and port
  information from the target URI, enabling the origin server to
  distinguish among resources while servicing requests for multiple
  host names.

  In HTTP/2 [HTTP/2] and HTTP/3 [HTTP/3], the Host header field is, in
  some cases, supplanted by the ":authority" pseudo-header field of a
  request's control data.

    Host = uri-host [ ":" port ] ; Section 4

  The target URI's authority information is critical for handling a
  request.  A user agent MUST generate a Host header field in a request
  unless it sends that information as an ":authority" pseudo-header
  field.  A user agent that sends Host SHOULD send it as the first
  field in the header section of a request.

  For example, a GET request to the origin server for
  <http://www.example.org/pub/WWW/> would begin with:

  GET /pub/WWW/ HTTP/1.1
  Host: www.example.org

  Since the host and port information acts as an application-level
  routing mechanism, it is a frequent target for malware seeking to
  poison a shared cache or redirect a request to an unintended server.
  An interception proxy is particularly vulnerable if it relies on the
  host and port information for redirecting requests to internal
  servers, or for use as a cache key in a shared cache, without first
  verifying that the intercepted connection is targeting a valid IP
  address for that host.

7.3.  Routing Inbound Requests

  Once the target URI and its origin are determined, a client decides
  whether a network request is necessary to accomplish the desired
  semantics and, if so, where that request is to be directed.

7.3.1.  To a Cache

  If the client has a cache [CACHING] and the request can be satisfied
  by it, then the request is usually directed there first.

7.3.2.  To a Proxy

  If the request is not satisfied by a cache, then a typical client
  will check its configuration to determine whether a proxy is to be
  used to satisfy the request.  Proxy configuration is implementation-
  dependent, but is often based on URI prefix matching, selective
  authority matching, or both, and the proxy itself is usually
  identified by an "http" or "https" URI.

  If an "http" or "https" proxy is applicable, the client connects
  inbound by establishing (or reusing) a connection to that proxy and
  then sending it an HTTP request message containing a request target
  that matches the client's target URI.

7.3.3.  To the Origin

  If no proxy is applicable, a typical client will invoke a handler
  routine (specific to the target URI's scheme) to obtain access to the
  identified resource.  How that is accomplished is dependent on the
  target URI scheme and defined by its associated specification.

  Section 4.3.2 defines how to obtain access to an "http" resource by
  establishing (or reusing) an inbound connection to the identified
  origin server and then sending it an HTTP request message containing
  a request target that matches the client's target URI.

  Section 4.3.3 defines how to obtain access to an "https" resource by
  establishing (or reusing) an inbound secured connection to an origin
  server that is authoritative for the identified origin and then
  sending it an HTTP request message containing a request target that
  matches the client's target URI.

7.4.  Rejecting Misdirected Requests

  Once a request is received by a server and parsed sufficiently to
  determine its target URI, the server decides whether to process the
  request itself, forward the request to another server, redirect the
  client to a different resource, respond with an error, or drop the
  connection.  This decision can be influenced by anything about the
  request or connection context, but is specifically directed at
  whether the server has been configured to process requests for that
  target URI and whether the connection context is appropriate for that
  request.

  For example, a request might have been misdirected, deliberately or
  accidentally, such that the information within a received Host header
  field differs from the connection's host or port.  If the connection
  is from a trusted gateway, such inconsistency might be expected;
  otherwise, it might indicate an attempt to bypass security filters,
  trick the server into delivering non-public content, or poison a
  cache.  See Section 17 for security considerations regarding message
  routing.

  Unless the connection is from a trusted gateway, an origin server
  MUST reject a request if any scheme-specific requirements for the
  target URI are not met.  In particular, a request for an "https"
  resource MUST be rejected unless it has been received over a
  connection that has been secured via a certificate valid for that
  target URI's origin, as defined by Section 4.2.2.

  The 421 (Misdirected Request) status code in a response indicates
  that the origin server has rejected the request because it appears to
  have been misdirected (Section 15.5.20).

7.5.  Response Correlation

  A connection might be used for multiple request/response exchanges.
  The mechanism used to correlate between request and response messages
  is version dependent; some versions of HTTP use implicit ordering of
  messages, while others use an explicit identifier.

  All responses, regardless of the status code (including interim
  responses) can be sent at any time after a request is received, even
  if the request is not yet complete.  A response can complete before
  its corresponding request is complete (Section 6.1).  Likewise,
  clients are not expected to wait any specific amount of time for a
  response.  Clients (including intermediaries) might abandon a request
  if the response is not received within a reasonable period of time.

  A client that receives a response while it is still sending the
  associated request SHOULD continue sending that request unless it
  receives an explicit indication to the contrary (see, e.g.,
  Section 9.5 of [HTTP/1.1] and Section 6.4 of [HTTP/2]).

7.6.  Message Forwarding

  As described in Section 3.7, intermediaries can serve a variety of
  roles in the processing of HTTP requests and responses.  Some
  intermediaries are used to improve performance or availability.
  Others are used for access control or to filter content.  Since an
  HTTP stream has characteristics similar to a pipe-and-filter
  architecture, there are no inherent limits to the extent an
  intermediary can enhance (or interfere) with either direction of the
  stream.

  Intermediaries are expected to forward messages even when protocol
  elements are not recognized (e.g., new methods, status codes, or
  field names) since that preserves extensibility for downstream
  recipients.

  An intermediary not acting as a tunnel MUST implement the Connection
  header field, as specified in Section 7.6.1, and exclude fields from
  being forwarded that are only intended for the incoming connection.

  An intermediary MUST NOT forward a message to itself unless it is
  protected from an infinite request loop.  In general, an intermediary
  ought to recognize its own server names, including any aliases, local
  variations, or literal IP addresses, and respond to such requests
  directly.

  An HTTP message can be parsed as a stream for incremental processing
  or forwarding downstream.  However, senders and recipients cannot
  rely on incremental delivery of partial messages, since some
  implementations will buffer or delay message forwarding for the sake
  of network efficiency, security checks, or content transformations.

7.6.1.  Connection

  The "Connection" header field allows the sender to list desired
  control options for the current connection.

    Connection        = #connection-option
    connection-option = token

  Connection options are case-insensitive.

  When a field aside from Connection is used to supply control
  information for or about the current connection, the sender MUST list
  the corresponding field name within the Connection header field.
  Note that some versions of HTTP prohibit the use of fields for such
  information, and therefore do not allow the Connection field.

  Intermediaries MUST parse a received Connection header field before a
  message is forwarded and, for each connection-option in this field,
  remove any header or trailer field(s) from the message with the same
  name as the connection-option, and then remove the Connection header
  field itself (or replace it with the intermediary's own control
  options for the forwarded message).

  Hence, the Connection header field provides a declarative way of
  distinguishing fields that are only intended for the immediate
  recipient ("hop-by-hop") from those fields that are intended for all
  recipients on the chain ("end-to-end"), enabling the message to be
  self-descriptive and allowing future connection-specific extensions
  to be deployed without fear that they will be blindly forwarded by
  older intermediaries.

  Furthermore, intermediaries SHOULD remove or replace fields that are
  known to require removal before forwarding, whether or not they
  appear as a connection-option, after applying those fields'
  semantics.  This includes but is not limited to:

  *  Proxy-Connection (Appendix C.2.2 of [HTTP/1.1])

  *  Keep-Alive (Section 19.7.1 of [RFC2068])

  *  TE (Section 10.1.4)

  *  Transfer-Encoding (Section 6.1 of [HTTP/1.1])

  *  Upgrade (Section 7.8)

  A sender MUST NOT send a connection option corresponding to a field
  that is intended for all recipients of the content.  For example,
  Cache-Control is never appropriate as a connection option
  (Section 5.2 of [CACHING]).

  Connection options do not always correspond to a field present in the
  message, since a connection-specific field might not be needed if
  there are no parameters associated with a connection option.  In
  contrast, a connection-specific field received without a
  corresponding connection option usually indicates that the field has
  been improperly forwarded by an intermediary and ought to be ignored
  by the recipient.

  When defining a new connection option that does not correspond to a
  field, specification authors ought to reserve the corresponding field
  name anyway in order to avoid later collisions.  Such reserved field
  names are registered in the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Field
  Name Registry" (Section 16.3.1).

7.6.2.  Max-Forwards

  The "Max-Forwards" header field provides a mechanism with the TRACE
  (Section 9.3.8) and OPTIONS (Section 9.3.7) request methods to limit
  the number of times that the request is forwarded by proxies.  This
  can be useful when the client is attempting to trace a request that
  appears to be failing or looping mid-chain.

    Max-Forwards = 1*DIGIT

  The Max-Forwards value is a decimal integer indicating the remaining
  number of times this request message can be forwarded.

  Each intermediary that receives a TRACE or OPTIONS request containing
  a Max-Forwards header field MUST check and update its value prior to
  forwarding the request.  If the received value is zero (0), the
  intermediary MUST NOT forward the request; instead, the intermediary
  MUST respond as the final recipient.  If the received Max-Forwards
  value is greater than zero, the intermediary MUST generate an updated
  Max-Forwards field in the forwarded message with a field value that
  is the lesser of a) the received value decremented by one (1) or b)
  the recipient's maximum supported value for Max-Forwards.

  A recipient MAY ignore a Max-Forwards header field received with any
  other request methods.

7.6.3.  Via

  The "Via" header field indicates the presence of intermediate
  protocols and recipients between the user agent and the server (on
  requests) or between the origin server and the client (on responses),
  similar to the "Received" header field in email (Section 3.6.7 of
  [RFC5322]).  Via can be used for tracking message forwards, avoiding
  request loops, and identifying the protocol capabilities of senders
  along the request/response chain.

    Via = #( received-protocol RWS received-by [ RWS comment ] )

    received-protocol = [ protocol-name "/" ] protocol-version
                      ; see Section 7.8
    received-by       = pseudonym [ ":" port ]
    pseudonym         = token

  Each member of the Via field value represents a proxy or gateway that
  has forwarded the message.  Each intermediary appends its own
  information about how the message was received, such that the end
  result is ordered according to the sequence of forwarding recipients.

  A proxy MUST send an appropriate Via header field, as described
  below, in each message that it forwards.  An HTTP-to-HTTP gateway
  MUST send an appropriate Via header field in each inbound request
  message and MAY send a Via header field in forwarded response
  messages.

  For each intermediary, the received-protocol indicates the protocol
  and protocol version used by the upstream sender of the message.
  Hence, the Via field value records the advertised protocol
  capabilities of the request/response chain such that they remain
  visible to downstream recipients; this can be useful for determining
  what backwards-incompatible features might be safe to use in
  response, or within a later request, as described in Section 2.5.
  For brevity, the protocol-name is omitted when the received protocol
  is HTTP.

  The received-by portion is normally the host and optional port number
  of a recipient server or client that subsequently forwarded the
  message.  However, if the real host is considered to be sensitive
  information, a sender MAY replace it with a pseudonym.  If a port is
  not provided, a recipient MAY interpret that as meaning it was
  received on the default port, if any, for the received-protocol.

  A sender MAY generate comments to identify the software of each
  recipient, analogous to the User-Agent and Server header fields.
  However, comments in Via are optional, and a recipient MAY remove
  them prior to forwarding the message.

  For example, a request message could be sent from an HTTP/1.0 user
  agent to an internal proxy code-named "fred", which uses HTTP/1.1 to
  forward the request to a public proxy at p.example.net, which
  completes the request by forwarding it to the origin server at
  www.example.com.  The request received by www.example.com would then
  have the following Via header field:

  Via: 1.0 fred, 1.1 p.example.net

  An intermediary used as a portal through a network firewall SHOULD
  NOT forward the names and ports of hosts within the firewall region
  unless it is explicitly enabled to do so.  If not enabled, such an
  intermediary SHOULD replace each received-by host of any host behind
  the firewall by an appropriate pseudonym for that host.

  An intermediary MAY combine an ordered subsequence of Via header
  field list members into a single member if the entries have identical
  received-protocol values.  For example,

  Via: 1.0 ricky, 1.1 ethel, 1.1 fred, 1.0 lucy

  could be collapsed to

  Via: 1.0 ricky, 1.1 mertz, 1.0 lucy

  A sender SHOULD NOT combine multiple list members unless they are all
  under the same organizational control and the hosts have already been
  replaced by pseudonyms.  A sender MUST NOT combine members that have
  different received-protocol values.

7.7.  Message Transformations

  Some intermediaries include features for transforming messages and
  their content.  A proxy might, for example, convert between image
  formats in order to save cache space or to reduce the amount of
  traffic on a slow link.  However, operational problems might occur
  when these transformations are applied to content intended for
  critical applications, such as medical imaging or scientific data
  analysis, particularly when integrity checks or digital signatures
  are used to ensure that the content received is identical to the
  original.

  An HTTP-to-HTTP proxy is called a "transforming proxy" if it is
  designed or configured to modify messages in a semantically
  meaningful way (i.e., modifications, beyond those required by normal
  HTTP processing, that change the message in a way that would be
  significant to the original sender or potentially significant to
  downstream recipients).  For example, a transforming proxy might be
  acting as a shared annotation server (modifying responses to include
  references to a local annotation database), a malware filter, a
  format transcoder, or a privacy filter.  Such transformations are
  presumed to be desired by whichever client (or client organization)
  chose the proxy.

  If a proxy receives a target URI with a host name that is not a fully
  qualified domain name, it MAY add its own domain to the host name it
  received when forwarding the request.  A proxy MUST NOT change the
  host name if the target URI contains a fully qualified domain name.

  A proxy MUST NOT modify the "absolute-path" and "query" parts of the
  received target URI when forwarding it to the next inbound server
  except as required by that forwarding protocol.  For example, a proxy
  forwarding a request to an origin server via HTTP/1.1 will replace an
  empty path with "/" (Section 3.2.1 of [HTTP/1.1]) or "*"
  (Section 3.2.4 of [HTTP/1.1]), depending on the request method.

  A proxy MUST NOT transform the content (Section 6.4) of a response
  message that contains a no-transform cache directive (Section 5.2.2.6
  of [CACHING]).  Note that this does not apply to message
  transformations that do not change the content, such as the addition
  or removal of transfer codings (Section 7 of [HTTP/1.1]).

  A proxy MAY transform the content of a message that does not contain
  a no-transform cache directive.  A proxy that transforms the content
  of a 200 (OK) response can inform downstream recipients that a
  transformation has been applied by changing the response status code
  to 203 (Non-Authoritative Information) (Section 15.3.4).

  A proxy SHOULD NOT modify header fields that provide information
  about the endpoints of the communication chain, the resource state,
  or the selected representation (other than the content) unless the
  field's definition specifically allows such modification or the
  modification is deemed necessary for privacy or security.

7.8.  Upgrade

  The "Upgrade" header field is intended to provide a simple mechanism
  for transitioning from HTTP/1.1 to some other protocol on the same
  connection.

  A client MAY send a list of protocol names in the Upgrade header
  field of a request to invite the server to switch to one or more of
  the named protocols, in order of descending preference, before
  sending the final response.  A server MAY ignore a received Upgrade
  header field if it wishes to continue using the current protocol on
  that connection.  Upgrade cannot be used to insist on a protocol
  change.

    Upgrade          = #protocol

    protocol         = protocol-name ["/" protocol-version]
    protocol-name    = token
    protocol-version = token

  Although protocol names are registered with a preferred case,
  recipients SHOULD use case-insensitive comparison when matching each
  protocol-name to supported protocols.

  A server that sends a 101 (Switching Protocols) response MUST send an
  Upgrade header field to indicate the new protocol(s) to which the
  connection is being switched; if multiple protocol layers are being
  switched, the sender MUST list the protocols in layer-ascending
  order.  A server MUST NOT switch to a protocol that was not indicated
  by the client in the corresponding request's Upgrade header field.  A
  server MAY choose to ignore the order of preference indicated by the
  client and select the new protocol(s) based on other factors, such as
  the nature of the request or the current load on the server.

  A server that sends a 426 (Upgrade Required) response MUST send an
  Upgrade header field to indicate the acceptable protocols, in order
  of descending preference.

  A server MAY send an Upgrade header field in any other response to
  advertise that it implements support for upgrading to the listed
  protocols, in order of descending preference, when appropriate for a
  future request.

  The following is a hypothetical example sent by a client:

  GET /hello HTTP/1.1
  Host: www.example.com
  Connection: upgrade
  Upgrade: websocket, IRC/6.9, RTA/x11

  The capabilities and nature of the application-level communication
  after the protocol change is entirely dependent upon the new
  protocol(s) chosen.  However, immediately after sending the 101
  (Switching Protocols) response, the server is expected to continue
  responding to the original request as if it had received its
  equivalent within the new protocol (i.e., the server still has an
  outstanding request to satisfy after the protocol has been changed,
  and is expected to do so without requiring the request to be
  repeated).

  For example, if the Upgrade header field is received in a GET request
  and the server decides to switch protocols, it first responds with a
  101 (Switching Protocols) message in HTTP/1.1 and then immediately
  follows that with the new protocol's equivalent of a response to a
  GET on the target resource.  This allows a connection to be upgraded
  to protocols with the same semantics as HTTP without the latency cost
  of an additional round trip.  A server MUST NOT switch protocols
  unless the received message semantics can be honored by the new
  protocol; an OPTIONS request can be honored by any protocol.

  The following is an example response to the above hypothetical
  request:

  HTTP/1.1 101 Switching Protocols
  Connection: upgrade
  Upgrade: websocket

  [... data stream switches to websocket with an appropriate response
  (as defined by new protocol) to the "GET /hello" request ...]

  A sender of Upgrade MUST also send an "Upgrade" connection option in
  the Connection header field (Section 7.6.1) to inform intermediaries
  not to forward this field.  A server that receives an Upgrade header
  field in an HTTP/1.0 request MUST ignore that Upgrade field.

  A client cannot begin using an upgraded protocol on the connection
  until it has completely sent the request message (i.e., the client
  can't change the protocol it is sending in the middle of a message).
  If a server receives both an Upgrade and an Expect header field with
  the "100-continue" expectation (Section 10.1.1), the server MUST send
  a 100 (Continue) response before sending a 101 (Switching Protocols)
  response.

  The Upgrade header field only applies to switching protocols on top
  of the existing connection; it cannot be used to switch the
  underlying connection (transport) protocol, nor to switch the
  existing communication to a different connection.  For those
  purposes, it is more appropriate to use a 3xx (Redirection) response
  (Section 15.4).

  This specification only defines the protocol name "HTTP" for use by
  the family of Hypertext Transfer Protocols, as defined by the HTTP
  version rules of Section 2.5 and future updates to this
  specification.  Additional protocol names ought to be registered
  using the registration procedure defined in Section 16.7.

8.  Representation Data and Metadata

8.1.  Representation Data

  The representation data associated with an HTTP message is either
  provided as the content of the message or referred to by the message
  semantics and the target URI.  The representation data is in a format
  and encoding defined by the representation metadata header fields.

  The data type of the representation data is determined via the header
  fields Content-Type and Content-Encoding.  These define a two-layer,
  ordered encoding model:

    representation-data := Content-Encoding( Content-Type( data ) )

8.2.  Representation Metadata

  Representation header fields provide metadata about the
  representation.  When a message includes content, the representation
  header fields describe how to interpret that data.  In a response to
  a HEAD request, the representation header fields describe the
  representation data that would have been enclosed in the content if
  the same request had been a GET.

8.3.  Content-Type

  The "Content-Type" header field indicates the media type of the
  associated representation: either the representation enclosed in the
  message content or the selected representation, as determined by the
  message semantics.  The indicated media type defines both the data
  format and how that data is intended to be processed by a recipient,
  within the scope of the received message semantics, after any content
  codings indicated by Content-Encoding are decoded.

    Content-Type = media-type

  Media types are defined in Section 8.3.1.  An example of the field is

  Content-Type: text/html; charset=ISO-8859-4

  A sender that generates a message containing content SHOULD generate
  a Content-Type header field in that message unless the intended media
  type of the enclosed representation is unknown to the sender.  If a
  Content-Type header field is not present, the recipient MAY either
  assume a media type of "application/octet-stream" ([RFC2046],
  Section 4.5.1) or examine the data to determine its type.

  In practice, resource owners do not always properly configure their
  origin server to provide the correct Content-Type for a given
  representation.  Some user agents examine the content and, in certain
  cases, override the received type (for example, see [Sniffing]).
  This "MIME sniffing" risks drawing incorrect conclusions about the
  data, which might expose the user to additional security risks (e.g.,
  "privilege escalation").  Furthermore, distinct media types often
  share a common data format, differing only in how the data is
  intended to be processed, which is impossible to distinguish by
  inspecting the data alone.  When sniffing is implemented,
  implementers are encouraged to provide a means for the user to
  disable it.

  Although Content-Type is defined as a singleton field, it is
  sometimes incorrectly generated multiple times, resulting in a
  combined field value that appears to be a list.  Recipients often
  attempt to handle this error by using the last syntactically valid
  member of the list, leading to potential interoperability and
  security issues if different implementations have different error
  handling behaviors.

8.3.1.  Media Type

  HTTP uses media types [RFC2046] in the Content-Type (Section 8.3) and
  Accept (Section 12.5.1) header fields in order to provide open and
  extensible data typing and type negotiation.  Media types define both
  a data format and various processing models: how to process that data
  in accordance with the message context.

    media-type = type "/" subtype parameters
    type       = token
    subtype    = token

  The type and subtype tokens are case-insensitive.

  The type/subtype MAY be followed by semicolon-delimited parameters
  (Section 5.6.6) in the form of name/value pairs.  The presence or
  absence of a parameter might be significant to the processing of a
  media type, depending on its definition within the media type
  registry.  Parameter values might or might not be case-sensitive,
  depending on the semantics of the parameter name.

  For example, the following media types are equivalent in describing
  HTML text data encoded in the UTF-8 character encoding scheme, but
  the first is preferred for consistency (the "charset" parameter value
  is defined as being case-insensitive in [RFC2046], Section 4.1.2):

    text/html;charset=utf-8
    Text/HTML;Charset="utf-8"
    text/html; charset="utf-8"
    text/html;charset=UTF-8

  Media types ought to be registered with IANA according to the
  procedures defined in [BCP13].

8.3.2.  Charset

  HTTP uses "charset" names to indicate or negotiate the character
  encoding scheme ([RFC6365], Section 2) of a textual representation.
  In the fields defined by this document, charset names appear either
  in parameters (Content-Type), or, for Accept-Encoding, in the form of
  a plain token.  In both cases, charset names are matched case-
  insensitively.

  Charset names ought to be registered in the IANA "Character Sets"
  registry (<https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets>)
  according to the procedures defined in Section 2 of [RFC2978].

     |  *Note:* In theory, charset names are defined by the "mime-
     |  charset" ABNF rule defined in Section 2.3 of [RFC2978] (as
     |  corrected in [Err1912]).  That rule allows two characters that
     |  are not included in "token" ("{" and "}"), but no charset name
     |  registered at the time of this writing includes braces (see
     |  [Err5433]).

8.3.3.  Multipart Types

  MIME provides for a number of "multipart" types -- encapsulations of
  one or more representations within a single message body.  All
  multipart types share a common syntax, as defined in Section 5.1.1 of
  [RFC2046], and include a boundary parameter as part of the media type
  value.  The message body is itself a protocol element; a sender MUST
  generate only CRLF to represent line breaks between body parts.

  HTTP message framing does not use the multipart boundary as an
  indicator of message body length, though it might be used by
  implementations that generate or process the content.  For example,
  the "multipart/form-data" type is often used for carrying form data
  in a request, as described in [RFC7578], and the "multipart/
  byteranges" type is defined by this specification for use in some 206
  (Partial Content) responses (see Section 15.3.7).

8.4.  Content-Encoding

  The "Content-Encoding" header field indicates what content codings
  have been applied to the representation, beyond those inherent in the
  media type, and thus what decoding mechanisms have to be applied in
  order to obtain data in the media type referenced by the Content-Type
  header field.  Content-Encoding is primarily used to allow a
  representation's data to be compressed without losing the identity of
  its underlying media type.

    Content-Encoding = #content-coding

  An example of its use is

  Content-Encoding: gzip

  If one or more encodings have been applied to a representation, the
  sender that applied the encodings MUST generate a Content-Encoding
  header field that lists the content codings in the order in which
  they were applied.  Note that the coding named "identity" is reserved
  for its special role in Accept-Encoding and thus SHOULD NOT be
  included.

  Additional information about the encoding parameters can be provided
  by other header fields not defined by this specification.

  Unlike Transfer-Encoding (Section 6.1 of [HTTP/1.1]), the codings
  listed in Content-Encoding are a characteristic of the
  representation; the representation is defined in terms of the coded
  form, and all other metadata about the representation is about the
  coded form unless otherwise noted in the metadata definition.
  Typically, the representation is only decoded just prior to rendering
  or analogous usage.

  If the media type includes an inherent encoding, such as a data
  format that is always compressed, then that encoding would not be
  restated in Content-Encoding even if it happens to be the same
  algorithm as one of the content codings.  Such a content coding would
  only be listed if, for some bizarre reason, it is applied a second
  time to form the representation.  Likewise, an origin server might
  choose to publish the same data as multiple representations that
  differ only in whether the coding is defined as part of Content-Type
  or Content-Encoding, since some user agents will behave differently
  in their handling of each response (e.g., open a "Save as ..." dialog
  instead of automatic decompression and rendering of content).

  An origin server MAY respond with a status code of 415 (Unsupported
  Media Type) if a representation in the request message has a content
  coding that is not acceptable.

8.4.1.  Content Codings

  Content coding values indicate an encoding transformation that has
  been or can be applied to a representation.  Content codings are
  primarily used to allow a representation to be compressed or
  otherwise usefully transformed without losing the identity of its
  underlying media type and without loss of information.  Frequently,
  the representation is stored in coded form, transmitted directly, and
  only decoded by the final recipient.

    content-coding   = token

  All content codings are case-insensitive and ought to be registered
  within the "HTTP Content Coding Registry", as described in
  Section 16.6

  Content-coding values are used in the Accept-Encoding
  (Section 12.5.3) and Content-Encoding (Section 8.4) header fields.

8.4.1.1.  Compress Coding

  The "compress" coding is an adaptive Lempel-Ziv-Welch (LZW) coding
  [Welch] that is commonly produced by the UNIX file compression
  program "compress".  A recipient SHOULD consider "x-compress" to be
  equivalent to "compress".

8.4.1.2.  Deflate Coding

  The "deflate" coding is a "zlib" data format [RFC1950] containing a
  "deflate" compressed data stream [RFC1951] that uses a combination of
  the Lempel-Ziv (LZ77) compression algorithm and Huffman coding.

     |  *Note:* Some non-conformant implementations send the "deflate"
     |  compressed data without the zlib wrapper.

8.4.1.3.  Gzip Coding

  The "gzip" coding is an LZ77 coding with a 32-bit Cyclic Redundancy
  Check (CRC) that is commonly produced by the gzip file compression
  program [RFC1952].  A recipient SHOULD consider "x-gzip" to be
  equivalent to "gzip".

8.5.  Content-Language

  The "Content-Language" header field describes the natural language(s)
  of the intended audience for the representation.  Note that this
  might not be equivalent to all the languages used within the
  representation.

    Content-Language = #language-tag

  Language tags are defined in Section 8.5.1.  The primary purpose of
  Content-Language is to allow a user to identify and differentiate
  representations according to the users' own preferred language.
  Thus, if the content is intended only for a Danish-literate audience,
  the appropriate field is

  Content-Language: da

  If no Content-Language is specified, the default is that the content
  is intended for all language audiences.  This might mean that the
  sender does not consider it to be specific to any natural language,
  or that the sender does not know for which language it is intended.

  Multiple languages MAY be listed for content that is intended for
  multiple audiences.  For example, a rendition of the "Treaty of
  Waitangi", presented simultaneously in the original Maori and English
  versions, would call for

  Content-Language: mi, en

  However, just because multiple languages are present within a
  representation does not mean that it is intended for multiple
  linguistic audiences.  An example would be a beginner's language
  primer, such as "A First Lesson in Latin", which is clearly intended
  to be used by an English-literate audience.  In this case, the
  Content-Language would properly only include "en".

  Content-Language MAY be applied to any media type -- it is not
  limited to textual documents.

8.5.1.  Language Tags

  A language tag, as defined in [RFC5646], identifies a natural
  language spoken, written, or otherwise conveyed by human beings for
  communication of information to other human beings.  Computer
  languages are explicitly excluded.

  HTTP uses language tags within the Accept-Language and
  Content-Language header fields.  Accept-Language uses the broader
  language-range production defined in Section 12.5.4, whereas
  Content-Language uses the language-tag production defined below.

    language-tag = <Language-Tag, see [RFC5646], Section 2.1>

  A language tag is a sequence of one or more case-insensitive subtags,
  each separated by a hyphen character ("-", %x2D).  In most cases, a
  language tag consists of a primary language subtag that identifies a
  broad family of related languages (e.g., "en" = English), which is
  optionally followed by a series of subtags that refine or narrow that
  language's range (e.g., "en-CA" = the variety of English as
  communicated in Canada).  Whitespace is not allowed within a language
  tag.  Example tags include:

    fr, en-US, es-419, az-Arab, x-pig-latin, man-Nkoo-GN

  See [RFC5646] for further information.

8.6.  Content-Length

  The "Content-Length" header field indicates the associated
  representation's data length as a decimal non-negative integer number
  of octets.  When transferring a representation as content, Content-
  Length refers specifically to the amount of data enclosed so that it
  can be used to delimit framing (e.g., Section 6.2 of [HTTP/1.1]).  In
  other cases, Content-Length indicates the selected representation's
  current length, which can be used by recipients to estimate transfer
  time or to compare with previously stored representations.

    Content-Length = 1*DIGIT

  An example is

  Content-Length: 3495

  A user agent SHOULD send Content-Length in a request when the method
  defines a meaning for enclosed content and it is not sending
  Transfer-Encoding.  For example, a user agent normally sends Content-
  Length in a POST request even when the value is 0 (indicating empty
  content).  A user agent SHOULD NOT send a Content-Length header field
  when the request message does not contain content and the method
  semantics do not anticipate such data.

  A server MAY send a Content-Length header field in a response to a
  HEAD request (Section 9.3.2); a server MUST NOT send Content-Length
  in such a response unless its field value equals the decimal number
  of octets that would have been sent in the content of a response if
  the same request had used the GET method.

  A server MAY send a Content-Length header field in a 304 (Not
  Modified) response to a conditional GET request (Section 15.4.5); a
  server MUST NOT send Content-Length in such a response unless its
  field value equals the decimal number of octets that would have been
  sent in the content of a 200 (OK) response to the same request.

  A server MUST NOT send a Content-Length header field in any response
  with a status code of 1xx (Informational) or 204 (No Content).  A
  server MUST NOT send a Content-Length header field in any 2xx
  (Successful) response to a CONNECT request (Section 9.3.6).

  Aside from the cases defined above, in the absence of Transfer-
  Encoding, an origin server SHOULD send a Content-Length header field
  when the content size is known prior to sending the complete header
  section.  This will allow downstream recipients to measure transfer
  progress, know when a received message is complete, and potentially
  reuse the connection for additional requests.

  Any Content-Length field value greater than or equal to zero is
  valid.  Since there is no predefined limit to the length of content,
  a recipient MUST anticipate potentially large decimal numerals and
  prevent parsing errors due to integer conversion overflows or
  precision loss due to integer conversion (Section 17.5).

  Because Content-Length is used for message delimitation in HTTP/1.1,
  its field value can impact how the message is parsed by downstream
  recipients even when the immediate connection is not using HTTP/1.1.
  If the message is forwarded by a downstream intermediary, a Content-
  Length field value that is inconsistent with the received message
  framing might cause a security failure due to request smuggling or
  response splitting.

  As a result, a sender MUST NOT forward a message with a Content-
  Length header field value that is known to be incorrect.

  Likewise, a sender MUST NOT forward a message with a Content-Length
  header field value that does not match the ABNF above, with one
  exception: a recipient of a Content-Length header field value
  consisting of the same decimal value repeated as a comma-separated
  list (e.g, "Content-Length: 42, 42") MAY either reject the message as
  invalid or replace that invalid field value with a single instance of
  the decimal value, since this likely indicates that a duplicate was
  generated or combined by an upstream message processor.

8.7.  Content-Location

  The "Content-Location" header field references a URI that can be used
  as an identifier for a specific resource corresponding to the
  representation in this message's content.  In other words, if one
  were to perform a GET request on this URI at the time of this
  message's generation, then a 200 (OK) response would contain the same
  representation that is enclosed as content in this message.

    Content-Location = absolute-URI / partial-URI

  The field value is either an absolute-URI or a partial-URI.  In the
  latter case (Section 4), the referenced URI is relative to the target
  URI ([URI], Section 5).

  The Content-Location value is not a replacement for the target URI
  (Section 7.1).  It is representation metadata.  It has the same
  syntax and semantics as the header field of the same name defined for
  MIME body parts in Section 4 of [RFC2557].  However, its appearance
  in an HTTP message has some special implications for HTTP recipients.

  If Content-Location is included in a 2xx (Successful) response
  message and its value refers (after conversion to absolute form) to a
  URI that is the same as the target URI, then the recipient MAY
  consider the content to be a current representation of that resource
  at the time indicated by the message origination date.  For a GET
  (Section 9.3.1) or HEAD (Section 9.3.2) request, this is the same as
  the default semantics when no Content-Location is provided by the
  server.  For a state-changing request like PUT (Section 9.3.4) or
  POST (Section 9.3.3), it implies that the server's response contains
  the new representation of that resource, thereby distinguishing it
  from representations that might only report about the action (e.g.,
  "It worked!").  This allows authoring applications to update their
  local copies without the need for a subsequent GET request.

  If Content-Location is included in a 2xx (Successful) response
  message and its field value refers to a URI that differs from the
  target URI, then the origin server claims that the URI is an
  identifier for a different resource corresponding to the enclosed
  representation.  Such a claim can only be trusted if both identifiers
  share the same resource owner, which cannot be programmatically
  determined via HTTP.

  *  For a response to a GET or HEAD request, this is an indication
     that the target URI refers to a resource that is subject to
     content negotiation and the Content-Location field value is a more
     specific identifier for the selected representation.

  *  For a 201 (Created) response to a state-changing method, a
     Content-Location field value that is identical to the Location
     field value indicates that this content is a current
     representation of the newly created resource.

  *  Otherwise, such a Content-Location indicates that this content is
     a representation reporting on the requested action's status and
     that the same report is available (for future access with GET) at
     the given URI.  For example, a purchase transaction made via a
     POST request might include a receipt document as the content of
     the 200 (OK) response; the Content-Location field value provides
     an identifier for retrieving a copy of that same receipt in the
     future.

  A user agent that sends Content-Location in a request message is
  stating that its value refers to where the user agent originally
  obtained the content of the enclosed representation (prior to any
  modifications made by that user agent).  In other words, the user
  agent is providing a back link to the source of the original
  representation.

  An origin server that receives a Content-Location field in a request
  message MUST treat the information as transitory request context
  rather than as metadata to be saved verbatim as part of the
  representation.  An origin server MAY use that context to guide in
  processing the request or to save it for other uses, such as within
  source links or versioning metadata.  However, an origin server MUST
  NOT use such context information to alter the request semantics.

  For example, if a client makes a PUT request on a negotiated resource
  and the origin server accepts that PUT (without redirection), then
  the new state of that resource is expected to be consistent with the
  one representation supplied in that PUT; the Content-Location cannot
  be used as a form of reverse content selection identifier to update
  only one of the negotiated representations.  If the user agent had
  wanted the latter semantics, it would have applied the PUT directly
  to the Content-Location URI.

8.8.  Validator Fields

  Resource metadata is referred to as a "validator" if it can be used
  within a precondition (Section 13.1) to make a conditional request
  (Section 13).  Validator fields convey a current validator for the
  selected representation (Section 3.2).

  In responses to safe requests, validator fields describe the selected
  representation chosen by the origin server while handling the
  response.  Note that, depending on the method and status code
  semantics, the selected representation for a given response is not
  necessarily the same as the representation enclosed as response
  content.

  In a successful response to a state-changing request, validator
  fields describe the new representation that has replaced the prior
  selected representation as a result of processing the request.

  For example, an ETag field in a 201 (Created) response communicates
  the entity tag of the newly created resource's representation, so
  that the entity tag can be used as a validator in later conditional
  requests to prevent the "lost update" problem.

  This specification defines two forms of metadata that are commonly
  used to observe resource state and test for preconditions:
  modification dates (Section 8.8.2) and opaque entity tags
  (Section 8.8.3).  Additional metadata that reflects resource state
  has been defined by various extensions of HTTP, such as Web
  Distributed Authoring and Versioning [WEBDAV], that are beyond the
  scope of this specification.

8.8.1.  Weak versus Strong

  Validators come in two flavors: strong or weak.  Weak validators are
  easy to generate but are far less useful for comparisons.  Strong
  validators are ideal for comparisons but can be very difficult (and
  occasionally impossible) to generate efficiently.  Rather than impose
  that all forms of resource adhere to the same strength of validator,
  HTTP exposes the type of validator in use and imposes restrictions on
  when weak validators can be used as preconditions.

  A "strong validator" is representation metadata that changes value
  whenever a change occurs to the representation data that would be
  observable in the content of a 200 (OK) response to GET.

  A strong validator might change for reasons other than a change to
  the representation data, such as when a semantically significant part
  of the representation metadata is changed (e.g., Content-Type), but
  it is in the best interests of the origin server to only change the
  value when it is necessary to invalidate the stored responses held by
  remote caches and authoring tools.

  Cache entries might persist for arbitrarily long periods, regardless
  of expiration times.  Thus, a cache might attempt to validate an
  entry using a validator that it obtained in the distant past.  A
  strong validator is unique across all versions of all representations
  associated with a particular resource over time.  However, there is
  no implication of uniqueness across representations of different
  resources (i.e., the same strong validator might be in use for
  representations of multiple resources at the same time and does not
  imply that those representations are equivalent).

  There are a variety of strong validators used in practice.  The best
  are based on strict revision control, wherein each change to a
  representation always results in a unique node name and revision
  identifier being assigned before the representation is made
  accessible to GET.  A collision-resistant hash function applied to
  the representation data is also sufficient if the data is available
  prior to the response header fields being sent and the digest does
  not need to be recalculated every time a validation request is
  received.  However, if a resource has distinct representations that
  differ only in their metadata, such as might occur with content
  negotiation over media types that happen to share the same data
  format, then the origin server needs to incorporate additional
  information in the validator to distinguish those representations.

  In contrast, a "weak validator" is representation metadata that might
  not change for every change to the representation data.  This
  weakness might be due to limitations in how the value is calculated
  (e.g., clock resolution), an inability to ensure uniqueness for all
  possible representations of the resource, or a desire of the resource
  owner to group representations by some self-determined set of
  equivalency rather than unique sequences of data.

  An origin server SHOULD change a weak entity tag whenever it
  considers prior representations to be unacceptable as a substitute
  for the current representation.  In other words, a weak entity tag
  ought to change whenever the origin server wants caches to invalidate
  old responses.

  For example, the representation of a weather report that changes in
  content every second, based on dynamic measurements, might be grouped
  into sets of equivalent representations (from the origin server's
  perspective) with the same weak validator in order to allow cached
  representations to be valid for a reasonable period of time (perhaps
  adjusted dynamically based on server load or weather quality).
  Likewise, a representation's modification time, if defined with only
  one-second resolution, might be a weak validator if it is possible
  for the representation to be modified twice during a single second
  and retrieved between those modifications.

  Likewise, a validator is weak if it is shared by two or more
  representations of a given resource at the same time, unless those
  representations have identical representation data.  For example, if
  the origin server sends the same validator for a representation with
  a gzip content coding applied as it does for a representation with no
  content coding, then that validator is weak.  However, two
  simultaneous representations might share the same strong validator if
  they differ only in the representation metadata, such as when two
  different media types are available for the same representation data.

  Strong validators are usable for all conditional requests, including
  cache validation, partial content ranges, and "lost update"
  avoidance.  Weak validators are only usable when the client does not
  require exact equality with previously obtained representation data,
  such as when validating a cache entry or limiting a web traversal to
  recent changes.

8.8.2.  Last-Modified

  The "Last-Modified" header field in a response provides a timestamp
  indicating the date and time at which the origin server believes the
  selected representation was last modified, as determined at the
  conclusion of handling the request.

    Last-Modified = HTTP-date

  An example of its use is

  Last-Modified: Tue, 15 Nov 1994 12:45:26 GMT

8.8.2.1.  Generation

  An origin server SHOULD send Last-Modified for any selected
  representation for which a last modification date can be reasonably
  and consistently determined, since its use in conditional requests
  and evaluating cache freshness ([CACHING]) can substantially reduce
  unnecessary transfers and significantly improve service availability
  and scalability.

  A representation is typically the sum of many parts behind the
  resource interface.  The last-modified time would usually be the most
  recent time that any of those parts were changed.  How that value is
  determined for any given resource is an implementation detail beyond
  the scope of this specification.

  An origin server SHOULD obtain the Last-Modified value of the
  representation as close as possible to the time that it generates the
  Date field value for its response.  This allows a recipient to make
  an accurate assessment of the representation's modification time,
  especially if the representation changes near the time that the
  response is generated.

  An origin server with a clock (as defined in Section 5.6.7) MUST NOT
  generate a Last-Modified date that is later than the server's time of
  message origination (Date, Section 6.6.1).  If the last modification
  time is derived from implementation-specific metadata that evaluates
  to some time in the future, according to the origin server's clock,
  then the origin server MUST replace that value with the message
  origination date.  This prevents a future modification date from
  having an adverse impact on cache validation.

  An origin server without a clock MUST NOT generate a Last-Modified
  date for a response unless that date value was assigned to the
  resource by some other system (presumably one with a clock).

8.8.2.2.  Comparison

  A Last-Modified time, when used as a validator in a request, is
  implicitly weak unless it is possible to deduce that it is strong,
  using the following rules:

  *  The validator is being compared by an origin server to the actual
     current validator for the representation and,

  *  That origin server reliably knows that the associated
     representation did not change twice during the second covered by
     the presented validator;

  or

  *  The validator is about to be used by a client in an
     If-Modified-Since, If-Unmodified-Since, or If-Range header field,
     because the client has a cache entry for the associated
     representation, and

  *  That cache entry includes a Date value which is at least one
     second after the Last-Modified value and the client has reason to
     believe that they were generated by the same clock or that there
     is enough difference between the Last-Modified and Date values to
     make clock synchronization issues unlikely;

  or

  *  The validator is being compared by an intermediate cache to the
     validator stored in its cache entry for the representation, and

  *  That cache entry includes a Date value which is at least one
     second after the Last-Modified value and the cache has reason to
     believe that they were generated by the same clock or that there
     is enough difference between the Last-Modified and Date values to
     make clock synchronization issues unlikely.

  This method relies on the fact that if two different responses were
  sent by the origin server during the same second, but both had the
  same Last-Modified time, then at least one of those responses would
  have a Date value equal to its Last-Modified time.

8.8.3.  ETag

  The "ETag" field in a response provides the current entity tag for
  the selected representation, as determined at the conclusion of
  handling the request.  An entity tag is an opaque validator for
  differentiating between multiple representations of the same
  resource, regardless of whether those multiple representations are
  due to resource state changes over time, content negotiation
  resulting in multiple representations being valid at the same time,
  or both.  An entity tag consists of an opaque quoted string, possibly
  prefixed by a weakness indicator.

    ETag       = entity-tag

    entity-tag = [ weak ] opaque-tag
    weak       = %s"W/"
    opaque-tag = DQUOTE *etagc DQUOTE
    etagc      = %x21 / %x23-7E / obs-text
               ; VCHAR except double quotes, plus obs-text

     |  *Note:* Previously, opaque-tag was defined to be a quoted-
     |  string ([RFC2616], Section 3.11); thus, some recipients might
     |  perform backslash unescaping.  Servers therefore ought to avoid
     |  backslash characters in entity tags.

  An entity tag can be more reliable for validation than a modification
  date in situations where it is inconvenient to store modification
  dates, where the one-second resolution of HTTP-date values is not
  sufficient, or where modification dates are not consistently
  maintained.

  Examples:

  ETag: "xyzzy"
  ETag: W/"xyzzy"
  ETag: ""

  An entity tag can be either a weak or strong validator, with strong
  being the default.  If an origin server provides an entity tag for a
  representation and the generation of that entity tag does not satisfy
  all of the characteristics of a strong validator (Section 8.8.1),
  then the origin server MUST mark the entity tag as weak by prefixing
  its opaque value with "W/" (case-sensitive).

  A sender MAY send the ETag field in a trailer section (see
  Section 6.5).  However, since trailers are often ignored, it is
  preferable to send ETag as a header field unless the entity tag is
  generated while sending the content.

8.8.3.1.  Generation

  The principle behind entity tags is that only the service author
  knows the implementation of a resource well enough to select the most
  accurate and efficient validation mechanism for that resource, and
  that any such mechanism can be mapped to a simple sequence of octets
  for easy comparison.  Since the value is opaque, there is no need for
  the client to be aware of how each entity tag is constructed.

  For example, a resource that has implementation-specific versioning
  applied to all changes might use an internal revision number, perhaps
  combined with a variance identifier for content negotiation, to
  accurately differentiate between representations.  Other
  implementations might use a collision-resistant hash of
  representation content, a combination of various file attributes, or
  a modification timestamp that has sub-second resolution.

  An origin server SHOULD send an ETag for any selected representation
  for which detection of changes can be reasonably and consistently
  determined, since the entity tag's use in conditional requests and
  evaluating cache freshness ([CACHING]) can substantially reduce
  unnecessary transfers and significantly improve service availability,
  scalability, and reliability.

8.8.3.2.  Comparison

  There are two entity tag comparison functions, depending on whether
  or not the comparison context allows the use of weak validators:

  "Strong comparison":  two entity tags are equivalent if both are not
     weak and their opaque-tags match character-by-character.

  "Weak comparison":  two entity tags are equivalent if their opaque-
     tags match character-by-character, regardless of either or both
     being tagged as "weak".

  The example below shows the results for a set of entity tag pairs and
  both the weak and strong comparison function results:

  +========+========+===================+=================+
  | ETag 1 | ETag 2 | Strong Comparison | Weak Comparison |
  +========+========+===================+=================+
  | W/"1"  | W/"1"  | no match          | match           |
  +--------+--------+-------------------+-----------------+
  | W/"1"  | W/"2"  | no match          | no match        |
  +--------+--------+-------------------+-----------------+
  | W/"1"  | "1"    | no match          | match           |
  +--------+--------+-------------------+-----------------+
  | "1"    | "1"    | match             | match           |
  +--------+--------+-------------------+-----------------+

                           Table 3

8.8.3.3.  Example: Entity Tags Varying on Content-Negotiated Resources

  Consider a resource that is subject to content negotiation
  (Section 12), and where the representations sent in response to a GET
  request vary based on the Accept-Encoding request header field
  (Section 12.5.3):

  >> Request:

  GET /index HTTP/1.1
  Host: www.example.com
  Accept-Encoding: gzip

  In this case, the response might or might not use the gzip content
  coding.  If it does not, the response might look like:

  >> Response:

  HTTP/1.1 200 OK
  Date: Fri, 26 Mar 2010 00:05:00 GMT
  ETag: "123-a"
  Content-Length: 70
  Vary: Accept-Encoding
  Content-Type: text/plain

  Hello World!
  Hello World!
  Hello World!
  Hello World!
  Hello World!

  An alternative representation that does use gzip content coding would
  be:

  >> Response:

  HTTP/1.1 200 OK
  Date: Fri, 26 Mar 2010 00:05:00 GMT
  ETag: "123-b"
  Content-Length: 43
  Vary: Accept-Encoding
  Content-Type: text/plain
  Content-Encoding: gzip

  ...binary data...

     |  *Note:* Content codings are a property of the representation
     |  data, so a strong entity tag for a content-encoded
     |  representation has to be distinct from the entity tag of an
     |  unencoded representation to prevent potential conflicts during
     |  cache updates and range requests.  In contrast, transfer
     |  codings (Section 7 of [HTTP/1.1]) apply only during message
     |  transfer and do not result in distinct entity tags.

9.  Methods

9.1.  Overview

  The request method token is the primary source of request semantics;
  it indicates the purpose for which the client has made this request
  and what is expected by the client as a successful result.

  The request method's semantics might be further specialized by the
  semantics of some header fields when present in a request if those
  additional semantics do not conflict with the method.  For example, a
  client can send conditional request header fields (Section 13.1) to
  make the requested action conditional on the current state of the
  target resource.

  HTTP is designed to be usable as an interface to distributed object
  systems.  The request method invokes an action to be applied to a
  target resource in much the same way that a remote method invocation
  can be sent to an identified object.

    method = token

  The method token is case-sensitive because it might be used as a
  gateway to object-based systems with case-sensitive method names.  By
  convention, standardized methods are defined in all-uppercase US-
  ASCII letters.

  Unlike distributed objects, the standardized request methods in HTTP
  are not resource-specific, since uniform interfaces provide for
  better visibility and reuse in network-based systems [REST].  Once
  defined, a standardized method ought to have the same semantics when
  applied to any resource, though each resource determines for itself
  whether those semantics are implemented or allowed.

  This specification defines a number of standardized methods that are
  commonly used in HTTP, as outlined by the following table.

  +=========+============================================+=========+
  | Method  | Description                                | Section |
  | Name    |                                            |         |
  +=========+============================================+=========+
  | GET     | Transfer a current representation of the   | 9.3.1   |
  |         | target resource.                           |         |
  +---------+--------------------------------------------+---------+
  | HEAD    | Same as GET, but do not transfer the       | 9.3.2   |
  |         | response content.                          |         |
  +---------+--------------------------------------------+---------+
  | POST    | Perform resource-specific processing on    | 9.3.3   |
  |         | the request content.                       |         |
  +---------+--------------------------------------------+---------+
  | PUT     | Replace all current representations of the | 9.3.4   |
  |         | target resource with the request content.  |         |
  +---------+--------------------------------------------+---------+
  | DELETE  | Remove all current representations of the  | 9.3.5   |
  |         | target resource.                           |         |
  +---------+--------------------------------------------+---------+
  | CONNECT | Establish a tunnel to the server           | 9.3.6   |
  |         | identified by the target resource.         |         |
  +---------+--------------------------------------------+---------+
  | OPTIONS | Describe the communication options for the | 9.3.7   |
  |         | target resource.                           |         |
  +---------+--------------------------------------------+---------+
  | TRACE   | Perform a message loop-back test along the | 9.3.8   |
  |         | path to the target resource.               |         |
  +---------+--------------------------------------------+---------+

                               Table 4

  All general-purpose servers MUST support the methods GET and HEAD.
  All other methods are OPTIONAL.

  The set of methods allowed by a target resource can be listed in an
  Allow header field (Section 10.2.1).  However, the set of allowed
  methods can change dynamically.  An origin server that receives a
  request method that is unrecognized or not implemented SHOULD respond
  with the 501 (Not Implemented) status code.  An origin server that
  receives a request method that is recognized and implemented, but not
  allowed for the target resource, SHOULD respond with the 405 (Method
  Not Allowed) status code.

  Additional methods, outside the scope of this specification, have
  been specified for use in HTTP.  All such methods ought to be
  registered within the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method
  Registry", as described in Section 16.1.

9.2.  Common Method Properties

9.2.1.  Safe Methods

  Request methods are considered "safe" if their defined semantics are
  essentially read-only; i.e., the client does not request, and does
  not expect, any state change on the origin server as a result of
  applying a safe method to a target resource.  Likewise, reasonable
  use of a safe method is not expected to cause any harm, loss of
  property, or unusual burden on the origin server.

  This definition of safe methods does not prevent an implementation
  from including behavior that is potentially harmful, that is not
  entirely read-only, or that causes side effects while invoking a safe
  method.  What is important, however, is that the client did not
  request that additional behavior and cannot be held accountable for
  it.  For example, most servers append request information to access
  log files at the completion of every response, regardless of the
  method, and that is considered safe even though the log storage might
  become full and cause the server to fail.  Likewise, a safe request
  initiated by selecting an advertisement on the Web will often have
  the side effect of charging an advertising account.

  Of the request methods defined by this specification, the GET, HEAD,
  OPTIONS, and TRACE methods are defined to be safe.

  The purpose of distinguishing between safe and unsafe methods is to
  allow automated retrieval processes (spiders) and cache performance
  optimization (pre-fetching) to work without fear of causing harm.  In
  addition, it allows a user agent to apply appropriate constraints on
  the automated use of unsafe methods when processing potentially
  untrusted content.

  A user agent SHOULD distinguish between safe and unsafe methods when
  presenting potential actions to a user, such that the user can be
  made aware of an unsafe action before it is requested.

  When a resource is constructed such that parameters within the target
  URI have the effect of selecting an action, it is the resource
  owner's responsibility to ensure that the action is consistent with
  the request method semantics.  For example, it is common for Web-
  based content editing software to use actions within query
  parameters, such as "page?do=delete".  If the purpose of such a
  resource is to perform an unsafe action, then the resource owner MUST
  disable or disallow that action when it is accessed using a safe
  request method.  Failure to do so will result in unfortunate side
  effects when automated processes perform a GET on every URI reference
  for the sake of link maintenance, pre-fetching, building a search
  index, etc.

9.2.2.  Idempotent Methods

  A request method is considered "idempotent" if the intended effect on
  the server of multiple identical requests with that method is the
  same as the effect for a single such request.  Of the request methods
  defined by this specification, PUT, DELETE, and safe request methods
  are idempotent.

  Like the definition of safe, the idempotent property only applies to
  what has been requested by the user; a server is free to log each
  request separately, retain a revision control history, or implement
  other non-idempotent side effects for each idempotent request.

  Idempotent methods are distinguished because the request can be
  repeated automatically if a communication failure occurs before the
  client is able to read the server's response.  For example, if a
  client sends a PUT request and the underlying connection is closed
  before any response is received, then the client can establish a new
  connection and retry the idempotent request.  It knows that repeating
  the request will have the same intended effect, even if the original
  request succeeded, though the response might differ.

  A client SHOULD NOT automatically retry a request with a non-
  idempotent method unless it has some means to know that the request
  semantics are actually idempotent, regardless of the method, or some
  means to detect that the original request was never applied.

  For example, a user agent can repeat a POST request automatically if
  it knows (through design or configuration) that the request is safe
  for that resource.  Likewise, a user agent designed specifically to
  operate on a version control repository might be able to recover from
  partial failure conditions by checking the target resource
  revision(s) after a failed connection, reverting or fixing any
  changes that were partially applied, and then automatically retrying
  the requests that failed.

  Some clients take a riskier approach and attempt to guess when an
  automatic retry is possible.  For example, a client might
  automatically retry a POST request if the underlying transport
  connection closed before any part of a response is received,
  particularly if an idle persistent connection was used.

  A proxy MUST NOT automatically retry non-idempotent requests.  A
  client SHOULD NOT automatically retry a failed automatic retry.

9.2.3.  Methods and Caching

  For a cache to store and use a response, the associated method needs
  to explicitly allow caching and to detail under what conditions a
  response can be used to satisfy subsequent requests; a method
  definition that does not do so cannot be cached.  For additional
  requirements see [CACHING].

  This specification defines caching semantics for GET, HEAD, and POST,
  although the overwhelming majority of cache implementations only
  support GET and HEAD.

9.3.  Method Definitions

9.3.1.  GET

  The GET method requests transfer of a current selected representation
  for the target resource.  A successful response reflects the quality
  of "sameness" identified by the target URI (Section 1.2.2 of [URI]).
  Hence, retrieving identifiable information via HTTP is usually
  performed by making a GET request on an identifier associated with
  the potential for providing that information in a 200 (OK) response.

  GET is the primary mechanism of information retrieval and the focus
  of almost all performance optimizations.  Applications that produce a
  URI for each important resource can benefit from those optimizations
  while enabling their reuse by other applications, creating a network
  effect that promotes further expansion of the Web.

  It is tempting to think of resource identifiers as remote file system
  pathnames and of representations as being a copy of the contents of
  such files.  In fact, that is how many resources are implemented (see
  Section 17.3 for related security considerations).  However, there
  are no such limitations in practice.

  The HTTP interface for a resource is just as likely to be implemented
  as a tree of content objects, a programmatic view on various database
  records, or a gateway to other information systems.  Even when the
  URI mapping mechanism is tied to a file system, an origin server
  might be configured to execute the files with the request as input
  and send the output as the representation rather than transfer the
  files directly.  Regardless, only the origin server needs to know how
  each resource identifier corresponds to an implementation and how
  that implementation manages to select and send a current
  representation of the target resource.

  A client can alter the semantics of GET to be a "range request",
  requesting transfer of only some part(s) of the selected
  representation, by sending a Range header field in the request
  (Section 14.2).

  Although request message framing is independent of the method used,
  content received in a GET request has no generally defined semantics,
  cannot alter the meaning or target of the request, and might lead
  some implementations to reject the request and close the connection
  because of its potential as a request smuggling attack (Section 11.2
  of [HTTP/1.1]).  A client SHOULD NOT generate content in a GET
  request unless it is made directly to an origin server that has
  previously indicated, in or out of band, that such a request has a
  purpose and will be adequately supported.  An origin server SHOULD
  NOT rely on private agreements to receive content, since participants
  in HTTP communication are often unaware of intermediaries along the
  request chain.

  The response to a GET request is cacheable; a cache MAY use it to
  satisfy subsequent GET and HEAD requests unless otherwise indicated
  by the Cache-Control header field (Section 5.2 of [CACHING]).

  When information retrieval is performed with a mechanism that
  constructs a target URI from user-provided information, such as the
  query fields of a form using GET, potentially sensitive data might be
  provided that would not be appropriate for disclosure within a URI
  (see Section 17.9).  In some cases, the data can be filtered or
  transformed such that it would not reveal such information.  In
  others, particularly when there is no benefit from caching a
  response, using the POST method (Section 9.3.3) instead of GET can
  transmit such information in the request content rather than within
  the target URI.

9.3.2.  HEAD

  The HEAD method is identical to GET except that the server MUST NOT
  send content in the response.  HEAD is used to obtain metadata about
  the selected representation without transferring its representation
  data, often for the sake of testing hypertext links or finding recent
  modifications.

  The server SHOULD send the same header fields in response to a HEAD
  request as it would have sent if the request method had been GET.
  However, a server MAY omit header fields for which a value is
  determined only while generating the content.  For example, some
  servers buffer a dynamic response to GET until a minimum amount of
  data is generated so that they can more efficiently delimit small
  responses or make late decisions with regard to content selection.
  Such a response to GET might contain Content-Length and Vary fields,
  for example, that are not generated within a HEAD response.  These
  minor inconsistencies are considered preferable to generating and
  discarding the content for a HEAD request, since HEAD is usually
  requested for the sake of efficiency.

  Although request message framing is independent of the method used,
  content received in a HEAD request has no generally defined
  semantics, cannot alter the meaning or target of the request, and
  might lead some implementations to reject the request and close the
  connection because of its potential as a request smuggling attack
  (Section 11.2 of [HTTP/1.1]).  A client SHOULD NOT generate content
  in a HEAD request unless it is made directly to an origin server that
  has previously indicated, in or out of band, that such a request has
  a purpose and will be adequately supported.  An origin server SHOULD
  NOT rely on private agreements to receive content, since participants
  in HTTP communication are often unaware of intermediaries along the
  request chain.

  The response to a HEAD request is cacheable; a cache MAY use it to
  satisfy subsequent HEAD requests unless otherwise indicated by the
  Cache-Control header field (Section 5.2 of [CACHING]).  A HEAD
  response might also affect previously cached responses to GET; see
  Section 4.3.5 of [CACHING].

9.3.3.  POST

  The POST method requests that the target resource process the
  representation enclosed in the request according to the resource's
  own specific semantics.  For example, POST is used for the following
  functions (among others):

  *  Providing a block of data, such as the fields entered into an HTML
     form, to a data-handling process;

  *  Posting a message to a bulletin board, newsgroup, mailing list,
     blog, or similar group of articles;

  *  Creating a new resource that has yet to be identified by the
     origin server; and

  *  Appending data to a resource's existing representation(s).

  An origin server indicates response semantics by choosing an
  appropriate status code depending on the result of processing the
  POST request; almost all of the status codes defined by this
  specification could be received in a response to POST (the exceptions
  being 206 (Partial Content), 304 (Not Modified), and 416 (Range Not
  Satisfiable)).

  If one or more resources has been created on the origin server as a
  result of successfully processing a POST request, the origin server
  SHOULD send a 201 (Created) response containing a Location header
  field that provides an identifier for the primary resource created
  (Section 10.2.2) and a representation that describes the status of
  the request while referring to the new resource(s).

  Responses to POST requests are only cacheable when they include
  explicit freshness information (see Section 4.2.1 of [CACHING]) and a
  Content-Location header field that has the same value as the POST's
  target URI (Section 8.7).  A cached POST response can be reused to
  satisfy a later GET or HEAD request.  In contrast, a POST request
  cannot be satisfied by a cached POST response because POST is
  potentially unsafe; see Section 4 of [CACHING].

  If the result of processing a POST would be equivalent to a
  representation of an existing resource, an origin server MAY redirect
  the user agent to that resource by sending a 303 (See Other) response
  with the existing resource's identifier in the Location field.  This
  has the benefits of providing the user agent a resource identifier
  and transferring the representation via a method more amenable to
  shared caching, though at the cost of an extra request if the user
  agent does not already have the representation cached.

9.3.4.  PUT

  The PUT method requests that the state of the target resource be
  created or replaced with the state defined by the representation
  enclosed in the request message content.  A successful PUT of a given
  representation would suggest that a subsequent GET on that same
  target resource will result in an equivalent representation being
  sent in a 200 (OK) response.  However, there is no guarantee that
  such a state change will be observable, since the target resource
  might be acted upon by other user agents in parallel, or might be
  subject to dynamic processing by the origin server, before any
  subsequent GET is received.  A successful response only implies that
  the user agent's intent was achieved at the time of its processing by
  the origin server.

  If the target resource does not have a current representation and the
  PUT successfully creates one, then the origin server MUST inform the
  user agent by sending a 201 (Created) response.  If the target
  resource does have a current representation and that representation
  is successfully modified in accordance with the state of the enclosed
  representation, then the origin server MUST send either a 200 (OK) or
  a 204 (No Content) response to indicate successful completion of the
  request.

  An origin server SHOULD verify that the PUT representation is
  consistent with its configured constraints for the target resource.
  For example, if an origin server determines a resource's
  representation metadata based on the URI, then the origin server
  needs to ensure that the content received in a successful PUT request
  is consistent with that metadata.  When a PUT representation is
  inconsistent with the target resource, the origin server SHOULD
  either make them consistent, by transforming the representation or
  changing the resource configuration, or respond with an appropriate
  error message containing sufficient information to explain why the
  representation is unsuitable.  The 409 (Conflict) or 415 (Unsupported
  Media Type) status codes are suggested, with the latter being
  specific to constraints on Content-Type values.

  For example, if the target resource is configured to always have a
  Content-Type of "text/html" and the representation being PUT has a
  Content-Type of "image/jpeg", the origin server ought to do one of:

  a.  reconfigure the target resource to reflect the new media type;

  b.  transform the PUT representation to a format consistent with that
      of the resource before saving it as the new resource state; or,

  c.  reject the request with a 415 (Unsupported Media Type) response
      indicating that the target resource is limited to "text/html",
      perhaps including a link to a different resource that would be a
      suitable target for the new representation.

  HTTP does not define exactly how a PUT method affects the state of an
  origin server beyond what can be expressed by the intent of the user
  agent request and the semantics of the origin server response.  It
  does not define what a resource might be, in any sense of that word,
  beyond the interface provided via HTTP.  It does not define how
  resource state is "stored", nor how such storage might change as a
  result of a change in resource state, nor how the origin server
  translates resource state into representations.  Generally speaking,
  all implementation details behind the resource interface are
  intentionally hidden by the server.

  This extends to how header and trailer fields are stored; while
  common header fields like Content-Type will typically be stored and
  returned upon subsequent GET requests, header and trailer field
  handling is specific to the resource that received the request.  As a
  result, an origin server SHOULD ignore unrecognized header and
  trailer fields received in a PUT request (i.e., not save them as part
  of the resource state).

  An origin server MUST NOT send a validator field (Section 8.8), such
  as an ETag or Last-Modified field, in a successful response to PUT
  unless the request's representation data was saved without any
  transformation applied to the content (i.e., the resource's new
  representation data is identical to the content received in the PUT
  request) and the validator field value reflects the new
  representation.  This requirement allows a user agent to know when
  the representation it sent (and retains in memory) is the result of
  the PUT, and thus it doesn't need to be retrieved again from the
  origin server.  The new validator(s) received in the response can be
  used for future conditional requests in order to prevent accidental
  overwrites (Section 13.1).

  The fundamental difference between the POST and PUT methods is
  highlighted by the different intent for the enclosed representation.
  The target resource in a POST request is intended to handle the
  enclosed representation according to the resource's own semantics,
  whereas the enclosed representation in a PUT request is defined as
  replacing the state of the target resource.  Hence, the intent of PUT
  is idempotent and visible to intermediaries, even though the exact
  effect is only known by the origin server.

  Proper interpretation of a PUT request presumes that the user agent
  knows which target resource is desired.  A service that selects a
  proper URI on behalf of the client, after receiving a state-changing
  request, SHOULD be implemented using the POST method rather than PUT.
  If the origin server will not make the requested PUT state change to
  the target resource and instead wishes to have it applied to a
  different resource, such as when the resource has been moved to a
  different URI, then the origin server MUST send an appropriate 3xx
  (Redirection) response; the user agent MAY then make its own decision
  regarding whether or not to redirect the request.

  A PUT request applied to the target resource can have side effects on
  other resources.  For example, an article might have a URI for
  identifying "the current version" (a resource) that is separate from
  the URIs identifying each particular version (different resources
  that at one point shared the same state as the current version
  resource).  A successful PUT request on "the current version" URI
  might therefore create a new version resource in addition to changing
  the state of the target resource, and might also cause links to be
  added between the related resources.

  Some origin servers support use of the Content-Range header field
  (Section 14.4) as a request modifier to perform a partial PUT, as
  described in Section 14.5.

  Responses to the PUT method are not cacheable.  If a successful PUT
  request passes through a cache that has one or more stored responses
  for the target URI, those stored responses will be invalidated (see
  Section 4.4 of [CACHING]).

9.3.5.  DELETE

  The DELETE method requests that the origin server remove the
  association between the target resource and its current
  functionality.  In effect, this method is similar to the "rm" command
  in UNIX: it expresses a deletion operation on the URI mapping of the
  origin server rather than an expectation that the previously
  associated information be deleted.

  If the target resource has one or more current representations, they
  might or might not be destroyed by the origin server, and the
  associated storage might or might not be reclaimed, depending
  entirely on the nature of the resource and its implementation by the
  origin server (which are beyond the scope of this specification).
  Likewise, other implementation aspects of a resource might need to be
  deactivated or archived as a result of a DELETE, such as database or
  gateway connections.  In general, it is assumed that the origin
  server will only allow DELETE on resources for which it has a
  prescribed mechanism for accomplishing the deletion.

  Relatively few resources allow the DELETE method -- its primary use
  is for remote authoring environments, where the user has some
  direction regarding its effect.  For example, a resource that was
  previously created using a PUT request, or identified via the
  Location header field after a 201 (Created) response to a POST
  request, might allow a corresponding DELETE request to undo those
  actions.  Similarly, custom user agent implementations that implement
  an authoring function, such as revision control clients using HTTP
  for remote operations, might use DELETE based on an assumption that
  the server's URI space has been crafted to correspond to a version
  repository.

  If a DELETE method is successfully applied, the origin server SHOULD
  send

  *  a 202 (Accepted) status code if the action will likely succeed but
     has not yet been enacted,

  *  a 204 (No Content) status code if the action has been enacted and
     no further information is to be supplied, or

  *  a 200 (OK) status code if the action has been enacted and the
     response message includes a representation describing the status.

  Although request message framing is independent of the method used,
  content received in a DELETE request has no generally defined
  semantics, cannot alter the meaning or target of the request, and
  might lead some implementations to reject the request and close the
  connection because of its potential as a request smuggling attack
  (Section 11.2 of [HTTP/1.1]).  A client SHOULD NOT generate content
  in a DELETE request unless it is made directly to an origin server
  that has previously indicated, in or out of band, that such a request
  has a purpose and will be adequately supported.  An origin server
  SHOULD NOT rely on private agreements to receive content, since
  participants in HTTP communication are often unaware of
  intermediaries along the request chain.

  Responses to the DELETE method are not cacheable.  If a successful
  DELETE request passes through a cache that has one or more stored
  responses for the target URI, those stored responses will be
  invalidated (see Section 4.4 of [CACHING]).

9.3.6.  CONNECT

  The CONNECT method requests that the recipient establish a tunnel to
  the destination origin server identified by the request target and,
  if successful, thereafter restrict its behavior to blind forwarding
  of data, in both directions, until the tunnel is closed.  Tunnels are
  commonly used to create an end-to-end virtual connection, through one
  or more proxies, which can then be secured using TLS (Transport Layer
  Security, [TLS13]).

  CONNECT uses a special form of request target, unique to this method,
  consisting of only the host and port number of the tunnel
  destination, separated by a colon.  There is no default port; a
  client MUST send the port number even if the CONNECT request is based
  on a URI reference that contains an authority component with an
  elided port (Section 4.1).  For example,

  CONNECT server.example.com:80 HTTP/1.1
  Host: server.example.com

  A server MUST reject a CONNECT request that targets an empty or
  invalid port number, typically by responding with a 400 (Bad Request)
  status code.

  Because CONNECT changes the request/response nature of an HTTP
  connection, specific HTTP versions might have different ways of
  mapping its semantics into the protocol's wire format.

  CONNECT is intended for use in requests to a proxy.  The recipient
  can establish a tunnel either by directly connecting to the server
  identified by the request target or, if configured to use another
  proxy, by forwarding the CONNECT request to the next inbound proxy.
  An origin server MAY accept a CONNECT request, but most origin
  servers do not implement CONNECT.

  Any 2xx (Successful) response indicates that the sender (and all
  inbound proxies) will switch to tunnel mode immediately after the
  response header section; data received after that header section is
  from the server identified by the request target.  Any response other
  than a successful response indicates that the tunnel has not yet been
  formed.

  A tunnel is closed when a tunnel intermediary detects that either
  side has closed its connection: the intermediary MUST attempt to send
  any outstanding data that came from the closed side to the other
  side, close both connections, and then discard any remaining data
  left undelivered.

  Proxy authentication might be used to establish the authority to
  create a tunnel.  For example,

  CONNECT server.example.com:443 HTTP/1.1
  Host: server.example.com:443
  Proxy-Authorization: basic aGVsbG86d29ybGQ=

  There are significant risks in establishing a tunnel to arbitrary
  servers, particularly when the destination is a well-known or
  reserved TCP port that is not intended for Web traffic.  For example,
  a CONNECT to "example.com:25" would suggest that the proxy connect to
  the reserved port for SMTP traffic; if allowed, that could trick the
  proxy into relaying spam email.  Proxies that support CONNECT SHOULD
  restrict its use to a limited set of known ports or a configurable
  list of safe request targets.

  A server MUST NOT send any Transfer-Encoding or Content-Length header
  fields in a 2xx (Successful) response to CONNECT.  A client MUST
  ignore any Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding header fields received
  in a successful response to CONNECT.

  A CONNECT request message does not have content.  The interpretation
  of data sent after the header section of the CONNECT request message
  is specific to the version of HTTP in use.

  Responses to the CONNECT method are not cacheable.

9.3.7.  OPTIONS

  The OPTIONS method requests information about the communication
  options available for the target resource, at either the origin
  server or an intervening intermediary.  This method allows a client
  to determine the options and/or requirements associated with a
  resource, or the capabilities of a server, without implying a
  resource action.

  An OPTIONS request with an asterisk ("*") as the request target
  (Section 7.1) applies to the server in general rather than to a
  specific resource.  Since a server's communication options typically
  depend on the resource, the "*" request is only useful as a "ping" or
  "no-op" type of method; it does nothing beyond allowing the client to
  test the capabilities of the server.  For example, this can be used
  to test a proxy for HTTP/1.1 conformance (or lack thereof).

  If the request target is not an asterisk, the OPTIONS request applies
  to the options that are available when communicating with the target
  resource.

  A server generating a successful response to OPTIONS SHOULD send any
  header that might indicate optional features implemented by the
  server and applicable to the target resource (e.g., Allow), including
  potential extensions not defined by this specification.  The response
  content, if any, might also describe the communication options in a
  machine or human-readable representation.  A standard format for such
  a representation is not defined by this specification, but might be
  defined by future extensions to HTTP.

  A client MAY send a Max-Forwards header field in an OPTIONS request
  to target a specific recipient in the request chain (see
  Section 7.6.2).  A proxy MUST NOT generate a Max-Forwards header
  field while forwarding a request unless that request was received
  with a Max-Forwards field.

  A client that generates an OPTIONS request containing content MUST
  send a valid Content-Type header field describing the representation
  media type.  Note that this specification does not define any use for
  such content.

  Responses to the OPTIONS method are not cacheable.

9.3.8.  TRACE

  The TRACE method requests a remote, application-level loop-back of
  the request message.  The final recipient of the request SHOULD
  reflect the message received, excluding some fields described below,
  back to the client as the content of a 200 (OK) response.  The
  "message/http" format (Section 10.1 of [HTTP/1.1]) is one way to do
  so.  The final recipient is either the origin server or the first
  server to receive a Max-Forwards value of zero (0) in the request
  (Section 7.6.2).

  A client MUST NOT generate fields in a TRACE request containing
  sensitive data that might be disclosed by the response.  For example,
  it would be foolish for a user agent to send stored user credentials
  (Section 11) or cookies [COOKIE] in a TRACE request.  The final
  recipient of the request SHOULD exclude any request fields that are
  likely to contain sensitive data when that recipient generates the
  response content.

  TRACE allows the client to see what is being received at the other
  end of the request chain and use that data for testing or diagnostic
  information.  The value of the Via header field (Section 7.6.3) is of
  particular interest, since it acts as a trace of the request chain.
  Use of the Max-Forwards header field allows the client to limit the
  length of the request chain, which is useful for testing a chain of
  proxies forwarding messages in an infinite loop.

  A client MUST NOT send content in a TRACE request.

  Responses to the TRACE method are not cacheable.

10.  Message Context

10.1.  Request Context Fields

  The request header fields below provide additional information about
  the request context, including information about the user, user
  agent, and resource behind the request.

10.1.1.  Expect

  The "Expect" header field in a request indicates a certain set of
  behaviors (expectations) that need to be supported by the server in
  order to properly handle this request.

    Expect =      #expectation
    expectation = token [ "=" ( token / quoted-string ) parameters ]

  The Expect field value is case-insensitive.

  The only expectation defined by this specification is "100-continue"
  (with no defined parameters).

  A server that receives an Expect field value containing a member
  other than 100-continue MAY respond with a 417 (Expectation Failed)
  status code to indicate that the unexpected expectation cannot be
  met.

  A "100-continue" expectation informs recipients that the client is
  about to send (presumably large) content in this request and wishes
  to receive a 100 (Continue) interim response if the method, target
  URI, and header fields are not sufficient to cause an immediate
  success, redirect, or error response.  This allows the client to wait
  for an indication that it is worthwhile to send the content before
  actually doing so, which can improve efficiency when the data is huge
  or when the client anticipates that an error is likely (e.g., when
  sending a state-changing method, for the first time, without
  previously verified authentication credentials).

  For example, a request that begins with

  PUT /somewhere/fun HTTP/1.1
  Host: origin.example.com
  Content-Type: video/h264
  Content-Length: 1234567890987
  Expect: 100-continue

  allows the origin server to immediately respond with an error
  message, such as 401 (Unauthorized) or 405 (Method Not Allowed),
  before the client starts filling the pipes with an unnecessary data
  transfer.

  Requirements for clients:

  *  A client MUST NOT generate a 100-continue expectation in a request
     that does not include content.

  *  A client that will wait for a 100 (Continue) response before
     sending the request content MUST send an Expect header field
     containing a 100-continue expectation.

  *  A client that sends a 100-continue expectation is not required to
     wait for any specific length of time; such a client MAY proceed to
     send the content even if it has not yet received a response.
     Furthermore, since 100 (Continue) responses cannot be sent through
     an HTTP/1.0 intermediary, such a client SHOULD NOT wait for an
     indefinite period before sending the content.

  *  A client that receives a 417 (Expectation Failed) status code in
     response to a request containing a 100-continue expectation SHOULD
     repeat that request without a 100-continue expectation, since the
     417 response merely indicates that the response chain does not
     support expectations (e.g., it passes through an HTTP/1.0 server).

  Requirements for servers:

  *  A server that receives a 100-continue expectation in an HTTP/1.0
     request MUST ignore that expectation.

  *  A server MAY omit sending a 100 (Continue) response if it has
     already received some or all of the content for the corresponding
     request, or if the framing indicates that there is no content.

  *  A server that sends a 100 (Continue) response MUST ultimately send
     a final status code, once it receives and processes the request
     content, unless the connection is closed prematurely.

  *  A server that responds with a final status code before reading the
     entire request content SHOULD indicate whether it intends to close
     the connection (e.g., see Section 9.6 of [HTTP/1.1]) or continue
     reading the request content.

  Upon receiving an HTTP/1.1 (or later) request that has a method,
  target URI, and complete header section that contains a 100-continue
  expectation and an indication that request content will follow, an
  origin server MUST send either:

  *  an immediate response with a final status code, if that status can
     be determined by examining just the method, target URI, and header
     fields, or

  *  an immediate 100 (Continue) response to encourage the client to
     send the request content.

  The origin server MUST NOT wait for the content before sending the
  100 (Continue) response.

  Upon receiving an HTTP/1.1 (or later) request that has a method,
  target URI, and complete header section that contains a 100-continue
  expectation and indicates a request content will follow, a proxy MUST
  either:

  *  send an immediate response with a final status code, if that
     status can be determined by examining just the method, target URI,
     and header fields, or

  *  forward the request toward the origin server by sending a
     corresponding request-line and header section to the next inbound
     server.

  If the proxy believes (from configuration or past interaction) that
  the next inbound server only supports HTTP/1.0, the proxy MAY
  generate an immediate 100 (Continue) response to encourage the client
  to begin sending the content.

10.1.2.  From

  The "From" header field contains an Internet email address for a
  human user who controls the requesting user agent.  The address ought
  to be machine-usable, as defined by "mailbox" in Section 3.4 of
  [RFC5322]:

    From    = mailbox

    mailbox = <mailbox, see [RFC5322], Section 3.4>

  An example is:

  From: [email protected]

  The From header field is rarely sent by non-robotic user agents.  A
  user agent SHOULD NOT send a From header field without explicit
  configuration by the user, since that might conflict with the user's
  privacy interests or their site's security policy.

  A robotic user agent SHOULD send a valid From header field so that
  the person responsible for running the robot can be contacted if
  problems occur on servers, such as if the robot is sending excessive,
  unwanted, or invalid requests.

  A server SHOULD NOT use the From header field for access control or
  authentication, since its value is expected to be visible to anyone
  receiving or observing the request and is often recorded within
  logfiles and error reports without any expectation of privacy.

10.1.3.  Referer

  The "Referer" [sic] header field allows the user agent to specify a
  URI reference for the resource from which the target URI was obtained
  (i.e., the "referrer", though the field name is misspelled).  A user
  agent MUST NOT include the fragment and userinfo components of the
  URI reference [URI], if any, when generating the Referer field value.

    Referer = absolute-URI / partial-URI

  The field value is either an absolute-URI or a partial-URI.  In the
  latter case (Section 4), the referenced URI is relative to the target
  URI ([URI], Section 5).

  The Referer header field allows servers to generate back-links to
  other resources for simple analytics, logging, optimized caching,
  etc.  It also allows obsolete or mistyped links to be found for
  maintenance.  Some servers use the Referer header field as a means of
  denying links from other sites (so-called "deep linking") or
  restricting cross-site request forgery (CSRF), but not all requests
  contain it.

  Example:

  Referer: http://www.example.org/hypertext/Overview.html

  If the target URI was obtained from a source that does not have its
  own URI (e.g., input from the user keyboard, or an entry within the
  user's bookmarks/favorites), the user agent MUST either exclude the
  Referer header field or send it with a value of "about:blank".

  The Referer header field value need not convey the full URI of the
  referring resource; a user agent MAY truncate parts other than the
  referring origin.

  The Referer header field has the potential to reveal information
  about the request context or browsing history of the user, which is a
  privacy concern if the referring resource's identifier reveals
  personal information (such as an account name) or a resource that is
  supposed to be confidential (such as behind a firewall or internal to
  a secured service).  Most general-purpose user agents do not send the
  Referer header field when the referring resource is a local "file" or
  "data" URI.  A user agent SHOULD NOT send a Referer header field if
  the referring resource was accessed with a secure protocol and the
  request target has an origin differing from that of the referring
  resource, unless the referring resource explicitly allows Referer to
  be sent.  A user agent MUST NOT send a Referer header field in an
  unsecured HTTP request if the referring resource was accessed with a
  secure protocol.  See Section 17.9 for additional security
  considerations.

  Some intermediaries have been known to indiscriminately remove
  Referer header fields from outgoing requests.  This has the
  unfortunate side effect of interfering with protection against CSRF
  attacks, which can be far more harmful to their users.
  Intermediaries and user agent extensions that wish to limit
  information disclosure in Referer ought to restrict their changes to
  specific edits, such as replacing internal domain names with
  pseudonyms or truncating the query and/or path components.  An
  intermediary SHOULD NOT modify or delete the Referer header field
  when the field value shares the same scheme and host as the target
  URI.

10.1.4.  TE

  The "TE" header field describes capabilities of the client with
  regard to transfer codings and trailer sections.

  As described in Section 6.5, a TE field with a "trailers" member sent
  in a request indicates that the client will not discard trailer
  fields.

  TE is also used within HTTP/1.1 to advise servers about which
  transfer codings the client is able to accept in a response.  As of
  publication, only HTTP/1.1 uses transfer codings (see Section 7 of
  [HTTP/1.1]).

  The TE field value is a list of members, with each member (aside from
  "trailers") consisting of a transfer coding name token with an
  optional weight indicating the client's relative preference for that
  transfer coding (Section 12.4.2) and optional parameters for that
  transfer coding.

    TE                 = #t-codings
    t-codings          = "trailers" / ( transfer-coding [ weight ] )
    transfer-coding    = token *( OWS ";" OWS transfer-parameter )
    transfer-parameter = token BWS "=" BWS ( token / quoted-string )

  A sender of TE MUST also send a "TE" connection option within the
  Connection header field (Section 7.6.1) to inform intermediaries not
  to forward this field.

10.1.5.  User-Agent

  The "User-Agent" header field contains information about the user
  agent originating the request, which is often used by servers to help
  identify the scope of reported interoperability problems, to work
  around or tailor responses to avoid particular user agent
  limitations, and for analytics regarding browser or operating system
  use.  A user agent SHOULD send a User-Agent header field in each
  request unless specifically configured not to do so.

    User-Agent = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) )

  The User-Agent field value consists of one or more product
  identifiers, each followed by zero or more comments (Section 5.6.5),
  which together identify the user agent software and its significant
  subproducts.  By convention, the product identifiers are listed in
  decreasing order of their significance for identifying the user agent
  software.  Each product identifier consists of a name and optional
  version.

    product         = token ["/" product-version]
    product-version = token

  A sender SHOULD limit generated product identifiers to what is
  necessary to identify the product; a sender MUST NOT generate
  advertising or other nonessential information within the product
  identifier.  A sender SHOULD NOT generate information in
  product-version that is not a version identifier (i.e., successive
  versions of the same product name ought to differ only in the
  product-version portion of the product identifier).

  Example:

  User-Agent: CERN-LineMode/2.15 libwww/2.17b3

  A user agent SHOULD NOT generate a User-Agent header field containing
  needlessly fine-grained detail and SHOULD limit the addition of
  subproducts by third parties.  Overly long and detailed User-Agent
  field values increase request latency and the risk of a user being
  identified against their wishes ("fingerprinting").

  Likewise, implementations are encouraged not to use the product
  tokens of other implementations in order to declare compatibility
  with them, as this circumvents the purpose of the field.  If a user
  agent masquerades as a different user agent, recipients can assume
  that the user intentionally desires to see responses tailored for
  that identified user agent, even if they might not work as well for
  the actual user agent being used.

10.2.  Response Context Fields

  The response header fields below provide additional information about
  the response, beyond what is implied by the status code, including
  information about the server, about the target resource, or about
  related resources.

10.2.1.  Allow

  The "Allow" header field lists the set of methods advertised as
  supported by the target resource.  The purpose of this field is
  strictly to inform the recipient of valid request methods associated
  with the resource.

    Allow = #method

  Example of use:

  Allow: GET, HEAD, PUT

  The actual set of allowed methods is defined by the origin server at
  the time of each request.  An origin server MUST generate an Allow
  header field in a 405 (Method Not Allowed) response and MAY do so in
  any other response.  An empty Allow field value indicates that the
  resource allows no methods, which might occur in a 405 response if
  the resource has been temporarily disabled by configuration.

  A proxy MUST NOT modify the Allow header field -- it does not need to
  understand all of the indicated methods in order to handle them
  according to the generic message handling rules.

10.2.2.  Location

  The "Location" header field is used in some responses to refer to a
  specific resource in relation to the response.  The type of
  relationship is defined by the combination of request method and
  status code semantics.

    Location = URI-reference

  The field value consists of a single URI-reference.  When it has the
  form of a relative reference ([URI], Section 4.2), the final value is
  computed by resolving it against the target URI ([URI], Section 5).

  For 201 (Created) responses, the Location value refers to the primary
  resource created by the request.  For 3xx (Redirection) responses,
  the Location value refers to the preferred target resource for
  automatically redirecting the request.

  If the Location value provided in a 3xx (Redirection) response does
  not have a fragment component, a user agent MUST process the
  redirection as if the value inherits the fragment component of the
  URI reference used to generate the target URI (i.e., the redirection
  inherits the original reference's fragment, if any).

  For example, a GET request generated for the URI reference
  "http://www.example.org/~tim" might result in a 303 (See Other)
  response containing the header field:

  Location: /People.html#tim

  which suggests that the user agent redirect to
  "http://www.example.org/People.html#tim"

  Likewise, a GET request generated for the URI reference
  "http://www.example.org/index.html#larry" might result in a 301
  (Moved Permanently) response containing the header field:

  Location: http://www.example.net/index.html

  which suggests that the user agent redirect to
  "http://www.example.net/index.html#larry", preserving the original
  fragment identifier.

  There are circumstances in which a fragment identifier in a Location
  value would not be appropriate.  For example, the Location header
  field in a 201 (Created) response is supposed to provide a URI that
  is specific to the created resource.

     |  *Note:* Some recipients attempt to recover from Location header
     |  fields that are not valid URI references.  This specification
     |  does not mandate or define such processing, but does allow it
     |  for the sake of robustness.  A Location field value cannot
     |  allow a list of members because the comma list separator is a
     |  valid data character within a URI-reference.  If an invalid
     |  message is sent with multiple Location field lines, a recipient
     |  along the path might combine those field lines into one value.
     |  Recovery of a valid Location field value from that situation is
     |  difficult and not interoperable across implementations.

     |  *Note:* The Content-Location header field (Section 8.7) differs
     |  from Location in that the Content-Location refers to the most
     |  specific resource corresponding to the enclosed representation.
     |  It is therefore possible for a response to contain both the
     |  Location and Content-Location header fields.

10.2.3.  Retry-After

  Servers send the "Retry-After" header field to indicate how long the
  user agent ought to wait before making a follow-up request.  When
  sent with a 503 (Service Unavailable) response, Retry-After indicates
  how long the service is expected to be unavailable to the client.
  When sent with any 3xx (Redirection) response, Retry-After indicates
  the minimum time that the user agent is asked to wait before issuing
  the redirected request.

  The Retry-After field value can be either an HTTP-date or a number of
  seconds to delay after receiving the response.

    Retry-After = HTTP-date / delay-seconds

  A delay-seconds value is a non-negative decimal integer, representing
  time in seconds.

    delay-seconds  = 1*DIGIT

  Two examples of its use are

  Retry-After: Fri, 31 Dec 1999 23:59:59 GMT
  Retry-After: 120

  In the latter example, the delay is 2 minutes.

10.2.4.  Server

  The "Server" header field contains information about the software
  used by the origin server to handle the request, which is often used
  by clients to help identify the scope of reported interoperability
  problems, to work around or tailor requests to avoid particular
  server limitations, and for analytics regarding server or operating
  system use.  An origin server MAY generate a Server header field in
  its responses.

    Server = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) )

  The Server header field value consists of one or more product
  identifiers, each followed by zero or more comments (Section 5.6.5),
  which together identify the origin server software and its
  significant subproducts.  By convention, the product identifiers are
  listed in decreasing order of their significance for identifying the
  origin server software.  Each product identifier consists of a name
  and optional version, as defined in Section 10.1.5.

  Example:

  Server: CERN/3.0 libwww/2.17

  An origin server SHOULD NOT generate a Server header field containing
  needlessly fine-grained detail and SHOULD limit the addition of
  subproducts by third parties.  Overly long and detailed Server field
  values increase response latency and potentially reveal internal
  implementation details that might make it (slightly) easier for
  attackers to find and exploit known security holes.

11.  HTTP Authentication

11.1.  Authentication Scheme

  HTTP provides a general framework for access control and
  authentication, via an extensible set of challenge-response
  authentication schemes, which can be used by a server to challenge a
  client request and by a client to provide authentication information.
  It uses a case-insensitive token to identify the authentication
  scheme:

    auth-scheme    = token

  Aside from the general framework, this document does not specify any
  authentication schemes.  New and existing authentication schemes are
  specified independently and ought to be registered within the
  "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Authentication Scheme Registry".
  For example, the "basic" and "digest" authentication schemes are
  defined by [RFC7617] and [RFC7616], respectively.

11.2.  Authentication Parameters

  The authentication scheme is followed by additional information
  necessary for achieving authentication via that scheme as either a
  comma-separated list of parameters or a single sequence of characters
  capable of holding base64-encoded information.

    token68        = 1*( ALPHA / DIGIT /
                         "-" / "." / "_" / "~" / "+" / "/" ) *"="

  The token68 syntax allows the 66 unreserved URI characters ([URI]),
  plus a few others, so that it can hold a base64, base64url (URL and
  filename safe alphabet), base32, or base16 (hex) encoding, with or
  without padding, but excluding whitespace ([RFC4648]).

  Authentication parameters are name/value pairs, where the name token
  is matched case-insensitively and each parameter name MUST only occur
  once per challenge.

    auth-param     = token BWS "=" BWS ( token / quoted-string )

  Parameter values can be expressed either as "token" or as "quoted-
  string" (Section 5.6).  Authentication scheme definitions need to
  accept both notations, both for senders and recipients, to allow
  recipients to use generic parsing components regardless of the
  authentication scheme.

  For backwards compatibility, authentication scheme definitions can
  restrict the format for senders to one of the two variants.  This can
  be important when it is known that deployed implementations will fail
  when encountering one of the two formats.

11.3.  Challenge and Response

  A 401 (Unauthorized) response message is used by an origin server to
  challenge the authorization of a user agent, including a
  WWW-Authenticate header field containing at least one challenge
  applicable to the requested resource.

  A 407 (Proxy Authentication Required) response message is used by a
  proxy to challenge the authorization of a client, including a
  Proxy-Authenticate header field containing at least one challenge
  applicable to the proxy for the requested resource.

    challenge   = auth-scheme [ 1*SP ( token68 / #auth-param ) ]

     |  *Note:* Many clients fail to parse a challenge that contains an
     |  unknown scheme.  A workaround for this problem is to list well-
     |  supported schemes (such as "basic") first.

  A user agent that wishes to authenticate itself with an origin server
  -- usually, but not necessarily, after receiving a 401 (Unauthorized)
  -- can do so by including an Authorization header field with the
  request.

  A client that wishes to authenticate itself with a proxy -- usually,
  but not necessarily, after receiving a 407 (Proxy Authentication
  Required) -- can do so by including a Proxy-Authorization header
  field with the request.

11.4.  Credentials

  Both the Authorization field value and the Proxy-Authorization field
  value contain the client's credentials for the realm of the resource
  being requested, based upon a challenge received in a response
  (possibly at some point in the past).  When creating their values,
  the user agent ought to do so by selecting the challenge with what it
  considers to be the most secure auth-scheme that it understands,
  obtaining credentials from the user as appropriate.  Transmission of
  credentials within header field values implies significant security
  considerations regarding the confidentiality of the underlying
  connection, as described in Section 17.16.1.

    credentials = auth-scheme [ 1*SP ( token68 / #auth-param ) ]

  Upon receipt of a request for a protected resource that omits
  credentials, contains invalid credentials (e.g., a bad password) or
  partial credentials (e.g., when the authentication scheme requires
  more than one round trip), an origin server SHOULD send a 401
  (Unauthorized) response that contains a WWW-Authenticate header field
  with at least one (possibly new) challenge applicable to the
  requested resource.

  Likewise, upon receipt of a request that omits proxy credentials or
  contains invalid or partial proxy credentials, a proxy that requires
  authentication SHOULD generate a 407 (Proxy Authentication Required)
  response that contains a Proxy-Authenticate header field with at
  least one (possibly new) challenge applicable to the proxy.

  A server that receives valid credentials that are not adequate to
  gain access ought to respond with the 403 (Forbidden) status code
  (Section 15.5.4).

  HTTP does not restrict applications to this simple challenge-response
  framework for access authentication.  Additional mechanisms can be
  used, such as authentication at the transport level or via message
  encapsulation, and with additional header fields specifying
  authentication information.  However, such additional mechanisms are
  not defined by this specification.

  Note that various custom mechanisms for user authentication use the
  Set-Cookie and Cookie header fields, defined in [COOKIE], for passing
  tokens related to authentication.

11.5.  Establishing a Protection Space (Realm)

  The "realm" authentication parameter is reserved for use by
  authentication schemes that wish to indicate a scope of protection.

  A "protection space" is defined by the origin (see Section 4.3.1) of
  the server being accessed, in combination with the realm value if
  present.  These realms allow the protected resources on a server to
  be partitioned into a set of protection spaces, each with its own
  authentication scheme and/or authorization database.  The realm value
  is a string, generally assigned by the origin server, that can have
  additional semantics specific to the authentication scheme.  Note
  that a response can have multiple challenges with the same auth-
  scheme but with different realms.

  The protection space determines the domain over which credentials can
  be automatically applied.  If a prior request has been authorized,
  the user agent MAY reuse the same credentials for all other requests
  within that protection space for a period of time determined by the
  authentication scheme, parameters, and/or user preferences (such as a
  configurable inactivity timeout).

  The extent of a protection space, and therefore the requests to which
  credentials might be automatically applied, is not necessarily known
  to clients without additional information.  An authentication scheme
  might define parameters that describe the extent of a protection
  space.  Unless specifically allowed by the authentication scheme, a
  single protection space cannot extend outside the scope of its
  server.

  For historical reasons, a sender MUST only generate the quoted-string
  syntax.  Recipients might have to support both token and quoted-
  string syntax for maximum interoperability with existing clients that
  have been accepting both notations for a long time.

11.6.  Authenticating Users to Origin Servers

11.6.1.  WWW-Authenticate

  The "WWW-Authenticate" response header field indicates the
  authentication scheme(s) and parameters applicable to the target
  resource.

    WWW-Authenticate = #challenge

  A server generating a 401 (Unauthorized) response MUST send a WWW-
  Authenticate header field containing at least one challenge.  A
  server MAY generate a WWW-Authenticate header field in other response
  messages to indicate that supplying credentials (or different
  credentials) might affect the response.

  A proxy forwarding a response MUST NOT modify any WWW-Authenticate
  header fields in that response.

  User agents are advised to take special care in parsing the field
  value, as it might contain more than one challenge, and each
  challenge can contain a comma-separated list of authentication
  parameters.  Furthermore, the header field itself can occur multiple
  times.

  For instance:

  WWW-Authenticate: Basic realm="simple", Newauth realm="apps",
                   type=1, title="Login to \"apps\""

  This header field contains two challenges, one for the "Basic" scheme
  with a realm value of "simple" and another for the "Newauth" scheme
  with a realm value of "apps".  It also contains two additional
  parameters, "type" and "title".

  Some user agents do not recognize this form, however.  As a result,
  sending a WWW-Authenticate field value with more than one member on
  the same field line might not be interoperable.

     |  *Note:* The challenge grammar production uses the list syntax
     |  as well.  Therefore, a sequence of comma, whitespace, and comma
     |  can be considered either as applying to the preceding
     |  challenge, or to be an empty entry in the list of challenges.
     |  In practice, this ambiguity does not affect the semantics of
     |  the header field value and thus is harmless.

11.6.2.  Authorization

  The "Authorization" header field allows a user agent to authenticate
  itself with an origin server -- usually, but not necessarily, after
  receiving a 401 (Unauthorized) response.  Its value consists of
  credentials containing the authentication information of the user
  agent for the realm of the resource being requested.

    Authorization = credentials

  If a request is authenticated and a realm specified, the same
  credentials are presumed to be valid for all other requests within
  this realm (assuming that the authentication scheme itself does not
  require otherwise, such as credentials that vary according to a
  challenge value or using synchronized clocks).

  A proxy forwarding a request MUST NOT modify any Authorization header
  fields in that request.  See Section 3.5 of [CACHING] for details of
  and requirements pertaining to handling of the Authorization header
  field by HTTP caches.

11.6.3.  Authentication-Info

  HTTP authentication schemes can use the "Authentication-Info"
  response field to communicate information after the client's
  authentication credentials have been accepted.  This information can
  include a finalization message from the server (e.g., it can contain
  the server authentication).

  The field value is a list of parameters (name/value pairs), using the
  "auth-param" syntax defined in Section 11.3.  This specification only
  describes the generic format; authentication schemes using
  Authentication-Info will define the individual parameters.  The
  "Digest" Authentication Scheme, for instance, defines multiple
  parameters in Section 3.5 of [RFC7616].

    Authentication-Info = #auth-param

  The Authentication-Info field can be used in any HTTP response,
  independently of request method and status code.  Its semantics are
  defined by the authentication scheme indicated by the Authorization
  header field (Section 11.6.2) of the corresponding request.

  A proxy forwarding a response is not allowed to modify the field
  value in any way.

  Authentication-Info can be sent as a trailer field (Section 6.5) when
  the authentication scheme explicitly allows this.

11.7.  Authenticating Clients to Proxies

11.7.1.  Proxy-Authenticate

  The "Proxy-Authenticate" header field consists of at least one
  challenge that indicates the authentication scheme(s) and parameters
  applicable to the proxy for this request.  A proxy MUST send at least
  one Proxy-Authenticate header field in each 407 (Proxy Authentication
  Required) response that it generates.

    Proxy-Authenticate = #challenge

  Unlike WWW-Authenticate, the Proxy-Authenticate header field applies
  only to the next outbound client on the response chain.  This is
  because only the client that chose a given proxy is likely to have
  the credentials necessary for authentication.  However, when multiple
  proxies are used within the same administrative domain, such as
  office and regional caching proxies within a large corporate network,
  it is common for credentials to be generated by the user agent and
  passed through the hierarchy until consumed.  Hence, in such a
  configuration, it will appear as if Proxy-Authenticate is being
  forwarded because each proxy will send the same challenge set.

  Note that the parsing considerations for WWW-Authenticate apply to
  this header field as well; see Section 11.6.1 for details.

11.7.2.  Proxy-Authorization

  The "Proxy-Authorization" header field allows the client to identify
  itself (or its user) to a proxy that requires authentication.  Its
  value consists of credentials containing the authentication
  information of the client for the proxy and/or realm of the resource
  being requested.

    Proxy-Authorization = credentials

  Unlike Authorization, the Proxy-Authorization header field applies
  only to the next inbound proxy that demanded authentication using the
  Proxy-Authenticate header field.  When multiple proxies are used in a
  chain, the Proxy-Authorization header field is consumed by the first
  inbound proxy that was expecting to receive credentials.  A proxy MAY
  relay the credentials from the client request to the next proxy if
  that is the mechanism by which the proxies cooperatively authenticate
  a given request.

11.7.3.  Proxy-Authentication-Info

  The "Proxy-Authentication-Info" response header field is equivalent
  to Authentication-Info, except that it applies to proxy
  authentication (Section 11.3) and its semantics are defined by the
  authentication scheme indicated by the Proxy-Authorization header
  field (Section 11.7.2) of the corresponding request:

    Proxy-Authentication-Info = #auth-param

  However, unlike Authentication-Info, the Proxy-Authentication-Info
  header field applies only to the next outbound client on the response
  chain.  This is because only the client that chose a given proxy is
  likely to have the credentials necessary for authentication.
  However, when multiple proxies are used within the same
  administrative domain, such as office and regional caching proxies
  within a large corporate network, it is common for credentials to be
  generated by the user agent and passed through the hierarchy until
  consumed.  Hence, in such a configuration, it will appear as if
  Proxy-Authentication-Info is being forwarded because each proxy will
  send the same field value.

  Proxy-Authentication-Info can be sent as a trailer field
  (Section 6.5) when the authentication scheme explicitly allows this.

12.  Content Negotiation

  When responses convey content, whether indicating a success or an
  error, the origin server often has different ways of representing
  that information; for example, in different formats, languages, or
  encodings.  Likewise, different users or user agents might have
  differing capabilities, characteristics, or preferences that could
  influence which representation, among those available, would be best
  to deliver.  For this reason, HTTP provides mechanisms for content
  negotiation.

  This specification defines three patterns of content negotiation that
  can be made visible within the protocol: "proactive" negotiation,
  where the server selects the representation based upon the user
  agent's stated preferences; "reactive" negotiation, where the server
  provides a list of representations for the user agent to choose from;
  and "request content" negotiation, where the user agent selects the
  representation for a future request based upon the server's stated
  preferences in past responses.

  Other patterns of content negotiation include "conditional content",
  where the representation consists of multiple parts that are
  selectively rendered based on user agent parameters, "active
  content", where the representation contains a script that makes
  additional (more specific) requests based on the user agent
  characteristics, and "Transparent Content Negotiation" ([RFC2295]),
  where content selection is performed by an intermediary.  These
  patterns are not mutually exclusive, and each has trade-offs in
  applicability and practicality.

  Note that, in all cases, HTTP is not aware of the resource semantics.
  The consistency with which an origin server responds to requests,
  over time and over the varying dimensions of content negotiation, and
  thus the "sameness" of a resource's observed representations over
  time, is determined entirely by whatever entity or algorithm selects
  or generates those responses.

12.1.  Proactive Negotiation

  When content negotiation preferences are sent by the user agent in a
  request to encourage an algorithm located at the server to select the
  preferred representation, it is called "proactive negotiation"
  (a.k.a., "server-driven negotiation").  Selection is based on the
  available representations for a response (the dimensions over which
  it might vary, such as language, content coding, etc.) compared to
  various information supplied in the request, including both the
  explicit negotiation header fields below and implicit
  characteristics, such as the client's network address or parts of the
  User-Agent field.

  Proactive negotiation is advantageous when the algorithm for
  selecting from among the available representations is difficult to
  describe to a user agent, or when the server desires to send its
  "best guess" to the user agent along with the first response (when
  that "best guess" is good enough for the user, this avoids the round-
  trip delay of a subsequent request).  In order to improve the
  server's guess, a user agent MAY send request header fields that
  describe its preferences.

  Proactive negotiation has serious disadvantages:

  *  It is impossible for the server to accurately determine what might
     be "best" for any given user, since that would require complete
     knowledge of both the capabilities of the user agent and the
     intended use for the response (e.g., does the user want to view it
     on screen or print it on paper?);

  *  Having the user agent describe its capabilities in every request
     can be both very inefficient (given that only a small percentage
     of responses have multiple representations) and a potential risk
     to the user's privacy;

  *  It complicates the implementation of an origin server and the
     algorithms for generating responses to a request; and,

  *  It limits the reusability of responses for shared caching.

  A user agent cannot rely on proactive negotiation preferences being
  consistently honored, since the origin server might not implement
  proactive negotiation for the requested resource or might decide that
  sending a response that doesn't conform to the user agent's
  preferences is better than sending a 406 (Not Acceptable) response.

  A Vary header field (Section 12.5.5) is often sent in a response
  subject to proactive negotiation to indicate what parts of the
  request information were used in the selection algorithm.

  The request header fields Accept, Accept-Charset, Accept-Encoding,
  and Accept-Language are defined below for a user agent to engage in
  proactive negotiation of the response content.  The preferences sent
  in these fields apply to any content in the response, including
  representations of the target resource, representations of error or
  processing status, and potentially even the miscellaneous text
  strings that might appear within the protocol.

12.2.  Reactive Negotiation

  With "reactive negotiation" (a.k.a., "agent-driven negotiation"),
  selection of content (regardless of the status code) is performed by
  the user agent after receiving an initial response.  The mechanism
  for reactive negotiation might be as simple as a list of references
  to alternative representations.

  If the user agent is not satisfied by the initial response content,
  it can perform a GET request on one or more of the alternative
  resources to obtain a different representation.  Selection of such
  alternatives might be performed automatically (by the user agent) or
  manually (e.g., by the user selecting from a hypertext menu).

  A server might choose not to send an initial representation, other
  than the list of alternatives, and thereby indicate that reactive
  negotiation by the user agent is preferred.  For example, the
  alternatives listed in responses with the 300 (Multiple Choices) and
  406 (Not Acceptable) status codes include information about available
  representations so that the user or user agent can react by making a
  selection.

  Reactive negotiation is advantageous when the response would vary
  over commonly used dimensions (such as type, language, or encoding),
  when the origin server is unable to determine a user agent's
  capabilities from examining the request, and generally when public
  caches are used to distribute server load and reduce network usage.

  Reactive negotiation suffers from the disadvantages of transmitting a
  list of alternatives to the user agent, which degrades user-perceived
  latency if transmitted in the header section, and needing a second
  request to obtain an alternate representation.  Furthermore, this
  specification does not define a mechanism for supporting automatic
  selection, though it does not prevent such a mechanism from being
  developed.

12.3.  Request Content Negotiation

  When content negotiation preferences are sent in a server's response,
  the listed preferences are called "request content negotiation"
  because they intend to influence selection of an appropriate content
  for subsequent requests to that resource.  For example, the Accept
  (Section 12.5.1) and Accept-Encoding (Section 12.5.3) header fields
  can be sent in a response to indicate preferred media types and
  content codings for subsequent requests to that resource.

  Similarly, Section 3.1 of [RFC5789] defines the "Accept-Patch"
  response header field, which allows discovery of which content types
  are accepted in PATCH requests.

12.4.  Content Negotiation Field Features

12.4.1.  Absence

  For each of the content negotiation fields, a request that does not
  contain the field implies that the sender has no preference on that
  dimension of negotiation.

  If a content negotiation header field is present in a request and
  none of the available representations for the response can be
  considered acceptable according to it, the origin server can either
  honor the header field by sending a 406 (Not Acceptable) response or
  disregard the header field by treating the response as if it is not
  subject to content negotiation for that request header field.  This
  does not imply, however, that the client will be able to use the
  representation.

     |  *Note:* A user agent sending these header fields makes it
     |  easier for a server to identify an individual by virtue of the
     |  user agent's request characteristics (Section 17.13).

12.4.2.  Quality Values

  The content negotiation fields defined by this specification use a
  common parameter, named "q" (case-insensitive), to assign a relative
  "weight" to the preference for that associated kind of content.  This
  weight is referred to as a "quality value" (or "qvalue") because the
  same parameter name is often used within server configurations to
  assign a weight to the relative quality of the various
  representations that can be selected for a resource.

  The weight is normalized to a real number in the range 0 through 1,
  where 0.001 is the least preferred and 1 is the most preferred; a
  value of 0 means "not acceptable".  If no "q" parameter is present,
  the default weight is 1.

    weight = OWS ";" OWS "q=" qvalue
    qvalue = ( "0" [ "." 0*3DIGIT ] )
           / ( "1" [ "." 0*3("0") ] )

  A sender of qvalue MUST NOT generate more than three digits after the
  decimal point.  User configuration of these values ought to be
  limited in the same fashion.

12.4.3.  Wildcard Values

  Most of these header fields, where indicated, define a wildcard value
  ("*") to select unspecified values.  If no wildcard is present,
  values that are not explicitly mentioned in the field are considered
  unacceptable.  Within Vary, the wildcard value means that the
  variance is unlimited.

     |  *Note:* In practice, using wildcards in content negotiation has
     |  limited practical value because it is seldom useful to say, for
     |  example, "I prefer image/* more or less than (some other
     |  specific value)".  By sending Accept: */*;q=0, clients can
     |  explicitly request a 406 (Not Acceptable) response if a more
     |  preferred format is not available, but they still need to be
     |  able to handle a different response since the server is allowed
     |  to ignore their preference.

12.5.  Content Negotiation Fields

12.5.1.  Accept

  The "Accept" header field can be used by user agents to specify their
  preferences regarding response media types.  For example, Accept
  header fields can be used to indicate that the request is
  specifically limited to a small set of desired types, as in the case
  of a request for an in-line image.

  When sent by a server in a response, Accept provides information
  about which content types are preferred in the content of a
  subsequent request to the same resource.

    Accept = #( media-range [ weight ] )

    media-range    = ( "*/*"
                       / ( type "/" "*" )
                       / ( type "/" subtype )
                     ) parameters

  The asterisk "*" character is used to group media types into ranges,
  with "*/*" indicating all media types and "type/*" indicating all
  subtypes of that type.  The media-range can include media type
  parameters that are applicable to that range.

  Each media-range might be followed by optional applicable media type
  parameters (e.g., charset), followed by an optional "q" parameter for
  indicating a relative weight (Section 12.4.2).

  Previous specifications allowed additional extension parameters to
  appear after the weight parameter.  The accept extension grammar
  (accept-params, accept-ext) has been removed because it had a
  complicated definition, was not being used in practice, and is more
  easily deployed through new header fields.  Senders using weights
  SHOULD send "q" last (after all media-range parameters).  Recipients
  SHOULD process any parameter named "q" as weight, regardless of
  parameter ordering.

     |  *Note:* Use of the "q" parameter name to control content
     |  negotiation would interfere with any media type parameter
     |  having the same name.  Hence, the media type registry disallows
     |  parameters named "q".

  The example

  Accept: audio/*; q=0.2, audio/basic

  is interpreted as "I prefer audio/basic, but send me any audio type
  if it is the best available after an 80% markdown in quality".

  A more elaborate example is

  Accept: text/plain; q=0.5, text/html,
         text/x-dvi; q=0.8, text/x-c

  Verbally, this would be interpreted as "text/html and text/x-c are
  the equally preferred media types, but if they do not exist, then
  send the text/x-dvi representation, and if that does not exist, send
  the text/plain representation".

  Media ranges can be overridden by more specific media ranges or
  specific media types.  If more than one media range applies to a
  given type, the most specific reference has precedence.  For example,

  Accept: text/*, text/plain, text/plain;format=flowed, */*

  have the following precedence:

  1.  text/plain;format=flowed

  2.  text/plain

  3.  text/*

  4.  */*

  The media type quality factor associated with a given type is
  determined by finding the media range with the highest precedence
  that matches the type.  For example,

  Accept: text/*;q=0.3, text/plain;q=0.7, text/plain;format=flowed,
         text/plain;format=fixed;q=0.4, */*;q=0.5

  would cause the following values to be associated:

  +==========================+===============+
  | Media Type               | Quality Value |
  +==========================+===============+
  | text/plain;format=flowed | 1             |
  +--------------------------+---------------+
  | text/plain               | 0.7           |
  +--------------------------+---------------+
  | text/html                | 0.3           |
  +--------------------------+---------------+
  | image/jpeg               | 0.5           |
  +--------------------------+---------------+
  | text/plain;format=fixed  | 0.4           |
  +--------------------------+---------------+
  | text/html;level=3        | 0.7           |
  +--------------------------+---------------+

                    Table 5

     |  *Note:* A user agent might be provided with a default set of
     |  quality values for certain media ranges.  However, unless the
     |  user agent is a closed system that cannot interact with other
     |  rendering agents, this default set ought to be configurable by
     |  the user.

12.5.2.  Accept-Charset

  The "Accept-Charset" header field can be sent by a user agent to
  indicate its preferences for charsets in textual response content.
  For example, this field allows user agents capable of understanding
  more comprehensive or special-purpose charsets to signal that
  capability to an origin server that is capable of representing
  information in those charsets.

    Accept-Charset = #( ( token / "*" ) [ weight ] )

  Charset names are defined in Section 8.3.2.  A user agent MAY
  associate a quality value with each charset to indicate the user's
  relative preference for that charset, as defined in Section 12.4.2.
  An example is

  Accept-Charset: iso-8859-5, unicode-1-1;q=0.8

  The special value "*", if present in the Accept-Charset header field,
  matches every charset that is not mentioned elsewhere in the field.

     |  *Note:* Accept-Charset is deprecated because UTF-8 has become
     |  nearly ubiquitous and sending a detailed list of user-preferred
     |  charsets wastes bandwidth, increases latency, and makes passive
     |  fingerprinting far too easy (Section 17.13).  Most general-
     |  purpose user agents do not send Accept-Charset unless
     |  specifically configured to do so.

12.5.3.  Accept-Encoding

  The "Accept-Encoding" header field can be used to indicate
  preferences regarding the use of content codings (Section 8.4.1).

  When sent by a user agent in a request, Accept-Encoding indicates the
  content codings acceptable in a response.

  When sent by a server in a response, Accept-Encoding provides
  information about which content codings are preferred in the content
  of a subsequent request to the same resource.

  An "identity" token is used as a synonym for "no encoding" in order
  to communicate when no encoding is preferred.

    Accept-Encoding  = #( codings [ weight ] )
    codings          = content-coding / "identity" / "*"

  Each codings value MAY be given an associated quality value (weight)
  representing the preference for that encoding, as defined in
  Section 12.4.2.  The asterisk "*" symbol in an Accept-Encoding field
  matches any available content coding not explicitly listed in the
  field.

  Examples:

  Accept-Encoding: compress, gzip
  Accept-Encoding:
  Accept-Encoding: *
  Accept-Encoding: compress;q=0.5, gzip;q=1.0
  Accept-Encoding: gzip;q=1.0, identity; q=0.5, *;q=0

  A server tests whether a content coding for a given representation is
  acceptable using these rules:

  1.  If no Accept-Encoding header field is in the request, any content
      coding is considered acceptable by the user agent.

  2.  If the representation has no content coding, then it is
      acceptable by default unless specifically excluded by the Accept-
      Encoding header field stating either "identity;q=0" or "*;q=0"
      without a more specific entry for "identity".

  3.  If the representation's content coding is one of the content
      codings listed in the Accept-Encoding field value, then it is
      acceptable unless it is accompanied by a qvalue of 0.  (As
      defined in Section 12.4.2, a qvalue of 0 means "not acceptable".)

  A representation could be encoded with multiple content codings.
  However, most content codings are alternative ways to accomplish the
  same purpose (e.g., data compression).  When selecting between
  multiple content codings that have the same purpose, the acceptable
  content coding with the highest non-zero qvalue is preferred.

  An Accept-Encoding header field with a field value that is empty
  implies that the user agent does not want any content coding in
  response.  If a non-empty Accept-Encoding header field is present in
  a request and none of the available representations for the response
  have a content coding that is listed as acceptable, the origin server
  SHOULD send a response without any content coding unless the identity
  coding is indicated as unacceptable.

  When the Accept-Encoding header field is present in a response, it
  indicates what content codings the resource was willing to accept in
  the associated request.  The field value is evaluated the same way as
  in a request.

  Note that this information is specific to the associated request; the
  set of supported encodings might be different for other resources on
  the same server and could change over time or depend on other aspects
  of the request (such as the request method).

  Servers that fail a request due to an unsupported content coding
  ought to respond with a 415 (Unsupported Media Type) status and
  include an Accept-Encoding header field in that response, allowing
  clients to distinguish between issues related to content codings and
  media types.  In order to avoid confusion with issues related to
  media types, servers that fail a request with a 415 status for
  reasons unrelated to content codings MUST NOT include the Accept-
  Encoding header field.

  The most common use of Accept-Encoding is in responses with a 415
  (Unsupported Media Type) status code, in response to optimistic use
  of a content coding by clients.  However, the header field can also
  be used to indicate to clients that content codings are supported in
  order to optimize future interactions.  For example, a resource might
  include it in a 2xx (Successful) response when the request content
  was big enough to justify use of a compression coding but the client
  failed do so.

12.5.4.  Accept-Language

  The "Accept-Language" header field can be used by user agents to
  indicate the set of natural languages that are preferred in the
  response.  Language tags are defined in Section 8.5.1.

    Accept-Language = #( language-range [ weight ] )
    language-range  =
              <language-range, see [RFC4647], Section 2.1>

  Each language-range can be given an associated quality value
  representing an estimate of the user's preference for the languages
  specified by that range, as defined in Section 12.4.2.  For example,

  Accept-Language: da, en-gb;q=0.8, en;q=0.7

  would mean: "I prefer Danish, but will accept British English and
  other types of English".

  Note that some recipients treat the order in which language tags are
  listed as an indication of descending priority, particularly for tags
  that are assigned equal quality values (no value is the same as q=1).
  However, this behavior cannot be relied upon.  For consistency and to
  maximize interoperability, many user agents assign each language tag
  a unique quality value while also listing them in order of decreasing
  quality.  Additional discussion of language priority lists can be
  found in Section 2.3 of [RFC4647].

  For matching, Section 3 of [RFC4647] defines several matching
  schemes.  Implementations can offer the most appropriate matching
  scheme for their requirements.  The "Basic Filtering" scheme
  ([RFC4647], Section 3.3.1) is identical to the matching scheme that
  was previously defined for HTTP in Section 14.4 of [RFC2616].

  It might be contrary to the privacy expectations of the user to send
  an Accept-Language header field with the complete linguistic
  preferences of the user in every request (Section 17.13).

  Since intelligibility is highly dependent on the individual user,
  user agents need to allow user control over the linguistic preference
  (either through configuration of the user agent itself or by
  defaulting to a user controllable system setting).  A user agent that
  does not provide such control to the user MUST NOT send an Accept-
  Language header field.

     |  *Note:* User agents ought to provide guidance to users when
     |  setting a preference, since users are rarely familiar with the
     |  details of language matching as described above.  For example,
     |  users might assume that on selecting "en-gb", they will be
     |  served any kind of English document if British English is not
     |  available.  A user agent might suggest, in such a case, to add
     |  "en" to the list for better matching behavior.

12.5.5.  Vary

  The "Vary" header field in a response describes what parts of a
  request message, aside from the method and target URI, might have
  influenced the origin server's process for selecting the content of
  this response.

    Vary = #( "*" / field-name )

  A Vary field value is either the wildcard member "*" or a list of
  request field names, known as the selecting header fields, that might
  have had a role in selecting the representation for this response.
  Potential selecting header fields are not limited to fields defined
  by this specification.

  A list containing the member "*" signals that other aspects of the
  request might have played a role in selecting the response
  representation, possibly including aspects outside the message syntax
  (e.g., the client's network address).  A recipient will not be able
  to determine whether this response is appropriate for a later request
  without forwarding the request to the origin server.  A proxy MUST
  NOT generate "*" in a Vary field value.

  For example, a response that contains

  Vary: accept-encoding, accept-language

  indicates that the origin server might have used the request's
  Accept-Encoding and Accept-Language header fields (or lack thereof)
  as determining factors while choosing the content for this response.

  A Vary field containing a list of field names has two purposes:

  1.  To inform cache recipients that they MUST NOT use this response
      to satisfy a later request unless the later request has the same
      values for the listed header fields as the original request
      (Section 4.1 of [CACHING]) or reuse of the response has been
      validated by the origin server.  In other words, Vary expands the
      cache key required to match a new request to the stored cache
      entry.

  2.  To inform user agent recipients that this response was subject to
      content negotiation (Section 12) and a different representation
      might be sent in a subsequent request if other values are
      provided in the listed header fields (proactive negotiation).

  An origin server SHOULD generate a Vary header field on a cacheable
  response when it wishes that response to be selectively reused for
  subsequent requests.  Generally, that is the case when the response
  content has been tailored to better fit the preferences expressed by
  those selecting header fields, such as when an origin server has
  selected the response's language based on the request's
  Accept-Language header field.

  Vary might be elided when an origin server considers variance in
  content selection to be less significant than Vary's performance
  impact on caching, particularly when reuse is already limited by
  cache response directives (Section 5.2 of [CACHING]).

  There is no need to send the Authorization field name in Vary because
  reuse of that response for a different user is prohibited by the
  field definition (Section 11.6.2).  Likewise, if the response content
  has been selected or influenced by network region, but the origin
  server wants the cached response to be reused even if recipients move
  from one region to another, then there is no need for the origin
  server to indicate such variance in Vary.

13.  Conditional Requests

  A conditional request is an HTTP request with one or more request
  header fields that indicate a precondition to be tested before
  applying the request method to the target resource.  Section 13.2
  defines when to evaluate preconditions and their order of precedence
  when more than one precondition is present.

  Conditional GET requests are the most efficient mechanism for HTTP
  cache updates [CACHING].  Conditionals can also be applied to state-
  changing methods, such as PUT and DELETE, to prevent the "lost
  update" problem: one client accidentally overwriting the work of
  another client that has been acting in parallel.

13.1.  Preconditions

  Preconditions are usually defined with respect to a state of the
  target resource as a whole (its current value set) or the state as
  observed in a previously obtained representation (one value in that
  set).  If a resource has multiple current representations, each with
  its own observable state, a precondition will assume that the mapping
  of each request to a selected representation (Section 3.2) is
  consistent over time.  Regardless, if the mapping is inconsistent or
  the server is unable to select an appropriate representation, then no
  harm will result when the precondition evaluates to false.

  Each precondition defined below consists of a comparison between a
  set of validators obtained from prior representations of the target
  resource to the current state of validators for the selected
  representation (Section 8.8).  Hence, these preconditions evaluate
  whether the state of the target resource has changed since a given
  state known by the client.  The effect of such an evaluation depends
  on the method semantics and choice of conditional, as defined in
  Section 13.2.

  Other preconditions, defined by other specifications as extension
  fields, might place conditions on all recipients, on the state of the
  target resource in general, or on a group of resources.  For
  instance, the "If" header field in WebDAV can make a request
  conditional on various aspects of multiple resources, such as locks,
  if the recipient understands and implements that field ([WEBDAV],
  Section 10.4).

  Extensibility of preconditions is only possible when the precondition
  can be safely ignored if unknown (like If-Modified-Since), when
  deployment can be assumed for a given use case, or when
  implementation is signaled by some other property of the target
  resource.  This encourages a focus on mutually agreed deployment of
  common standards.

13.1.1.  If-Match

  The "If-Match" header field makes the request method conditional on
  the recipient origin server either having at least one current
  representation of the target resource, when the field value is "*",
  or having a current representation of the target resource that has an
  entity tag matching a member of the list of entity tags provided in
  the field value.

  An origin server MUST use the strong comparison function when
  comparing entity tags for If-Match (Section 8.8.3.2), since the
  client intends this precondition to prevent the method from being
  applied if there have been any changes to the representation data.

    If-Match = "*" / #entity-tag

  Examples:

  If-Match: "xyzzy"
  If-Match: "xyzzy", "r2d2xxxx", "c3piozzzz"
  If-Match: *

  If-Match is most often used with state-changing methods (e.g., POST,
  PUT, DELETE) to prevent accidental overwrites when multiple user
  agents might be acting in parallel on the same resource (i.e., to
  prevent the "lost update" problem).  In general, it can be used with
  any method that involves the selection or modification of a
  representation to abort the request if the selected representation's
  current entity tag is not a member within the If-Match field value.

  When an origin server receives a request that selects a
  representation and that request includes an If-Match header field,
  the origin server MUST evaluate the If-Match condition per
  Section 13.2 prior to performing the method.

  To evaluate a received If-Match header field:

  1.  If the field value is "*", the condition is true if the origin
      server has a current representation for the target resource.

  2.  If the field value is a list of entity tags, the condition is
      true if any of the listed tags match the entity tag of the
      selected representation.

  3.  Otherwise, the condition is false.

  An origin server that evaluates an If-Match condition MUST NOT
  perform the requested method if the condition evaluates to false.
  Instead, the origin server MAY indicate that the conditional request
  failed by responding with a 412 (Precondition Failed) status code.
  Alternatively, if the request is a state-changing operation that
  appears to have already been applied to the selected representation,
  the origin server MAY respond with a 2xx (Successful) status code
  (i.e., the change requested by the user agent has already succeeded,
  but the user agent might not be aware of it, perhaps because the
  prior response was lost or an equivalent change was made by some
  other user agent).

  Allowing an origin server to send a success response when a change
  request appears to have already been applied is more efficient for
  many authoring use cases, but comes with some risk if multiple user
  agents are making change requests that are very similar but not
  cooperative.  For example, multiple user agents writing to a common
  resource as a semaphore (e.g., a nonatomic increment) are likely to
  collide and potentially lose important state transitions.  For those
  kinds of resources, an origin server is better off being stringent in
  sending 412 for every failed precondition on an unsafe method.  In
  other cases, excluding the ETag field from a success response might
  encourage the user agent to perform a GET as its next request to
  eliminate confusion about the resource's current state.

  A client MAY send an If-Match header field in a GET request to
  indicate that it would prefer a 412 (Precondition Failed) response if
  the selected representation does not match.  However, this is only
  useful in range requests (Section 14) for completing a previously
  received partial representation when there is no desire for a new
  representation.  If-Range (Section 13.1.5) is better suited for range
  requests when the client prefers to receive a new representation.

  A cache or intermediary MAY ignore If-Match because its
  interoperability features are only necessary for an origin server.

  Note that an If-Match header field with a list value containing "*"
  and other values (including other instances of "*") is syntactically
  invalid (therefore not allowed to be generated) and furthermore is
  unlikely to be interoperable.

13.1.2.  If-None-Match

  The "If-None-Match" header field makes the request method conditional
  on a recipient cache or origin server either not having any current
  representation of the target resource, when the field value is "*",
  or having a selected representation with an entity tag that does not
  match any of those listed in the field value.

  A recipient MUST use the weak comparison function when comparing
  entity tags for If-None-Match (Section 8.8.3.2), since weak entity
  tags can be used for cache validation even if there have been changes
  to the representation data.

    If-None-Match = "*" / #entity-tag

  Examples:

  If-None-Match: "xyzzy"
  If-None-Match: W/"xyzzy"
  If-None-Match: "xyzzy", "r2d2xxxx", "c3piozzzz"
  If-None-Match: W/"xyzzy", W/"r2d2xxxx", W/"c3piozzzz"
  If-None-Match: *

  If-None-Match is primarily used in conditional GET requests to enable
  efficient updates of cached information with a minimum amount of
  transaction overhead.  When a client desires to update one or more
  stored responses that have entity tags, the client SHOULD generate an
  If-None-Match header field containing a list of those entity tags
  when making a GET request; this allows recipient servers to send a
  304 (Not Modified) response to indicate when one of those stored
  responses matches the selected representation.

  If-None-Match can also be used with a value of "*" to prevent an
  unsafe request method (e.g., PUT) from inadvertently modifying an
  existing representation of the target resource when the client
  believes that the resource does not have a current representation
  (Section 9.2.1).  This is a variation on the "lost update" problem
  that might arise if more than one client attempts to create an
  initial representation for the target resource.

  When an origin server receives a request that selects a
  representation and that request includes an If-None-Match header
  field, the origin server MUST evaluate the If-None-Match condition
  per Section 13.2 prior to performing the method.

  To evaluate a received If-None-Match header field:

  1.  If the field value is "*", the condition is false if the origin
      server has a current representation for the target resource.

  2.  If the field value is a list of entity tags, the condition is
      false if one of the listed tags matches the entity tag of the
      selected representation.

  3.  Otherwise, the condition is true.

  An origin server that evaluates an If-None-Match condition MUST NOT
  perform the requested method if the condition evaluates to false;
  instead, the origin server MUST respond with either a) the 304 (Not
  Modified) status code if the request method is GET or HEAD or b) the
  412 (Precondition Failed) status code for all other request methods.

  Requirements on cache handling of a received If-None-Match header
  field are defined in Section 4.3.2 of [CACHING].

  Note that an If-None-Match header field with a list value containing
  "*" and other values (including other instances of "*") is
  syntactically invalid (therefore not allowed to be generated) and
  furthermore is unlikely to be interoperable.

13.1.3.  If-Modified-Since

  The "If-Modified-Since" header field makes a GET or HEAD request
  method conditional on the selected representation's modification date
  being more recent than the date provided in the field value.
  Transfer of the selected representation's data is avoided if that
  data has not changed.

    If-Modified-Since = HTTP-date

  An example of the field is:

  If-Modified-Since: Sat, 29 Oct 1994 19:43:31 GMT

  A recipient MUST ignore If-Modified-Since if the request contains an
  If-None-Match header field; the condition in If-None-Match is
  considered to be a more accurate replacement for the condition in If-
  Modified-Since, and the two are only combined for the sake of
  interoperating with older intermediaries that might not implement
  If-None-Match.

  A recipient MUST ignore the If-Modified-Since header field if the
  received field value is not a valid HTTP-date, the field value has
  more than one member, or if the request method is neither GET nor
  HEAD.

  A recipient MUST ignore the If-Modified-Since header field if the
  resource does not have a modification date available.

  A recipient MUST interpret an If-Modified-Since field value's
  timestamp in terms of the origin server's clock.

  If-Modified-Since is typically used for two distinct purposes: 1) to
  allow efficient updates of a cached representation that does not have
  an entity tag and 2) to limit the scope of a web traversal to
  resources that have recently changed.

  When used for cache updates, a cache will typically use the value of
  the cached message's Last-Modified header field to generate the field
  value of If-Modified-Since.  This behavior is most interoperable for
  cases where clocks are poorly synchronized or when the server has
  chosen to only honor exact timestamp matches (due to a problem with
  Last-Modified dates that appear to go "back in time" when the origin
  server's clock is corrected or a representation is restored from an
  archived backup).  However, caches occasionally generate the field
  value based on other data, such as the Date header field of the
  cached message or the clock time at which the message was received,
  particularly when the cached message does not contain a Last-Modified
  header field.

  When used for limiting the scope of retrieval to a recent time
  window, a user agent will generate an If-Modified-Since field value
  based on either its own clock or a Date header field received from
  the server in a prior response.  Origin servers that choose an exact
  timestamp match based on the selected representation's Last-Modified
  header field will not be able to help the user agent limit its data
  transfers to only those changed during the specified window.

  When an origin server receives a request that selects a
  representation and that request includes an If-Modified-Since header
  field without an If-None-Match header field, the origin server SHOULD
  evaluate the If-Modified-Since condition per Section 13.2 prior to
  performing the method.

  To evaluate a received If-Modified-Since header field:

  1.  If the selected representation's last modification date is
      earlier or equal to the date provided in the field value, the
      condition is false.

  2.  Otherwise, the condition is true.

  An origin server that evaluates an If-Modified-Since condition SHOULD
  NOT perform the requested method if the condition evaluates to false;
  instead, the origin server SHOULD generate a 304 (Not Modified)
  response, including only those metadata that are useful for
  identifying or updating a previously cached response.

  Requirements on cache handling of a received If-Modified-Since header
  field are defined in Section 4.3.2 of [CACHING].

13.1.4.  If-Unmodified-Since

  The "If-Unmodified-Since" header field makes the request method
  conditional on the selected representation's last modification date
  being earlier than or equal to the date provided in the field value.
  This field accomplishes the same purpose as If-Match for cases where
  the user agent does not have an entity tag for the representation.

    If-Unmodified-Since = HTTP-date

  An example of the field is:

  If-Unmodified-Since: Sat, 29 Oct 1994 19:43:31 GMT

  A recipient MUST ignore If-Unmodified-Since if the request contains
  an If-Match header field; the condition in If-Match is considered to
  be a more accurate replacement for the condition in If-Unmodified-
  Since, and the two are only combined for the sake of interoperating
  with older intermediaries that might not implement If-Match.

  A recipient MUST ignore the If-Unmodified-Since header field if the
  received field value is not a valid HTTP-date (including when the
  field value appears to be a list of dates).

  A recipient MUST ignore the If-Unmodified-Since header field if the
  resource does not have a modification date available.

  A recipient MUST interpret an If-Unmodified-Since field value's
  timestamp in terms of the origin server's clock.

  If-Unmodified-Since is most often used with state-changing methods
  (e.g., POST, PUT, DELETE) to prevent accidental overwrites when
  multiple user agents might be acting in parallel on a resource that
  does not supply entity tags with its representations (i.e., to
  prevent the "lost update" problem).  In general, it can be used with
  any method that involves the selection or modification of a
  representation to abort the request if the selected representation's
  last modification date has changed since the date provided in the If-
  Unmodified-Since field value.

  When an origin server receives a request that selects a
  representation and that request includes an If-Unmodified-Since
  header field without an If-Match header field, the origin server MUST
  evaluate the If-Unmodified-Since condition per Section 13.2 prior to
  performing the method.

  To evaluate a received If-Unmodified-Since header field:

  1.  If the selected representation's last modification date is
      earlier than or equal to the date provided in the field value,
      the condition is true.

  2.  Otherwise, the condition is false.

  An origin server that evaluates an If-Unmodified-Since condition MUST
  NOT perform the requested method if the condition evaluates to false.
  Instead, the origin server MAY indicate that the conditional request
  failed by responding with a 412 (Precondition Failed) status code.
  Alternatively, if the request is a state-changing operation that
  appears to have already been applied to the selected representation,
  the origin server MAY respond with a 2xx (Successful) status code
  (i.e., the change requested by the user agent has already succeeded,
  but the user agent might not be aware of it, perhaps because the
  prior response was lost or an equivalent change was made by some
  other user agent).

  Allowing an origin server to send a success response when a change
  request appears to have already been applied is more efficient for
  many authoring use cases, but comes with some risk if multiple user
  agents are making change requests that are very similar but not
  cooperative.  In those cases, an origin server is better off being
  stringent in sending 412 for every failed precondition on an unsafe
  method.

  A client MAY send an If-Unmodified-Since header field in a GET
  request to indicate that it would prefer a 412 (Precondition Failed)
  response if the selected representation has been modified.  However,
  this is only useful in range requests (Section 14) for completing a
  previously received partial representation when there is no desire
  for a new representation.  If-Range (Section 13.1.5) is better suited
  for range requests when the client prefers to receive a new
  representation.

  A cache or intermediary MAY ignore If-Unmodified-Since because its
  interoperability features are only necessary for an origin server.

13.1.5.  If-Range

  The "If-Range" header field provides a special conditional request
  mechanism that is similar to the If-Match and If-Unmodified-Since
  header fields but that instructs the recipient to ignore the Range
  header field if the validator doesn't match, resulting in transfer of
  the new selected representation instead of a 412 (Precondition
  Failed) response.

  If a client has a partial copy of a representation and wishes to have
  an up-to-date copy of the entire representation, it could use the
  Range header field with a conditional GET (using either or both of
  If-Unmodified-Since and If-Match.)  However, if the precondition
  fails because the representation has been modified, the client would
  then have to make a second request to obtain the entire current
  representation.

  The "If-Range" header field allows a client to "short-circuit" the
  second request.  Informally, its meaning is as follows: if the
  representation is unchanged, send me the part(s) that I am requesting
  in Range; otherwise, send me the entire representation.

    If-Range = entity-tag / HTTP-date

  A valid entity-tag can be distinguished from a valid HTTP-date by
  examining the first three characters for a DQUOTE.

  A client MUST NOT generate an If-Range header field in a request that
  does not contain a Range header field.  A server MUST ignore an If-
  Range header field received in a request that does not contain a
  Range header field.  An origin server MUST ignore an If-Range header
  field received in a request for a target resource that does not
  support Range requests.

  A client MUST NOT generate an If-Range header field containing an
  entity tag that is marked as weak.  A client MUST NOT generate an If-
  Range header field containing an HTTP-date unless the client has no
  entity tag for the corresponding representation and the date is a
  strong validator in the sense defined by Section 8.8.2.2.

  A server that receives an If-Range header field on a Range request
  MUST evaluate the condition per Section 13.2 prior to performing the
  method.

  To evaluate a received If-Range header field containing an HTTP-date:

  1.  If the HTTP-date validator provided is not a strong validator in
      the sense defined by Section 8.8.2.2, the condition is false.

  2.  If the HTTP-date validator provided exactly matches the
      Last-Modified field value for the selected representation, the
      condition is true.

  3.  Otherwise, the condition is false.

  To evaluate a received If-Range header field containing an
  entity-tag:

  1.  If the entity-tag validator provided exactly matches the ETag
      field value for the selected representation using the strong
      comparison function (Section 8.8.3.2), the condition is true.

  2.  Otherwise, the condition is false.

  A recipient of an If-Range header field MUST ignore the Range header
  field if the If-Range condition evaluates to false.  Otherwise, the
  recipient SHOULD process the Range header field as requested.

  Note that the If-Range comparison is by exact match, including when
  the validator is an HTTP-date, and so it differs from the "earlier
  than or equal to" comparison used when evaluating an
  If-Unmodified-Since conditional.

13.2.  Evaluation of Preconditions

13.2.1.  When to Evaluate

  Except when excluded below, a recipient cache or origin server MUST
  evaluate received request preconditions after it has successfully
  performed its normal request checks and just before it would process
  the request content (if any) or perform the action associated with
  the request method.  A server MUST ignore all received preconditions
  if its response to the same request without those conditions, prior
  to processing the request content, would have been a status code
  other than a 2xx (Successful) or 412 (Precondition Failed).  In other
  words, redirects and failures that can be detected before significant
  processing occurs take precedence over the evaluation of
  preconditions.

  A server that is not the origin server for the target resource and
  cannot act as a cache for requests on the target resource MUST NOT
  evaluate the conditional request header fields defined by this
  specification, and it MUST forward them if the request is forwarded,
  since the generating client intends that they be evaluated by a
  server that can provide a current representation.  Likewise, a server
  MUST ignore the conditional request header fields defined by this
  specification when received with a request method that does not
  involve the selection or modification of a selected representation,
  such as CONNECT, OPTIONS, or TRACE.

  Note that protocol extensions can modify the conditions under which
  preconditions are evaluated or the consequences of their evaluation.
  For example, the immutable cache directive (defined by [RFC8246])
  instructs caches to forgo forwarding conditional requests when they
  hold a fresh response.

  Although conditional request header fields are defined as being
  usable with the HEAD method (to keep HEAD's semantics consistent with
  those of GET), there is no point in sending a conditional HEAD
  because a successful response is around the same size as a 304 (Not
  Modified) response and more useful than a 412 (Precondition Failed)
  response.

13.2.2.  Precedence of Preconditions

  When more than one conditional request header field is present in a
  request, the order in which the fields are evaluated becomes
  important.  In practice, the fields defined in this document are
  consistently implemented in a single, logical order, since "lost
  update" preconditions have more strict requirements than cache
  validation, a validated cache is more efficient than a partial
  response, and entity tags are presumed to be more accurate than date
  validators.

  A recipient cache or origin server MUST evaluate the request
  preconditions defined by this specification in the following order:

  1.  When recipient is the origin server and If-Match is present,
      evaluate the If-Match precondition:

      *  if true, continue to step 3

      *  if false, respond 412 (Precondition Failed) unless it can be
         determined that the state-changing request has already
         succeeded (see Section 13.1.1)

  2.  When recipient is the origin server, If-Match is not present, and
      If-Unmodified-Since is present, evaluate the If-Unmodified-Since
      precondition:

      *  if true, continue to step 3

      *  if false, respond 412 (Precondition Failed) unless it can be
         determined that the state-changing request has already
         succeeded (see Section 13.1.4)

  3.  When If-None-Match is present, evaluate the If-None-Match
      precondition:

      *  if true, continue to step 5

      *  if false for GET/HEAD, respond 304 (Not Modified)

      *  if false for other methods, respond 412 (Precondition Failed)

  4.  When the method is GET or HEAD, If-None-Match is not present, and
      If-Modified-Since is present, evaluate the If-Modified-Since
      precondition:

      *  if true, continue to step 5

      *  if false, respond 304 (Not Modified)

  5.  When the method is GET and both Range and If-Range are present,
      evaluate the If-Range precondition:

      *  if true and the Range is applicable to the selected
         representation, respond 206 (Partial Content)

      *  otherwise, ignore the Range header field and respond 200 (OK)

  6.  Otherwise,

      *  perform the requested method and respond according to its
         success or failure.

  Any extension to HTTP that defines additional conditional request
  header fields ought to define the order for evaluating such fields in
  relation to those defined in this document and other conditionals
  that might be found in practice.

14.  Range Requests

  Clients often encounter interrupted data transfers as a result of
  canceled requests or dropped connections.  When a client has stored a
  partial representation, it is desirable to request the remainder of
  that representation in a subsequent request rather than transfer the
  entire representation.  Likewise, devices with limited local storage
  might benefit from being able to request only a subset of a larger
  representation, such as a single page of a very large document, or
  the dimensions of an embedded image.

  Range requests are an OPTIONAL feature of HTTP, designed so that
  recipients not implementing this feature (or not supporting it for
  the target resource) can respond as if it is a normal GET request
  without impacting interoperability.  Partial responses are indicated
  by a distinct status code to not be mistaken for full responses by
  caches that might not implement the feature.

14.1.  Range Units

  Representation data can be partitioned into subranges when there are
  addressable structural units inherent to that data's content coding
  or media type.  For example, octet (a.k.a. byte) boundaries are a
  structural unit common to all representation data, allowing
  partitions of the data to be identified as a range of bytes at some
  offset from the start or end of that data.

  This general notion of a "range unit" is used in the Accept-Ranges
  (Section 14.3) response header field to advertise support for range
  requests, the Range (Section 14.2) request header field to delineate
  the parts of a representation that are requested, and the
  Content-Range (Section 14.4) header field to describe which part of a
  representation is being transferred.

    range-unit       = token

  All range unit names are case-insensitive and ought to be registered
  within the "HTTP Range Unit Registry", as defined in Section 16.5.1.

  Range units are intended to be extensible, as described in
  Section 16.5.

14.1.1.  Range Specifiers

  Ranges are expressed in terms of a range unit paired with a set of
  range specifiers.  The range unit name determines what kinds of
  range-spec are applicable to its own specifiers.  Hence, the
  following grammar is generic: each range unit is expected to specify
  requirements on when int-range, suffix-range, and other-range are
  allowed.

  A range request can specify a single range or a set of ranges within
  a single representation.

    ranges-specifier = range-unit "=" range-set
    range-set        = 1#range-spec
    range-spec       = int-range
                     / suffix-range
                     / other-range

  An int-range is a range expressed as two non-negative integers or as
  one non-negative integer through to the end of the representation
  data.  The range unit specifies what the integers mean (e.g., they
  might indicate unit offsets from the beginning, inclusive numbered
  parts, etc.).

    int-range     = first-pos "-" [ last-pos ]
    first-pos     = 1*DIGIT
    last-pos      = 1*DIGIT

  An int-range is invalid if the last-pos value is present and less
  than the first-pos.

  A suffix-range is a range expressed as a suffix of the representation
  data with the provided non-negative integer maximum length (in range
  units).  In other words, the last N units of the representation data.

    suffix-range  = "-" suffix-length
    suffix-length = 1*DIGIT

  To provide for extensibility, the other-range rule is a mostly
  unconstrained grammar that allows application-specific or future
  range units to define additional range specifiers.

    other-range   = 1*( %x21-2B / %x2D-7E )
                  ; 1*(VCHAR excluding comma)

  A ranges-specifier is invalid if it contains any range-spec that is
  invalid or undefined for the indicated range-unit.

  A valid ranges-specifier is "satisfiable" if it contains at least one
  range-spec that is satisfiable, as defined by the indicated
  range-unit.  Otherwise, the ranges-specifier is "unsatisfiable".

14.1.2.  Byte Ranges

  The "bytes" range unit is used to express subranges of a
  representation data's octet sequence.  Each byte range is expressed
  as an integer range at some offset, relative to either the beginning
  (int-range) or end (suffix-range) of the representation data.  Byte
  ranges do not use the other-range specifier.

  The first-pos value in a bytes int-range gives the offset of the
  first byte in a range.  The last-pos value gives the offset of the
  last byte in the range; that is, the byte positions specified are
  inclusive.  Byte offsets start at zero.

  If the representation data has a content coding applied, each byte
  range is calculated with respect to the encoded sequence of bytes,
  not the sequence of underlying bytes that would be obtained after
  decoding.

  Examples of bytes range specifiers:

  *  The first 500 bytes (byte offsets 0-499, inclusive):

          bytes=0-499

  *  The second 500 bytes (byte offsets 500-999, inclusive):

          bytes=500-999

  A client can limit the number of bytes requested without knowing the
  size of the selected representation.  If the last-pos value is
  absent, or if the value is greater than or equal to the current
  length of the representation data, the byte range is interpreted as
  the remainder of the representation (i.e., the server replaces the
  value of last-pos with a value that is one less than the current
  length of the selected representation).

  A client can refer to the last N bytes (N > 0) of the selected
  representation using a suffix-range.  If the selected representation
  is shorter than the specified suffix-length, the entire
  representation is used.

  Additional examples, assuming a representation of length 10000:

  *  The final 500 bytes (byte offsets 9500-9999, inclusive):

          bytes=-500

     Or:

          bytes=9500-

  *  The first and last bytes only (bytes 0 and 9999):

          bytes=0-0,-1

  *  The first, middle, and last 1000 bytes:

          bytes= 0-999, 4500-5499, -1000

  *  Other valid (but not canonical) specifications of the second 500
     bytes (byte offsets 500-999, inclusive):

          bytes=500-600,601-999
          bytes=500-700,601-999

  For a GET request, a valid bytes range-spec is satisfiable if it is
  either:

  *  an int-range with a first-pos that is less than the current length
     of the selected representation or

  *  a suffix-range with a non-zero suffix-length.

  When a selected representation has zero length, the only satisfiable
  form of range-spec in a GET request is a suffix-range with a non-zero
  suffix-length.

  In the byte-range syntax, first-pos, last-pos, and suffix-length are
  expressed as decimal number of octets.  Since there is no predefined
  limit to the length of content, recipients MUST anticipate
  potentially large decimal numerals and prevent parsing errors due to
  integer conversion overflows.

14.2.  Range

  The "Range" header field on a GET request modifies the method
  semantics to request transfer of only one or more subranges of the
  selected representation data (Section 8.1), rather than the entire
  selected representation.

    Range = ranges-specifier

  A server MAY ignore the Range header field.  However, origin servers
  and intermediate caches ought to support byte ranges when possible,
  since they support efficient recovery from partially failed transfers
  and partial retrieval of large representations.

  A server MUST ignore a Range header field received with a request
  method that is unrecognized or for which range handling is not
  defined.  For this specification, GET is the only method for which
  range handling is defined.

  An origin server MUST ignore a Range header field that contains a
  range unit it does not understand.  A proxy MAY discard a Range
  header field that contains a range unit it does not understand.

  A server that supports range requests MAY ignore or reject a Range
  header field that contains an invalid ranges-specifier
  (Section 14.1.1), a ranges-specifier with more than two overlapping
  ranges, or a set of many small ranges that are not listed in
  ascending order, since these are indications of either a broken
  client or a deliberate denial-of-service attack (Section 17.15).  A
  client SHOULD NOT request multiple ranges that are inherently less
  efficient to process and transfer than a single range that
  encompasses the same data.

  A server that supports range requests MAY ignore a Range header field
  when the selected representation has no content (i.e., the selected
  representation's data is of zero length).

  A client that is requesting multiple ranges SHOULD list those ranges
  in ascending order (the order in which they would typically be
  received in a complete representation) unless there is a specific
  need to request a later part earlier.  For example, a user agent
  processing a large representation with an internal catalog of parts
  might need to request later parts first, particularly if the
  representation consists of pages stored in reverse order and the user
  agent wishes to transfer one page at a time.

  The Range header field is evaluated after evaluating the precondition
  header fields defined in Section 13.1, and only if the result in
  absence of the Range header field would be a 200 (OK) response.  In
  other words, Range is ignored when a conditional GET would result in
  a 304 (Not Modified) response.

  The If-Range header field (Section 13.1.5) can be used as a
  precondition to applying the Range header field.

  If all of the preconditions are true, the server supports the Range
  header field for the target resource, the received Range field-value
  contains a valid ranges-specifier with a range-unit supported for
  that target resource, and that ranges-specifier is satisfiable with
  respect to the selected representation, the server SHOULD send a 206
  (Partial Content) response with content containing one or more
  partial representations that correspond to the satisfiable
  range-spec(s) requested.

  The above does not imply that a server will send all requested
  ranges.  In some cases, it may only be possible (or efficient) to
  send a portion of the requested ranges first, while expecting the
  client to re-request the remaining portions later if they are still
  desired (see Section 15.3.7).

  If all of the preconditions are true, the server supports the Range
  header field for the target resource, the received Range field-value
  contains a valid ranges-specifier, and either the range-unit is not
  supported for that target resource or the ranges-specifier is
  unsatisfiable with respect to the selected representation, the server
  SHOULD send a 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) response.

14.3.  Accept-Ranges

  The "Accept-Ranges" field in a response indicates whether an upstream
  server supports range requests for the target resource.

    Accept-Ranges     = acceptable-ranges
    acceptable-ranges = 1#range-unit

  For example, a server that supports byte-range requests
  (Section 14.1.2) can send the field

  Accept-Ranges: bytes

  to indicate that it supports byte range requests for that target
  resource, thereby encouraging its use by the client for future
  partial requests on the same request path.  Range units are defined
  in Section 14.1.

  A client MAY generate range requests regardless of having received an
  Accept-Ranges field.  The information only provides advice for the
  sake of improving performance and reducing unnecessary network
  transfers.

  Conversely, a client MUST NOT assume that receiving an Accept-Ranges
  field means that future range requests will return partial responses.
  The content might change, the server might only support range
  requests at certain times or under certain conditions, or a different
  intermediary might process the next request.

  A server that does not support any kind of range request for the
  target resource MAY send

  Accept-Ranges: none

  to advise the client not to attempt a range request on the same
  request path.  The range unit "none" is reserved for this purpose.

  The Accept-Ranges field MAY be sent in a trailer section, but is
  preferred to be sent as a header field because the information is
  particularly useful for restarting large information transfers that
  have failed in mid-content (before the trailer section is received).

14.4.  Content-Range

  The "Content-Range" header field is sent in a single part 206
  (Partial Content) response to indicate the partial range of the
  selected representation enclosed as the message content, sent in each
  part of a multipart 206 response to indicate the range enclosed
  within each body part (Section 14.6), and sent in 416 (Range Not
  Satisfiable) responses to provide information about the selected
  representation.

    Content-Range       = range-unit SP
                          ( range-resp / unsatisfied-range )

    range-resp          = incl-range "/" ( complete-length / "*" )
    incl-range          = first-pos "-" last-pos
    unsatisfied-range   = "*/" complete-length

    complete-length     = 1*DIGIT

  If a 206 (Partial Content) response contains a Content-Range header
  field with a range unit (Section 14.1) that the recipient does not
  understand, the recipient MUST NOT attempt to recombine it with a
  stored representation.  A proxy that receives such a message SHOULD
  forward it downstream.

  Content-Range might also be sent as a request modifier to request a
  partial PUT, as described in Section 14.5, based on private
  agreements between client and origin server.  A server MUST ignore a
  Content-Range header field received in a request with a method for
  which Content-Range support is not defined.

  For byte ranges, a sender SHOULD indicate the complete length of the
  representation from which the range has been extracted, unless the
  complete length is unknown or difficult to determine.  An asterisk
  character ("*") in place of the complete-length indicates that the
  representation length was unknown when the header field was
  generated.

  The following example illustrates when the complete length of the
  selected representation is known by the sender to be 1234 bytes:

  Content-Range: bytes 42-1233/1234

  and this second example illustrates when the complete length is
  unknown:

  Content-Range: bytes 42-1233/*

  A Content-Range field value is invalid if it contains a range-resp
  that has a last-pos value less than its first-pos value, or a
  complete-length value less than or equal to its last-pos value.  The
  recipient of an invalid Content-Range MUST NOT attempt to recombine
  the received content with a stored representation.

  A server generating a 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) response to a byte-
  range request SHOULD send a Content-Range header field with an
  unsatisfied-range value, as in the following example:

  Content-Range: bytes */1234

  The complete-length in a 416 response indicates the current length of
  the selected representation.

  The Content-Range header field has no meaning for status codes that
  do not explicitly describe its semantic.  For this specification,
  only the 206 (Partial Content) and 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) status
  codes describe a meaning for Content-Range.

  The following are examples of Content-Range values in which the
  selected representation contains a total of 1234 bytes:

  *  The first 500 bytes:

     Content-Range: bytes 0-499/1234

  *  The second 500 bytes:

     Content-Range: bytes 500-999/1234

  *  All except for the first 500 bytes:

     Content-Range: bytes 500-1233/1234

  *  The last 500 bytes:

     Content-Range: bytes 734-1233/1234

14.5.  Partial PUT

  Some origin servers support PUT of a partial representation when the
  user agent sends a Content-Range header field (Section 14.4) in the
  request, though such support is inconsistent and depends on private
  agreements with user agents.  In general, it requests that the state
  of the target resource be partly replaced with the enclosed content
  at an offset and length indicated by the Content-Range value, where
  the offset is relative to the current selected representation.

  An origin server SHOULD respond with a 400 (Bad Request) status code
  if it receives Content-Range on a PUT for a target resource that does
  not support partial PUT requests.

  Partial PUT is not backwards compatible with the original definition
  of PUT.  It may result in the content being written as a complete
  replacement for the current representation.

  Partial resource updates are also possible by targeting a separately
  identified resource with state that overlaps or extends a portion of
  the larger resource, or by using a different method that has been
  specifically defined for partial updates (for example, the PATCH
  method defined in [RFC5789]).

14.6.  Media Type multipart/byteranges

  When a 206 (Partial Content) response message includes the content of
  multiple ranges, they are transmitted as body parts in a multipart
  message body ([RFC2046], Section 5.1) with the media type of
  "multipart/byteranges".

  The "multipart/byteranges" media type includes one or more body
  parts, each with its own Content-Type and Content-Range fields.  The
  required boundary parameter specifies the boundary string used to
  separate each body part.

  Implementation Notes:

  1.  Additional CRLFs might precede the first boundary string in the
      body.

  2.  Although [RFC2046] permits the boundary string to be quoted, some
      existing implementations handle a quoted boundary string
      incorrectly.

  3.  A number of clients and servers were coded to an early draft of
      the byteranges specification that used a media type of
      "multipart/x-byteranges", which is almost (but not quite)
      compatible with this type.

  Despite the name, the "multipart/byteranges" media type is not
  limited to byte ranges.  The following example uses an "exampleunit"
  range unit:

  HTTP/1.1 206 Partial Content
  Date: Tue, 14 Nov 1995 06:25:24 GMT
  Last-Modified: Tue, 14 July 04:58:08 GMT
  Content-Length: 2331785
  Content-Type: multipart/byteranges; boundary=THIS_STRING_SEPARATES

  --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES
  Content-Type: video/example
  Content-Range: exampleunit 1.2-4.3/25

  ...the first range...
  --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES
  Content-Type: video/example
  Content-Range: exampleunit 11.2-14.3/25

  ...the second range
  --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES--

  The following information serves as the registration form for the
  "multipart/byteranges" media type.

  Type name:  multipart

  Subtype name:  byteranges

  Required parameters:  boundary

  Optional parameters:  N/A

  Encoding considerations:  only "7bit", "8bit", or "binary" are
     permitted

  Security considerations:  see Section 17

  Interoperability considerations:  N/A

  Published specification:  RFC 9110 (see Section 14.6)

  Applications that use this media type:  HTTP components supporting
     multiple ranges in a single request

  Fragment identifier considerations:  N/A

  Additional information:  Deprecated alias names for this type:  N/A

                           Magic number(s):  N/A

                           File extension(s):  N/A

                           Macintosh file type code(s):  N/A

  Person and email address to contact for further information:  See Aut
     hors' Addresses section.

  Intended usage:  COMMON

  Restrictions on usage:  N/A

  Author:  See Authors' Addresses section.

  Change controller:  IESG

15.  Status Codes

  The status code of a response is a three-digit integer code that
  describes the result of the request and the semantics of the
  response, including whether the request was successful and what
  content is enclosed (if any).  All valid status codes are within the
  range of 100 to 599, inclusive.

  The first digit of the status code defines the class of response.
  The last two digits do not have any categorization role.  There are
  five values for the first digit:

  *  1xx (Informational): The request was received, continuing process

  *  2xx (Successful): The request was successfully received,
     understood, and accepted

  *  3xx (Redirection): Further action needs to be taken in order to
     complete the request

  *  4xx (Client Error): The request contains bad syntax or cannot be
     fulfilled

  *  5xx (Server Error): The server failed to fulfill an apparently
     valid request

  HTTP status codes are extensible.  A client is not required to
  understand the meaning of all registered status codes, though such
  understanding is obviously desirable.  However, a client MUST
  understand the class of any status code, as indicated by the first
  digit, and treat an unrecognized status code as being equivalent to
  the x00 status code of that class.

  For example, if a client receives an unrecognized status code of 471,
  it can see from the first digit that there was something wrong with
  its request and treat the response as if it had received a 400 (Bad
  Request) status code.  The response message will usually contain a
  representation that explains the status.

  Values outside the range 100..599 are invalid.  Implementations often
  use three-digit integer values outside of that range (i.e., 600..999)
  for internal communication of non-HTTP status (e.g., library errors).
  A client that receives a response with an invalid status code SHOULD
  process the response as if it had a 5xx (Server Error) status code.

  A single request can have multiple associated responses: zero or more
  "interim" (non-final) responses with status codes in the
  "informational" (1xx) range, followed by exactly one "final" response
  with a status code in one of the other ranges.

15.1.  Overview of Status Codes

  The status codes listed below are defined in this specification.  The
  reason phrases listed here are only recommendations -- they can be
  replaced by local equivalents or left out altogether without
  affecting the protocol.

  Responses with status codes that are defined as heuristically
  cacheable (e.g., 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301, 308, 404, 405, 410,
  414, and 501 in this specification) can be reused by a cache with
  heuristic expiration unless otherwise indicated by the method
  definition or explicit cache controls [CACHING]; all other status
  codes are not heuristically cacheable.

  Additional status codes, outside the scope of this specification,
  have been specified for use in HTTP.  All such status codes ought to
  be registered within the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Status
  Code Registry", as described in Section 16.2.

15.2.  Informational 1xx

  The 1xx (Informational) class of status code indicates an interim
  response for communicating connection status or request progress
  prior to completing the requested action and sending a final
  response.  Since HTTP/1.0 did not define any 1xx status codes, a
  server MUST NOT send a 1xx response to an HTTP/1.0 client.

  A 1xx response is terminated by the end of the header section; it
  cannot contain content or trailers.

  A client MUST be able to parse one or more 1xx responses received
  prior to a final response, even if the client does not expect one.  A
  user agent MAY ignore unexpected 1xx responses.

  A proxy MUST forward 1xx responses unless the proxy itself requested
  the generation of the 1xx response.  For example, if a proxy adds an
  "Expect: 100-continue" header field when it forwards a request, then
  it need not forward the corresponding 100 (Continue) response(s).

15.2.1.  100 Continue

  The 100 (Continue) status code indicates that the initial part of a
  request has been received and has not yet been rejected by the
  server.  The server intends to send a final response after the
  request has been fully received and acted upon.

  When the request contains an Expect header field that includes a
  100-continue expectation, the 100 response indicates that the server
  wishes to receive the request content, as described in
  Section 10.1.1.  The client ought to continue sending the request and
  discard the 100 response.

  If the request did not contain an Expect header field containing the
  100-continue expectation, the client can simply discard this interim
  response.

15.2.2.  101 Switching Protocols

  The 101 (Switching Protocols) status code indicates that the server
  understands and is willing to comply with the client's request, via
  the Upgrade header field (Section 7.8), for a change in the
  application protocol being used on this connection.  The server MUST
  generate an Upgrade header field in the response that indicates which
  protocol(s) will be in effect after this response.

  It is assumed that the server will only agree to switch protocols
  when it is advantageous to do so.  For example, switching to a newer
  version of HTTP might be advantageous over older versions, and
  switching to a real-time, synchronous protocol might be advantageous
  when delivering resources that use such features.

15.3.  Successful 2xx

  The 2xx (Successful) class of status code indicates that the client's
  request was successfully received, understood, and accepted.

15.3.1.  200 OK

  The 200 (OK) status code indicates that the request has succeeded.
  The content sent in a 200 response depends on the request method.
  For the methods defined by this specification, the intended meaning
  of the content can be summarized as:

  +================+============================================+
  | Request Method | Response content is a representation of:   |
  +================+============================================+
  | GET            | the target resource                        |
  +----------------+--------------------------------------------+
  | HEAD           | the target resource, like GET, but without |
  |                | transferring the representation data       |
  +----------------+--------------------------------------------+
  | POST           | the status of, or results obtained from,   |
  |                | the action                                 |
  +----------------+--------------------------------------------+
  | PUT, DELETE    | the status of the action                   |
  +----------------+--------------------------------------------+
  | OPTIONS        | communication options for the target       |
  |                | resource                                   |
  +----------------+--------------------------------------------+
  | TRACE          | the request message as received by the     |
  |                | server returning the trace                 |
  +----------------+--------------------------------------------+

                              Table 6

  Aside from responses to CONNECT, a 200 response is expected to
  contain message content unless the message framing explicitly
  indicates that the content has zero length.  If some aspect of the
  request indicates a preference for no content upon success, the
  origin server ought to send a 204 (No Content) response instead.  For
  CONNECT, there is no content because the successful result is a
  tunnel, which begins immediately after the 200 response header
  section.

  A 200 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

  In 200 responses to GET or HEAD, an origin server SHOULD send any
  available validator fields (Section 8.8) for the selected
  representation, with both a strong entity tag and a Last-Modified
  date being preferred.

  In 200 responses to state-changing methods, any validator fields
  (Section 8.8) sent in the response convey the current validators for
  the new representation formed as a result of successfully applying
  the request semantics.  Note that the PUT method (Section 9.3.4) has
  additional requirements that might preclude sending such validators.

15.3.2.  201 Created

  The 201 (Created) status code indicates that the request has been
  fulfilled and has resulted in one or more new resources being
  created.  The primary resource created by the request is identified
  by either a Location header field in the response or, if no Location
  header field is received, by the target URI.

  The 201 response content typically describes and links to the
  resource(s) created.  Any validator fields (Section 8.8) sent in the
  response convey the current validators for a new representation
  created by the request.  Note that the PUT method (Section 9.3.4) has
  additional requirements that might preclude sending such validators.

15.3.3.  202 Accepted

  The 202 (Accepted) status code indicates that the request has been
  accepted for processing, but the processing has not been completed.
  The request might or might not eventually be acted upon, as it might
  be disallowed when processing actually takes place.  There is no
  facility in HTTP for re-sending a status code from an asynchronous
  operation.

  The 202 response is intentionally noncommittal.  Its purpose is to
  allow a server to accept a request for some other process (perhaps a
  batch-oriented process that is only run once per day) without
  requiring that the user agent's connection to the server persist
  until the process is completed.  The representation sent with this
  response ought to describe the request's current status and point to
  (or embed) a status monitor that can provide the user with an
  estimate of when the request will be fulfilled.

15.3.4.  203 Non-Authoritative Information

  The 203 (Non-Authoritative Information) status code indicates that
  the request was successful but the enclosed content has been modified
  from that of the origin server's 200 (OK) response by a transforming
  proxy (Section 7.7).  This status code allows the proxy to notify
  recipients when a transformation has been applied, since that
  knowledge might impact later decisions regarding the content.  For
  example, future cache validation requests for the content might only
  be applicable along the same request path (through the same proxies).

  A 203 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

15.3.5.  204 No Content

  The 204 (No Content) status code indicates that the server has
  successfully fulfilled the request and that there is no additional
  content to send in the response content.  Metadata in the response
  header fields refer to the target resource and its selected
  representation after the requested action was applied.

  For example, if a 204 status code is received in response to a PUT
  request and the response contains an ETag field, then the PUT was
  successful and the ETag field value contains the entity tag for the
  new representation of that target resource.

  The 204 response allows a server to indicate that the action has been
  successfully applied to the target resource, while implying that the
  user agent does not need to traverse away from its current "document
  view" (if any).  The server assumes that the user agent will provide
  some indication of the success to its user, in accord with its own
  interface, and apply any new or updated metadata in the response to
  its active representation.

  For example, a 204 status code is commonly used with document editing
  interfaces corresponding to a "save" action, such that the document
  being saved remains available to the user for editing.  It is also
  frequently used with interfaces that expect automated data transfers
  to be prevalent, such as within distributed version control systems.

  A 204 response is terminated by the end of the header section; it
  cannot contain content or trailers.

  A 204 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

15.3.6.  205 Reset Content

  The 205 (Reset Content) status code indicates that the server has
  fulfilled the request and desires that the user agent reset the
  "document view", which caused the request to be sent, to its original
  state as received from the origin server.

  This response is intended to support a common data entry use case
  where the user receives content that supports data entry (a form,
  notepad, canvas, etc.), enters or manipulates data in that space,
  causes the entered data to be submitted in a request, and then the
  data entry mechanism is reset for the next entry so that the user can
  easily initiate another input action.

  Since the 205 status code implies that no additional content will be
  provided, a server MUST NOT generate content in a 205 response.

15.3.7.  206 Partial Content

  The 206 (Partial Content) status code indicates that the server is
  successfully fulfilling a range request for the target resource by
  transferring one or more parts of the selected representation.

  A server that supports range requests (Section 14) will usually
  attempt to satisfy all of the requested ranges, since sending less
  data will likely result in another client request for the remainder.
  However, a server might want to send only a subset of the data
  requested for reasons of its own, such as temporary unavailability,
  cache efficiency, load balancing, etc.  Since a 206 response is self-
  descriptive, the client can still understand a response that only
  partially satisfies its range request.

  A client MUST inspect a 206 response's Content-Type and Content-Range
  field(s) to determine what parts are enclosed and whether additional
  requests are needed.

  A server that generates a 206 response MUST generate the following
  header fields, in addition to those required in the subsections
  below, if the field would have been sent in a 200 (OK) response to
  the same request: Date, Cache-Control, ETag, Expires,
  Content-Location, and Vary.

  A Content-Length header field present in a 206 response indicates the
  number of octets in the content of this message, which is usually not
  the complete length of the selected representation.  Each
  Content-Range header field includes information about the selected
  representation's complete length.

  A sender that generates a 206 response to a request with an If-Range
  header field SHOULD NOT generate other representation header fields
  beyond those required because the client already has a prior response
  containing those header fields.  Otherwise, a sender MUST generate
  all of the representation header fields that would have been sent in
  a 200 (OK) response to the same request.

  A 206 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by explicit cache controls (see Section 4.2.2 of
  [CACHING]).

15.3.7.1.  Single Part

  If a single part is being transferred, the server generating the 206
  response MUST generate a Content-Range header field, describing what
  range of the selected representation is enclosed, and a content
  consisting of the range.  For example:

  HTTP/1.1 206 Partial Content
  Date: Wed, 15 Nov 1995 06:25:24 GMT
  Last-Modified: Wed, 15 Nov 1995 04:58:08 GMT
  Content-Range: bytes 21010-47021/47022
  Content-Length: 26012
  Content-Type: image/gif

  ... 26012 bytes of partial image data ...

15.3.7.2.  Multiple Parts

  If multiple parts are being transferred, the server generating the
  206 response MUST generate "multipart/byteranges" content, as defined
  in Section 14.6, and a Content-Type header field containing the
  "multipart/byteranges" media type and its required boundary
  parameter.  To avoid confusion with single-part responses, a server
  MUST NOT generate a Content-Range header field in the HTTP header
  section of a multiple part response (this field will be sent in each
  part instead).

  Within the header area of each body part in the multipart content,
  the server MUST generate a Content-Range header field corresponding
  to the range being enclosed in that body part.  If the selected
  representation would have had a Content-Type header field in a 200
  (OK) response, the server SHOULD generate that same Content-Type
  header field in the header area of each body part.  For example:

  HTTP/1.1 206 Partial Content
  Date: Wed, 15 Nov 1995 06:25:24 GMT
  Last-Modified: Wed, 15 Nov 1995 04:58:08 GMT
  Content-Length: 1741
  Content-Type: multipart/byteranges; boundary=THIS_STRING_SEPARATES

  --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES
  Content-Type: application/pdf
  Content-Range: bytes 500-999/8000

  ...the first range...
  --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES
  Content-Type: application/pdf
  Content-Range: bytes 7000-7999/8000

  ...the second range
  --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES--

  When multiple ranges are requested, a server MAY coalesce any of the
  ranges that overlap, or that are separated by a gap that is smaller
  than the overhead of sending multiple parts, regardless of the order
  in which the corresponding range-spec appeared in the received Range
  header field.  Since the typical overhead between each part of a
  "multipart/byteranges" is around 80 bytes, depending on the selected
  representation's media type and the chosen boundary parameter length,
  it can be less efficient to transfer many small disjoint parts than
  it is to transfer the entire selected representation.

  A server MUST NOT generate a multipart response to a request for a
  single range, since a client that does not request multiple parts
  might not support multipart responses.  However, a server MAY
  generate a "multipart/byteranges" response with only a single body
  part if multiple ranges were requested and only one range was found
  to be satisfiable or only one range remained after coalescing.  A
  client that cannot process a "multipart/byteranges" response MUST NOT
  generate a request that asks for multiple ranges.

  A server that generates a multipart response SHOULD send the parts in
  the same order that the corresponding range-spec appeared in the
  received Range header field, excluding those ranges that were deemed
  unsatisfiable or that were coalesced into other ranges.  A client
  that receives a multipart response MUST inspect the Content-Range
  header field present in each body part in order to determine which
  range is contained in that body part; a client cannot rely on
  receiving the same ranges that it requested, nor the same order that
  it requested.

15.3.7.3.  Combining Parts

  A response might transfer only a subrange of a representation if the
  connection closed prematurely or if the request used one or more
  Range specifications.  After several such transfers, a client might
  have received several ranges of the same representation.  These
  ranges can only be safely combined if they all have in common the
  same strong validator (Section 8.8.1).

  A client that has received multiple partial responses to GET requests
  on a target resource MAY combine those responses into a larger
  continuous range if they share the same strong validator.

  If the most recent response is an incomplete 200 (OK) response, then
  the header fields of that response are used for any combined response
  and replace those of the matching stored responses.

  If the most recent response is a 206 (Partial Content) response and
  at least one of the matching stored responses is a 200 (OK), then the
  combined response header fields consist of the most recent 200
  response's header fields.  If all of the matching stored responses
  are 206 responses, then the stored response with the most recent
  header fields is used as the source of header fields for the combined
  response, except that the client MUST use other header fields
  provided in the new response, aside from Content-Range, to replace
  all instances of the corresponding header fields in the stored
  response.

  The combined response content consists of the union of partial
  content ranges within the new response and all of the matching stored
  responses.  If the union consists of the entire range of the
  representation, then the client MUST process the combined response as
  if it were a complete 200 (OK) response, including a Content-Length
  header field that reflects the complete length.  Otherwise, the
  client MUST process the set of continuous ranges as one of the
  following: an incomplete 200 (OK) response if the combined response
  is a prefix of the representation, a single 206 (Partial Content)
  response containing "multipart/byteranges" content, or multiple 206
  (Partial Content) responses, each with one continuous range that is
  indicated by a Content-Range header field.

15.4.  Redirection 3xx

  The 3xx (Redirection) class of status code indicates that further
  action needs to be taken by the user agent in order to fulfill the
  request.  There are several types of redirects:

  1.  Redirects that indicate this resource might be available at a
      different URI, as provided by the Location header field, as in
      the status codes 301 (Moved Permanently), 302 (Found), 307
      (Temporary Redirect), and 308 (Permanent Redirect).

  2.  Redirection that offers a choice among matching resources capable
      of representing this resource, as in the 300 (Multiple Choices)
      status code.

  3.  Redirection to a different resource, identified by the Location
      header field, that can represent an indirect response to the
      request, as in the 303 (See Other) status code.

  4.  Redirection to a previously stored result, as in the 304 (Not
      Modified) status code.

     |  *Note:* In HTTP/1.0, the status codes 301 (Moved Permanently)
     |  and 302 (Found) were originally defined as method-preserving
     |  ([HTTP/1.0], Section 9.3) to match their implementation at
     |  CERN; 303 (See Other) was defined for a redirection that
     |  changed its method to GET.  However, early user agents split on
     |  whether to redirect POST requests as POST (according to then-
     |  current specification) or as GET (the safer alternative when
     |  redirected to a different site).  Prevailing practice
     |  eventually converged on changing the method to GET.  307
     |  (Temporary Redirect) and 308 (Permanent Redirect) [RFC7538]
     |  were later added to unambiguously indicate method-preserving
     |  redirects, and status codes 301 and 302 have been adjusted to
     |  allow a POST request to be redirected as GET.

  If a Location header field (Section 10.2.2) is provided, the user
  agent MAY automatically redirect its request to the URI referenced by
  the Location field value, even if the specific status code is not
  understood.  Automatic redirection needs to be done with care for
  methods not known to be safe, as defined in Section 9.2.1, since the
  user might not wish to redirect an unsafe request.

  When automatically following a redirected request, the user agent
  SHOULD resend the original request message with the following
  modifications:

  1.  Replace the target URI with the URI referenced by the redirection
      response's Location header field value after resolving it
      relative to the original request's target URI.

  2.  Remove header fields that were automatically generated by the
      implementation, replacing them with updated values as appropriate
      to the new request.  This includes:

      1.  Connection-specific header fields (see Section 7.6.1),

      2.  Header fields specific to the client's proxy configuration,
          including (but not limited to) Proxy-Authorization,

      3.  Origin-specific header fields (if any), including (but not
          limited to) Host,

      4.  Validating header fields that were added by the
          implementation's cache (e.g., If-None-Match,
          If-Modified-Since), and

      5.  Resource-specific header fields, including (but not limited
          to) Referer, Origin, Authorization, and Cookie.

  3.  Consider removing header fields that were not automatically
      generated by the implementation (i.e., those present in the
      request because they were added by the calling context) where
      there are security implications; this includes but is not limited
      to Authorization and Cookie.

  4.  Change the request method according to the redirecting status
      code's semantics, if applicable.

  5.  If the request method has been changed to GET or HEAD, remove
      content-specific header fields, including (but not limited to)
      Content-Encoding, Content-Language, Content-Location,
      Content-Type, Content-Length, Digest, Last-Modified.

  A client SHOULD detect and intervene in cyclical redirections (i.e.,
  "infinite" redirection loops).

     |  *Note:* An earlier version of this specification recommended a
     |  maximum of five redirections ([RFC2068], Section 10.3).
     |  Content developers need to be aware that some clients might
     |  implement such a fixed limitation.

15.4.1.  300 Multiple Choices

  The 300 (Multiple Choices) status code indicates that the target
  resource has more than one representation, each with its own more
  specific identifier, and information about the alternatives is being
  provided so that the user (or user agent) can select a preferred
  representation by redirecting its request to one or more of those
  identifiers.  In other words, the server desires that the user agent
  engage in reactive negotiation to select the most appropriate
  representation(s) for its needs (Section 12).

  If the server has a preferred choice, the server SHOULD generate a
  Location header field containing a preferred choice's URI reference.
  The user agent MAY use the Location field value for automatic
  redirection.

  For request methods other than HEAD, the server SHOULD generate
  content in the 300 response containing a list of representation
  metadata and URI reference(s) from which the user or user agent can
  choose the one most preferred.  The user agent MAY make a selection
  from that list automatically if it understands the provided media
  type.  A specific format for automatic selection is not defined by
  this specification because HTTP tries to remain orthogonal to the
  definition of its content.  In practice, the representation is
  provided in some easily parsed format believed to be acceptable to
  the user agent, as determined by shared design or content
  negotiation, or in some commonly accepted hypertext format.

  A 300 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

     |  *Note:* The original proposal for the 300 status code defined
     |  the URI header field as providing a list of alternative
     |  representations, such that it would be usable for 200, 300, and
     |  406 responses and be transferred in responses to the HEAD
     |  method.  However, lack of deployment and disagreement over
     |  syntax led to both URI and Alternates (a subsequent proposal)
     |  being dropped from this specification.  It is possible to
     |  communicate the list as a Link header field value [RFC8288]
     |  whose members have a relationship of "alternate", though
     |  deployment is a chicken-and-egg problem.

15.4.2.  301 Moved Permanently

  The 301 (Moved Permanently) status code indicates that the target
  resource has been assigned a new permanent URI and any future
  references to this resource ought to use one of the enclosed URIs.
  The server is suggesting that a user agent with link-editing
  capability can permanently replace references to the target URI with
  one of the new references sent by the server.  However, this
  suggestion is usually ignored unless the user agent is actively
  editing references (e.g., engaged in authoring content), the
  connection is secured, and the origin server is a trusted authority
  for the content being edited.

  The server SHOULD generate a Location header field in the response
  containing a preferred URI reference for the new permanent URI.  The
  user agent MAY use the Location field value for automatic
  redirection.  The server's response content usually contains a short
  hypertext note with a hyperlink to the new URI(s).

     |  *Note:* For historical reasons, a user agent MAY change the
     |  request method from POST to GET for the subsequent request.  If
     |  this behavior is undesired, the 308 (Permanent Redirect) status
     |  code can be used instead.

  A 301 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

15.4.3.  302 Found

  The 302 (Found) status code indicates that the target resource
  resides temporarily under a different URI.  Since the redirection
  might be altered on occasion, the client ought to continue to use the
  target URI for future requests.

  The server SHOULD generate a Location header field in the response
  containing a URI reference for the different URI.  The user agent MAY
  use the Location field value for automatic redirection.  The server's
  response content usually contains a short hypertext note with a
  hyperlink to the different URI(s).

     |  *Note:* For historical reasons, a user agent MAY change the
     |  request method from POST to GET for the subsequent request.  If
     |  this behavior is undesired, the 307 (Temporary Redirect) status
     |  code can be used instead.

15.4.4.  303 See Other

  The 303 (See Other) status code indicates that the server is
  redirecting the user agent to a different resource, as indicated by a
  URI in the Location header field, which is intended to provide an
  indirect response to the original request.  A user agent can perform
  a retrieval request targeting that URI (a GET or HEAD request if
  using HTTP), which might also be redirected, and present the eventual
  result as an answer to the original request.  Note that the new URI
  in the Location header field is not considered equivalent to the
  target URI.

  This status code is applicable to any HTTP method.  It is primarily
  used to allow the output of a POST action to redirect the user agent
  to a different resource, since doing so provides the information
  corresponding to the POST response as a resource that can be
  separately identified, bookmarked, and cached.

  A 303 response to a GET request indicates that the origin server does
  not have a representation of the target resource that can be
  transferred by the server over HTTP.  However, the Location field
  value refers to a resource that is descriptive of the target
  resource, such that making a retrieval request on that other resource
  might result in a representation that is useful to recipients without
  implying that it represents the original target resource.  Note that
  answers to the questions of what can be represented, what
  representations are adequate, and what might be a useful description
  are outside the scope of HTTP.

  Except for responses to a HEAD request, the representation of a 303
  response ought to contain a short hypertext note with a hyperlink to
  the same URI reference provided in the Location header field.

15.4.5.  304 Not Modified

  The 304 (Not Modified) status code indicates that a conditional GET
  or HEAD request has been received and would have resulted in a 200
  (OK) response if it were not for the fact that the condition
  evaluated to false.  In other words, there is no need for the server
  to transfer a representation of the target resource because the
  request indicates that the client, which made the request
  conditional, already has a valid representation; the server is
  therefore redirecting the client to make use of that stored
  representation as if it were the content of a 200 (OK) response.

  The server generating a 304 response MUST generate any of the
  following header fields that would have been sent in a 200 (OK)
  response to the same request:

  *  Content-Location, Date, ETag, and Vary

  *  Cache-Control and Expires (see [CACHING])

  Since the goal of a 304 response is to minimize information transfer
  when the recipient already has one or more cached representations, a
  sender SHOULD NOT generate representation metadata other than the
  above listed fields unless said metadata exists for the purpose of
  guiding cache updates (e.g., Last-Modified might be useful if the
  response does not have an ETag field).

  Requirements on a cache that receives a 304 response are defined in
  Section 4.3.4 of [CACHING].  If the conditional request originated
  with an outbound client, such as a user agent with its own cache
  sending a conditional GET to a shared proxy, then the proxy SHOULD
  forward the 304 response to that client.

  A 304 response is terminated by the end of the header section; it
  cannot contain content or trailers.

15.4.6.  305 Use Proxy

  The 305 (Use Proxy) status code was defined in a previous version of
  this specification and is now deprecated (Appendix B of [RFC7231]).

15.4.7.  306 (Unused)

  The 306 status code was defined in a previous version of this
  specification, is no longer used, and the code is reserved.

15.4.8.  307 Temporary Redirect

  The 307 (Temporary Redirect) status code indicates that the target
  resource resides temporarily under a different URI and the user agent
  MUST NOT change the request method if it performs an automatic
  redirection to that URI.  Since the redirection can change over time,
  the client ought to continue using the original target URI for future
  requests.

  The server SHOULD generate a Location header field in the response
  containing a URI reference for the different URI.  The user agent MAY
  use the Location field value for automatic redirection.  The server's
  response content usually contains a short hypertext note with a
  hyperlink to the different URI(s).

15.4.9.  308 Permanent Redirect

  The 308 (Permanent Redirect) status code indicates that the target
  resource has been assigned a new permanent URI and any future
  references to this resource ought to use one of the enclosed URIs.
  The server is suggesting that a user agent with link-editing
  capability can permanently replace references to the target URI with
  one of the new references sent by the server.  However, this
  suggestion is usually ignored unless the user agent is actively
  editing references (e.g., engaged in authoring content), the
  connection is secured, and the origin server is a trusted authority
  for the content being edited.

  The server SHOULD generate a Location header field in the response
  containing a preferred URI reference for the new permanent URI.  The
  user agent MAY use the Location field value for automatic
  redirection.  The server's response content usually contains a short
  hypertext note with a hyperlink to the new URI(s).

  A 308 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

     |  *Note:* This status code is much younger (June 2014) than its
     |  sibling codes and thus might not be recognized everywhere.  See
     |  Section 4 of [RFC7538] for deployment considerations.

15.5.  Client Error 4xx

  The 4xx (Client Error) class of status code indicates that the client
  seems to have erred.  Except when responding to a HEAD request, the
  server SHOULD send a representation containing an explanation of the
  error situation, and whether it is a temporary or permanent
  condition.  These status codes are applicable to any request method.
  User agents SHOULD display any included representation to the user.

15.5.1.  400 Bad Request

  The 400 (Bad Request) status code indicates that the server cannot or
  will not process the request due to something that is perceived to be
  a client error (e.g., malformed request syntax, invalid request
  message framing, or deceptive request routing).

15.5.2.  401 Unauthorized

  The 401 (Unauthorized) status code indicates that the request has not
  been applied because it lacks valid authentication credentials for
  the target resource.  The server generating a 401 response MUST send
  a WWW-Authenticate header field (Section 11.6.1) containing at least
  one challenge applicable to the target resource.

  If the request included authentication credentials, then the 401
  response indicates that authorization has been refused for those
  credentials.  The user agent MAY repeat the request with a new or
  replaced Authorization header field (Section 11.6.2).  If the 401
  response contains the same challenge as the prior response, and the
  user agent has already attempted authentication at least once, then
  the user agent SHOULD present the enclosed representation to the
  user, since it usually contains relevant diagnostic information.

15.5.3.  402 Payment Required

  The 402 (Payment Required) status code is reserved for future use.

15.5.4.  403 Forbidden

  The 403 (Forbidden) status code indicates that the server understood
  the request but refuses to fulfill it.  A server that wishes to make
  public why the request has been forbidden can describe that reason in
  the response content (if any).

  If authentication credentials were provided in the request, the
  server considers them insufficient to grant access.  The client
  SHOULD NOT automatically repeat the request with the same
  credentials.  The client MAY repeat the request with new or different
  credentials.  However, a request might be forbidden for reasons
  unrelated to the credentials.

  An origin server that wishes to "hide" the current existence of a
  forbidden target resource MAY instead respond with a status code of
  404 (Not Found).

15.5.5.  404 Not Found

  The 404 (Not Found) status code indicates that the origin server did
  not find a current representation for the target resource or is not
  willing to disclose that one exists.  A 404 status code does not
  indicate whether this lack of representation is temporary or
  permanent; the 410 (Gone) status code is preferred over 404 if the
  origin server knows, presumably through some configurable means, that
  the condition is likely to be permanent.

  A 404 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

15.5.6.  405 Method Not Allowed

  The 405 (Method Not Allowed) status code indicates that the method
  received in the request-line is known by the origin server but not
  supported by the target resource.  The origin server MUST generate an
  Allow header field in a 405 response containing a list of the target
  resource's currently supported methods.

  A 405 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

15.5.7.  406 Not Acceptable

  The 406 (Not Acceptable) status code indicates that the target
  resource does not have a current representation that would be
  acceptable to the user agent, according to the proactive negotiation
  header fields received in the request (Section 12.1), and the server
  is unwilling to supply a default representation.

  The server SHOULD generate content containing a list of available
  representation characteristics and corresponding resource identifiers
  from which the user or user agent can choose the one most
  appropriate.  A user agent MAY automatically select the most
  appropriate choice from that list.  However, this specification does
  not define any standard for such automatic selection, as described in
  Section 15.4.1.

15.5.8.  407 Proxy Authentication Required

  The 407 (Proxy Authentication Required) status code is similar to 401
  (Unauthorized), but it indicates that the client needs to
  authenticate itself in order to use a proxy for this request.  The
  proxy MUST send a Proxy-Authenticate header field (Section 11.7.1)
  containing a challenge applicable to that proxy for the request.  The
  client MAY repeat the request with a new or replaced
  Proxy-Authorization header field (Section 11.7.2).

15.5.9.  408 Request Timeout

  The 408 (Request Timeout) status code indicates that the server did
  not receive a complete request message within the time that it was
  prepared to wait.

  If the client has an outstanding request in transit, it MAY repeat
  that request.  If the current connection is not usable (e.g., as it
  would be in HTTP/1.1 because request delimitation is lost), a new
  connection will be used.

15.5.10.  409 Conflict

  The 409 (Conflict) status code indicates that the request could not
  be completed due to a conflict with the current state of the target
  resource.  This code is used in situations where the user might be
  able to resolve the conflict and resubmit the request.  The server
  SHOULD generate content that includes enough information for a user
  to recognize the source of the conflict.

  Conflicts are most likely to occur in response to a PUT request.  For
  example, if versioning were being used and the representation being
  PUT included changes to a resource that conflict with those made by
  an earlier (third-party) request, the origin server might use a 409
  response to indicate that it can't complete the request.  In this
  case, the response representation would likely contain information
  useful for merging the differences based on the revision history.

15.5.11.  410 Gone

  The 410 (Gone) status code indicates that access to the target
  resource is no longer available at the origin server and that this
  condition is likely to be permanent.  If the origin server does not
  know, or has no facility to determine, whether or not the condition
  is permanent, the status code 404 (Not Found) ought to be used
  instead.

  The 410 response is primarily intended to assist the task of web
  maintenance by notifying the recipient that the resource is
  intentionally unavailable and that the server owners desire that
  remote links to that resource be removed.  Such an event is common
  for limited-time, promotional services and for resources belonging to
  individuals no longer associated with the origin server's site.  It
  is not necessary to mark all permanently unavailable resources as
  "gone" or to keep the mark for any length of time -- that is left to
  the discretion of the server owner.

  A 410 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

15.5.12.  411 Length Required

  The 411 (Length Required) status code indicates that the server
  refuses to accept the request without a defined Content-Length
  (Section 8.6).  The client MAY repeat the request if it adds a valid
  Content-Length header field containing the length of the request
  content.

15.5.13.  412 Precondition Failed

  The 412 (Precondition Failed) status code indicates that one or more
  conditions given in the request header fields evaluated to false when
  tested on the server (Section 13).  This response status code allows
  the client to place preconditions on the current resource state (its
  current representations and metadata) and, thus, prevent the request
  method from being applied if the target resource is in an unexpected
  state.

15.5.14.  413 Content Too Large

  The 413 (Content Too Large) status code indicates that the server is
  refusing to process a request because the request content is larger
  than the server is willing or able to process.  The server MAY
  terminate the request, if the protocol version in use allows it;
  otherwise, the server MAY close the connection.

  If the condition is temporary, the server SHOULD generate a
  Retry-After header field to indicate that it is temporary and after
  what time the client MAY try again.

15.5.15.  414 URI Too Long

  The 414 (URI Too Long) status code indicates that the server is
  refusing to service the request because the target URI is longer than
  the server is willing to interpret.  This rare condition is only
  likely to occur when a client has improperly converted a POST request
  to a GET request with long query information, when the client has
  descended into an infinite loop of redirection (e.g., a redirected
  URI prefix that points to a suffix of itself) or when the server is
  under attack by a client attempting to exploit potential security
  holes.

  A 414 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

15.5.16.  415 Unsupported Media Type

  The 415 (Unsupported Media Type) status code indicates that the
  origin server is refusing to service the request because the content
  is in a format not supported by this method on the target resource.

  The format problem might be due to the request's indicated
  Content-Type or Content-Encoding, or as a result of inspecting the
  data directly.

  If the problem was caused by an unsupported content coding, the
  Accept-Encoding response header field (Section 12.5.3) ought to be
  used to indicate which (if any) content codings would have been
  accepted in the request.

  On the other hand, if the cause was an unsupported media type, the
  Accept response header field (Section 12.5.1) can be used to indicate
  which media types would have been accepted in the request.

15.5.17.  416 Range Not Satisfiable

  The 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) status code indicates that the set of
  ranges in the request's Range header field (Section 14.2) has been
  rejected either because none of the requested ranges are satisfiable
  or because the client has requested an excessive number of small or
  overlapping ranges (a potential denial of service attack).

  Each range unit defines what is required for its own range sets to be
  satisfiable.  For example, Section 14.1.2 defines what makes a bytes
  range set satisfiable.

  A server that generates a 416 response to a byte-range request SHOULD
  generate a Content-Range header field specifying the current length
  of the selected representation (Section 14.4).

  For example:

  HTTP/1.1 416 Range Not Satisfiable
  Date: Fri, 20 Jan 2012 15:41:54 GMT
  Content-Range: bytes */47022

     |  *Note:* Because servers are free to ignore Range, many
     |  implementations will respond with the entire selected
     |  representation in a 200 (OK) response.  That is partly because
     |  most clients are prepared to receive a 200 (OK) to complete the
     |  task (albeit less efficiently) and partly because clients might
     |  not stop making an invalid range request until they have
     |  received a complete representation.  Thus, clients cannot
     |  depend on receiving a 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) response even
     |  when it is most appropriate.

15.5.18.  417 Expectation Failed

  The 417 (Expectation Failed) status code indicates that the
  expectation given in the request's Expect header field
  (Section 10.1.1) could not be met by at least one of the inbound
  servers.

15.5.19.  418 (Unused)

  [RFC2324] was an April 1 RFC that lampooned the various ways HTTP was
  abused; one such abuse was the definition of an application-specific
  418 status code, which has been deployed as a joke often enough for
  the code to be unusable for any future use.

  Therefore, the 418 status code is reserved in the IANA HTTP Status
  Code Registry.  This indicates that the status code cannot be
  assigned to other applications currently.  If future circumstances
  require its use (e.g., exhaustion of 4NN status codes), it can be re-
  assigned to another use.

15.5.20.  421 Misdirected Request

  The 421 (Misdirected Request) status code indicates that the request
  was directed at a server that is unable or unwilling to produce an
  authoritative response for the target URI.  An origin server (or
  gateway acting on behalf of the origin server) sends 421 to reject a
  target URI that does not match an origin for which the server has
  been configured (Section 4.3.1) or does not match the connection
  context over which the request was received (Section 7.4).

  A client that receives a 421 (Misdirected Request) response MAY retry
  the request, whether or not the request method is idempotent, over a
  different connection, such as a fresh connection specific to the
  target resource's origin, or via an alternative service [ALTSVC].

  A proxy MUST NOT generate a 421 response.

15.5.21.  422 Unprocessable Content

  The 422 (Unprocessable Content) status code indicates that the server
  understands the content type of the request content (hence a 415
  (Unsupported Media Type) status code is inappropriate), and the
  syntax of the request content is correct, but it was unable to
  process the contained instructions.  For example, this status code
  can be sent if an XML request content contains well-formed (i.e.,
  syntactically correct), but semantically erroneous XML instructions.

15.5.22.  426 Upgrade Required

  The 426 (Upgrade Required) status code indicates that the server
  refuses to perform the request using the current protocol but might
  be willing to do so after the client upgrades to a different
  protocol.  The server MUST send an Upgrade header field in a 426
  response to indicate the required protocol(s) (Section 7.8).

  Example:

  HTTP/1.1 426 Upgrade Required
  Upgrade: HTTP/3.0
  Connection: Upgrade
  Content-Length: 53
  Content-Type: text/plain

  This service requires use of the HTTP/3.0 protocol.

15.6.  Server Error 5xx

  The 5xx (Server Error) class of status code indicates that the server
  is aware that it has erred or is incapable of performing the
  requested method.  Except when responding to a HEAD request, the
  server SHOULD send a representation containing an explanation of the
  error situation, and whether it is a temporary or permanent
  condition.  A user agent SHOULD display any included representation
  to the user.  These status codes are applicable to any request
  method.

15.6.1.  500 Internal Server Error

  The 500 (Internal Server Error) status code indicates that the server
  encountered an unexpected condition that prevented it from fulfilling
  the request.

15.6.2.  501 Not Implemented

  The 501 (Not Implemented) status code indicates that the server does
  not support the functionality required to fulfill the request.  This
  is the appropriate response when the server does not recognize the
  request method and is not capable of supporting it for any resource.

  A 501 response is heuristically cacheable; i.e., unless otherwise
  indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
  Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

15.6.3.  502 Bad Gateway

  The 502 (Bad Gateway) status code indicates that the server, while
  acting as a gateway or proxy, received an invalid response from an
  inbound server it accessed while attempting to fulfill the request.

15.6.4.  503 Service Unavailable

  The 503 (Service Unavailable) status code indicates that the server
  is currently unable to handle the request due to a temporary overload
  or scheduled maintenance, which will likely be alleviated after some
  delay.  The server MAY send a Retry-After header field
  (Section 10.2.3) to suggest an appropriate amount of time for the
  client to wait before retrying the request.

     |  *Note:* The existence of the 503 status code does not imply
     |  that a server has to use it when becoming overloaded.  Some
     |  servers might simply refuse the connection.

15.6.5.  504 Gateway Timeout

  The 504 (Gateway Timeout) status code indicates that the server,
  while acting as a gateway or proxy, did not receive a timely response
  from an upstream server it needed to access in order to complete the
  request.

15.6.6.  505 HTTP Version Not Supported

  The 505 (HTTP Version Not Supported) status code indicates that the
  server does not support, or refuses to support, the major version of
  HTTP that was used in the request message.  The server is indicating
  that it is unable or unwilling to complete the request using the same
  major version as the client, as described in Section 2.5, other than
  with this error message.  The server SHOULD generate a representation
  for the 505 response that describes why that version is not supported
  and what other protocols are supported by that server.

16.  Extending HTTP

  HTTP defines a number of generic extension points that can be used to
  introduce capabilities to the protocol without introducing a new
  version, including methods, status codes, field names, and further
  extensibility points within defined fields, such as authentication
  schemes and cache directives (see Cache-Control extensions in
  Section 5.2.3 of [CACHING]).  Because the semantics of HTTP are not
  versioned, these extension points are persistent; the version of the
  protocol in use does not affect their semantics.

  Version-independent extensions are discouraged from depending on or
  interacting with the specific version of the protocol in use.  When
  this is unavoidable, careful consideration needs to be given to how
  the extension can interoperate across versions.

  Additionally, specific versions of HTTP might have their own
  extensibility points, such as transfer codings in HTTP/1.1
  (Section 6.1 of [HTTP/1.1]) and HTTP/2 SETTINGS or frame types
  ([HTTP/2]).  These extension points are specific to the version of
  the protocol they occur within.

  Version-specific extensions cannot override or modify the semantics
  of a version-independent mechanism or extension point (like a method
  or header field) without explicitly being allowed by that protocol
  element.  For example, the CONNECT method (Section 9.3.6) allows
  this.

  These guidelines assure that the protocol operates correctly and
  predictably, even when parts of the path implement different versions
  of HTTP.

16.1.  Method Extensibility

16.1.1.  Method Registry

  The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method Registry", maintained
  by IANA at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-methods>, registers
  method names.

  HTTP method registrations MUST include the following fields:

  *  Method Name (see Section 9)

  *  Safe ("yes" or "no", see Section 9.2.1)

  *  Idempotent ("yes" or "no", see Section 9.2.2)

  *  Pointer to specification text

  Values to be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
  [RFC8126], Section 4.8).

16.1.2.  Considerations for New Methods

  Standardized methods are generic; that is, they are potentially
  applicable to any resource, not just one particular media type, kind
  of resource, or application.  As such, it is preferred that new
  methods be registered in a document that isn't specific to a single
  application or data format, since orthogonal technologies deserve
  orthogonal specification.

  Since message parsing (Section 6) needs to be independent of method
  semantics (aside from responses to HEAD), definitions of new methods
  cannot change the parsing algorithm or prohibit the presence of
  content on either the request or the response message.  Definitions
  of new methods can specify that only a zero-length content is allowed
  by requiring a Content-Length header field with a value of "0".

  Likewise, new methods cannot use the special host:port and asterisk
  forms of request target that are allowed for CONNECT and OPTIONS,
  respectively (Section 7.1).  A full URI in absolute form is needed
  for the target URI, which means either the request target needs to be
  sent in absolute form or the target URI will be reconstructed from
  the request context in the same way it is for other methods.

  A new method definition needs to indicate whether it is safe
  (Section 9.2.1), idempotent (Section 9.2.2), cacheable
  (Section 9.2.3), what semantics are to be associated with the request
  content (if any), and what refinements the method makes to header
  field or status code semantics.  If the new method is cacheable, its
  definition ought to describe how, and under what conditions, a cache
  can store a response and use it to satisfy a subsequent request.  The
  new method ought to describe whether it can be made conditional
  (Section 13.1) and, if so, how a server responds when the condition
  is false.  Likewise, if the new method might have some use for
  partial response semantics (Section 14.2), it ought to document this,
  too.

     |  *Note:* Avoid defining a method name that starts with "M-",
     |  since that prefix might be misinterpreted as having the
     |  semantics assigned to it by [RFC2774].

16.2.  Status Code Extensibility

16.2.1.  Status Code Registry

  The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Status Code Registry",
  maintained by IANA at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-status-
  codes>, registers status code numbers.

  A registration MUST include the following fields:

  *  Status Code (3 digits)

  *  Short Description

  *  Pointer to specification text

  Values to be added to the HTTP status code namespace require IETF
  Review (see [RFC8126], Section 4.8).

16.2.2.  Considerations for New Status Codes

  When it is necessary to express semantics for a response that are not
  defined by current status codes, a new status code can be registered.
  Status codes are generic; they are potentially applicable to any
  resource, not just one particular media type, kind of resource, or
  application of HTTP.  As such, it is preferred that new status codes
  be registered in a document that isn't specific to a single
  application.

  New status codes are required to fall under one of the categories
  defined in Section 15.  To allow existing parsers to process the
  response message, new status codes cannot disallow content, although
  they can mandate a zero-length content.

  Proposals for new status codes that are not yet widely deployed ought
  to avoid allocating a specific number for the code until there is
  clear consensus that it will be registered; instead, early drafts can
  use a notation such as "4NN", or "3N0" .. "3N9", to indicate the
  class of the proposed status code(s) without consuming a number
  prematurely.

  The definition of a new status code ought to explain the request
  conditions that would cause a response containing that status code
  (e.g., combinations of request header fields and/or method(s)) along
  with any dependencies on response header fields (e.g., what fields
  are required, what fields can modify the semantics, and what field
  semantics are further refined when used with the new status code).

  By default, a status code applies only to the request corresponding
  to the response it occurs within.  If a status code applies to a
  larger scope of applicability -- for example, all requests to the
  resource in question or all requests to a server -- this must be
  explicitly specified.  When doing so, it should be noted that not all
  clients can be expected to consistently apply a larger scope because
  they might not understand the new status code.

  The definition of a new final status code ought to specify whether or
  not it is heuristically cacheable.  Note that any response with a
  final status code can be cached if the response has explicit
  freshness information.  A status code defined as heuristically
  cacheable is allowed to be cached without explicit freshness
  information.  Likewise, the definition of a status code can place
  constraints upon cache behavior if the must-understand cache
  directive is used.  See [CACHING] for more information.

  Finally, the definition of a new status code ought to indicate
  whether the content has any implied association with an identified
  resource (Section 6.4.2).

16.3.  Field Extensibility

  HTTP's most widely used extensibility point is the definition of new
  header and trailer fields.

  New fields can be defined such that, when they are understood by a
  recipient, they override or enhance the interpretation of previously
  defined fields, define preconditions on request evaluation, or refine
  the meaning of responses.

  However, defining a field doesn't guarantee its deployment or
  recognition by recipients.  Most fields are designed with the
  expectation that a recipient can safely ignore (but forward
  downstream) any field not recognized.  In other cases, the sender's
  ability to understand a given field might be indicated by its prior
  communication, perhaps in the protocol version or fields that it sent
  in prior messages, or its use of a specific media type.  Likewise,
  direct inspection of support might be possible through an OPTIONS
  request or by interacting with a defined well-known URI [RFC8615] if
  such inspection is defined along with the field being introduced.

16.3.1.  Field Name Registry

  The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Field Name Registry" defines
  the namespace for HTTP field names.

  Any party can request registration of an HTTP field.  See
  Section 16.3.2 for considerations to take into account when creating
  a new HTTP field.

  The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Field Name Registry" is
  located at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-fields/>.
  Registration requests can be made by following the instructions
  located there or by sending an email to the "[email protected]"
  mailing list.

  Field names are registered on the advice of a designated expert
  (appointed by the IESG or their delegate).  Fields with the status
  'permanent' are Specification Required ([RFC8126], Section 4.6).

  Registration requests consist of the following information:

  Field name:
     The requested field name.  It MUST conform to the field-name
     syntax defined in Section 5.1, and it SHOULD be restricted to just
     letters, digits, and hyphen ('-') characters, with the first
     character being a letter.

  Status:
     "permanent", "provisional", "deprecated", or "obsoleted".

  Specification document(s):
     Reference to the document that specifies the field, preferably
     including a URI that can be used to retrieve a copy of the
     document.  Optional but encouraged for provisional registrations.
     An indication of the relevant section(s) can also be included, but
     is not required.

  And optionally:

  Comments:  Additional information, such as about reserved entries.

  The expert(s) can define additional fields to be collected in the
  registry, in consultation with the community.

  Standards-defined names have a status of "permanent".  Other names
  can also be registered as permanent if the expert(s) finds that they
  are in use, in consultation with the community.  Other names should
  be registered as "provisional".

  Provisional entries can be removed by the expert(s) if -- in
  consultation with the community -- the expert(s) find that they are
  not in use.  The expert(s) can change a provisional entry's status to
  permanent at any time.

  Note that names can be registered by third parties (including the
  expert(s)) if the expert(s) determines that an unregistered name is
  widely deployed and not likely to be registered in a timely manner
  otherwise.

16.3.2.  Considerations for New Fields

  HTTP header and trailer fields are a widely used extension point for
  the protocol.  While they can be used in an ad hoc fashion, fields
  that are intended for wider use need to be carefully documented to
  ensure interoperability.

  In particular, authors of specifications defining new fields are
  advised to consider and, where appropriate, document the following
  aspects:

  *  Under what conditions the field can be used; e.g., only in
     responses or requests, in all messages, only on responses to a
     particular request method, etc.

  *  Whether the field semantics are further refined by their context,
     such as their use with certain request methods or status codes.

  *  The scope of applicability for the information conveyed.  By
     default, fields apply only to the message they are associated
     with, but some response fields are designed to apply to all
     representations of a resource, the resource itself, or an even
     broader scope.  Specifications that expand the scope of a response
     field will need to carefully consider issues such as content
     negotiation, the time period of applicability, and (in some cases)
     multi-tenant server deployments.

  *  Under what conditions intermediaries are allowed to insert,
     delete, or modify the field's value.

  *  If the field is allowable in trailers; by default, it will not be
     (see Section 6.5.1).

  *  Whether it is appropriate or even required to list the field name
     in the Connection header field (i.e., if the field is to be hop-
     by-hop; see Section 7.6.1).

  *  Whether the field introduces any additional security
     considerations, such as disclosure of privacy-related data.

  Request header fields have additional considerations that need to be
  documented if the default behavior is not appropriate:

  *  If it is appropriate to list the field name in a Vary response
     header field (e.g., when the request header field is used by an
     origin server's content selection algorithm; see Section 12.5.5).

  *  If the field is intended to be stored when received in a PUT
     request (see Section 9.3.4).

  *  If the field ought to be removed when automatically redirecting a
     request due to security concerns (see Section 15.4).

16.3.2.1.  Considerations for New Field Names

  Authors of specifications defining new fields are advised to choose a
  short but descriptive field name.  Short names avoid needless data
  transmission; descriptive names avoid confusion and "squatting" on
  names that might have broader uses.

  To that end, limited-use fields (such as a header confined to a
  single application or use case) are encouraged to use a name that
  includes that use (or an abbreviation) as a prefix; for example, if
  the Foo Application needs a Description field, it might use "Foo-
  Desc"; "Description" is too generic, and "Foo-Description" is
  needlessly long.

  While the field-name syntax is defined to allow any token character,
  in practice some implementations place limits on the characters they
  accept in field-names.  To be interoperable, new field names SHOULD
  constrain themselves to alphanumeric characters, "-", and ".", and
  SHOULD begin with a letter.  For example, the underscore ("_")
  character can be problematic when passed through non-HTTP gateway
  interfaces (see Section 17.10).

  Field names ought not be prefixed with "X-"; see [BCP178] for further
  information.

  Other prefixes are sometimes used in HTTP field names; for example,
  "Accept-" is used in many content negotiation headers, and "Content-"
  is used as explained in Section 6.4.  These prefixes are only an aid
  to recognizing the purpose of a field and do not trigger automatic
  processing.

16.3.2.2.  Considerations for New Field Values

  A major task in the definition of a new HTTP field is the
  specification of the field value syntax: what senders should
  generate, and how recipients should infer semantics from what is
  received.

  Authors are encouraged (but not required) to use either the ABNF
  rules in this specification or those in [RFC8941] to define the
  syntax of new field values.

  Authors are advised to carefully consider how the combination of
  multiple field lines will impact them (see Section 5.3).  Because
  senders might erroneously send multiple values, and both
  intermediaries and HTTP libraries can perform combination
  automatically, this applies to all field values -- even when only a
  single value is anticipated.

  Therefore, authors are advised to delimit or encode values that
  contain commas (e.g., with the quoted-string rule of Section 5.6.4,
  the String data type of [RFC8941], or a field-specific encoding).
  This ensures that commas within field data are not confused with the
  commas that delimit a list value.

  For example, the Content-Type field value only allows commas inside
  quoted strings, which can be reliably parsed even when multiple
  values are present.  The Location field value provides a counter-
  example that should not be emulated: because URIs can include commas,
  it is not possible to reliably distinguish between a single value
  that includes a comma from two values.

  Authors of fields with a singleton value (see Section 5.5) are
  additionally advised to document how to treat messages where the
  multiple members are present (a sensible default would be to ignore
  the field, but this might not always be the right choice).

16.4.  Authentication Scheme Extensibility

16.4.1.  Authentication Scheme Registry

  The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Authentication Scheme
  Registry" defines the namespace for the authentication schemes in
  challenges and credentials.  It is maintained at
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-authschemes>.

  Registrations MUST include the following fields:

  *  Authentication Scheme Name

  *  Pointer to specification text

  *  Notes (optional)

  Values to be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
  [RFC8126], Section 4.8).

16.4.2.  Considerations for New Authentication Schemes

  There are certain aspects of the HTTP Authentication framework that
  put constraints on how new authentication schemes can work:

  *  HTTP authentication is presumed to be stateless: all of the
     information necessary to authenticate a request MUST be provided
     in the request, rather than be dependent on the server remembering
     prior requests.  Authentication based on, or bound to, the
     underlying connection is outside the scope of this specification
     and inherently flawed unless steps are taken to ensure that the
     connection cannot be used by any party other than the
     authenticated user (see Section 3.3).

  *  The authentication parameter "realm" is reserved for defining
     protection spaces as described in Section 11.5.  New schemes MUST
     NOT use it in a way incompatible with that definition.

  *  The "token68" notation was introduced for compatibility with
     existing authentication schemes and can only be used once per
     challenge or credential.  Thus, new schemes ought to use the auth-
     param syntax instead, because otherwise future extensions will be
     impossible.

  *  The parsing of challenges and credentials is defined by this
     specification and cannot be modified by new authentication
     schemes.  When the auth-param syntax is used, all parameters ought
     to support both token and quoted-string syntax, and syntactical
     constraints ought to be defined on the field value after parsing
     (i.e., quoted-string processing).  This is necessary so that
     recipients can use a generic parser that applies to all
     authentication schemes.

     *Note:* The fact that the value syntax for the "realm" parameter
     is restricted to quoted-string was a bad design choice not to be
     repeated for new parameters.

  *  Definitions of new schemes ought to define the treatment of
     unknown extension parameters.  In general, a "must-ignore" rule is
     preferable to a "must-understand" rule, because otherwise it will
     be hard to introduce new parameters in the presence of legacy
     recipients.  Furthermore, it's good to describe the policy for
     defining new parameters (such as "update the specification" or
     "use this registry").

  *  Authentication schemes need to document whether they are usable in
     origin-server authentication (i.e., using WWW-Authenticate), and/
     or proxy authentication (i.e., using Proxy-Authenticate).

  *  The credentials carried in an Authorization header field are
     specific to the user agent and, therefore, have the same effect on
     HTTP caches as the "private" cache response directive
     (Section 5.2.2.7 of [CACHING]), within the scope of the request in
     which they appear.

     Therefore, new authentication schemes that choose not to carry
     credentials in the Authorization header field (e.g., using a newly
     defined header field) will need to explicitly disallow caching, by
     mandating the use of cache response directives (e.g., "private").

  *  Schemes using Authentication-Info, Proxy-Authentication-Info, or
     any other authentication related response header field need to
     consider and document the related security considerations (see
     Section 17.16.4).

16.5.  Range Unit Extensibility

16.5.1.  Range Unit Registry

  The "HTTP Range Unit Registry" defines the namespace for the range
  unit names and refers to their corresponding specifications.  It is
  maintained at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters>.

  Registration of an HTTP Range Unit MUST include the following fields:

  *  Name

  *  Description

  *  Pointer to specification text

  Values to be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
  [RFC8126], Section 4.8).

16.5.2.  Considerations for New Range Units

  Other range units, such as format-specific boundaries like pages,
  sections, records, rows, or time, are potentially usable in HTTP for
  application-specific purposes, but are not commonly used in practice.
  Implementors of alternative range units ought to consider how they
  would work with content codings and general-purpose intermediaries.

16.6.  Content Coding Extensibility

16.6.1.  Content Coding Registry

  The "HTTP Content Coding Registry", maintained by IANA at
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/>, registers
  content-coding names.

  Content coding registrations MUST include the following fields:

  *  Name

  *  Description

  *  Pointer to specification text

  Names of content codings MUST NOT overlap with names of transfer
  codings (per the "HTTP Transfer Coding Registry" located at
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/>) unless the
  encoding transformation is identical (as is the case for the
  compression codings defined in Section 8.4.1).

  Values to be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
  Section 4.8 of [RFC8126]) and MUST conform to the purpose of content
  coding defined in Section 8.4.1.

16.6.2.  Considerations for New Content Codings

  New content codings ought to be self-descriptive whenever possible,
  with optional parameters discoverable within the coding format
  itself, rather than rely on external metadata that might be lost
  during transit.

16.7.  Upgrade Token Registry

  The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Upgrade Token Registry"
  defines the namespace for protocol-name tokens used to identify
  protocols in the Upgrade header field.  The registry is maintained at
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-upgrade-tokens>.

  Each registered protocol name is associated with contact information
  and an optional set of specifications that details how the connection
  will be processed after it has been upgraded.

  Registrations happen on a "First Come First Served" basis (see
  Section 4.4 of [RFC8126]) and are subject to the following rules:

  1.  A protocol-name token, once registered, stays registered forever.

  2.  A protocol-name token is case-insensitive and registered with the
      preferred case to be generated by senders.

  3.  The registration MUST name a responsible party for the
      registration.

  4.  The registration MUST name a point of contact.

  5.  The registration MAY name a set of specifications associated with
      that token.  Such specifications need not be publicly available.

  6.  The registration SHOULD name a set of expected "protocol-version"
      tokens associated with that token at the time of registration.

  7.  The responsible party MAY change the registration at any time.
      The IANA will keep a record of all such changes, and make them
      available upon request.

  8.  The IESG MAY reassign responsibility for a protocol token.  This
      will normally only be used in the case when a responsible party
      cannot be contacted.

17.  Security Considerations

  This section is meant to inform developers, information providers,
  and users of known security concerns relevant to HTTP semantics and
  its use for transferring information over the Internet.
  Considerations related to caching are discussed in Section 7 of
  [CACHING], and considerations related to HTTP/1.1 message syntax and
  parsing are discussed in Section 11 of [HTTP/1.1].

  The list of considerations below is not exhaustive.  Most security
  concerns related to HTTP semantics are about securing server-side
  applications (code behind the HTTP interface), securing user agent
  processing of content received via HTTP, or secure use of the
  Internet in general, rather than security of the protocol.  The
  security considerations for URIs, which are fundamental to HTTP
  operation, are discussed in Section 7 of [URI].  Various
  organizations maintain topical information and links to current
  research on Web application security (e.g., [OWASP]).

17.1.  Establishing Authority

  HTTP relies on the notion of an "authoritative response": a response
  that has been determined by (or at the direction of) the origin
  server identified within the target URI to be the most appropriate
  response for that request given the state of the target resource at
  the time of response message origination.

  When a registered name is used in the authority component, the "http"
  URI scheme (Section 4.2.1) relies on the user's local name resolution
  service to determine where it can find authoritative responses.  This
  means that any attack on a user's network host table, cached names,
  or name resolution libraries becomes an avenue for attack on
  establishing authority for "http" URIs.  Likewise, the user's choice
  of server for Domain Name Service (DNS), and the hierarchy of servers
  from which it obtains resolution results, could impact the
  authenticity of address mappings; DNS Security Extensions (DNSSEC,
  [RFC4033]) are one way to improve authenticity, as are the various
  mechanisms for making DNS requests over more secure transfer
  protocols.

  Furthermore, after an IP address is obtained, establishing authority
  for an "http" URI is vulnerable to attacks on Internet Protocol
  routing.

  The "https" scheme (Section 4.2.2) is intended to prevent (or at
  least reveal) many of these potential attacks on establishing
  authority, provided that the negotiated connection is secured and the
  client properly verifies that the communicating server's identity
  matches the target URI's authority component (Section 4.3.4).
  Correctly implementing such verification can be difficult (see
  [Georgiev]).

  Authority for a given origin server can be delegated through protocol
  extensions; for example, [ALTSVC].  Likewise, the set of servers for
  which a connection is considered authoritative can be changed with a
  protocol extension like [RFC8336].

  Providing a response from a non-authoritative source, such as a
  shared proxy cache, is often useful to improve performance and
  availability, but only to the extent that the source can be trusted
  or the distrusted response can be safely used.

  Unfortunately, communicating authority to users can be difficult.
  For example, "phishing" is an attack on the user's perception of
  authority, where that perception can be misled by presenting similar
  branding in hypertext, possibly aided by userinfo obfuscating the
  authority component (see Section 4.2.1).  User agents can reduce the
  impact of phishing attacks by enabling users to easily inspect a
  target URI prior to making an action, by prominently distinguishing
  (or rejecting) userinfo when present, and by not sending stored
  credentials and cookies when the referring document is from an
  unknown or untrusted source.

17.2.  Risks of Intermediaries

  HTTP intermediaries are inherently situated for on-path attacks.
  Compromise of the systems on which the intermediaries run can result
  in serious security and privacy problems.  Intermediaries might have
  access to security-related information, personal information about
  individual users and organizations, and proprietary information
  belonging to users and content providers.  A compromised
  intermediary, or an intermediary implemented or configured without
  regard to security and privacy considerations, might be used in the
  commission of a wide range of potential attacks.

  Intermediaries that contain a shared cache are especially vulnerable
  to cache poisoning attacks, as described in Section 7 of [CACHING].

  Implementers need to consider the privacy and security implications
  of their design and coding decisions, and of the configuration
  options they provide to operators (especially the default
  configuration).

  Intermediaries are no more trustworthy than the people and policies
  under which they operate; HTTP cannot solve this problem.

17.3.  Attacks Based on File and Path Names

  Origin servers frequently make use of their local file system to
  manage the mapping from target URI to resource representations.  Most
  file systems are not designed to protect against malicious file or
  path names.  Therefore, an origin server needs to avoid accessing
  names that have a special significance to the system when mapping the
  target resource to files, folders, or directories.

  For example, UNIX, Microsoft Windows, and other operating systems use
  ".." as a path component to indicate a directory level above the
  current one, and they use specially named paths or file names to send
  data to system devices.  Similar naming conventions might exist
  within other types of storage systems.  Likewise, local storage
  systems have an annoying tendency to prefer user-friendliness over
  security when handling invalid or unexpected characters,
  recomposition of decomposed characters, and case-normalization of
  case-insensitive names.

  Attacks based on such special names tend to focus on either denial-
  of-service (e.g., telling the server to read from a COM port) or
  disclosure of configuration and source files that are not meant to be
  served.

17.4.  Attacks Based on Command, Code, or Query Injection

  Origin servers often use parameters within the URI as a means of
  identifying system services, selecting database entries, or choosing
  a data source.  However, data received in a request cannot be
  trusted.  An attacker could construct any of the request data
  elements (method, target URI, header fields, or content) to contain
  data that might be misinterpreted as a command, code, or query when
  passed through a command invocation, language interpreter, or
  database interface.

  For example, SQL injection is a common attack wherein additional
  query language is inserted within some part of the target URI or
  header fields (e.g., Host, Referer, etc.).  If the received data is
  used directly within a SELECT statement, the query language might be
  interpreted as a database command instead of a simple string value.
  This type of implementation vulnerability is extremely common, in
  spite of being easy to prevent.

  In general, resource implementations ought to avoid use of request
  data in contexts that are processed or interpreted as instructions.
  Parameters ought to be compared to fixed strings and acted upon as a
  result of that comparison, rather than passed through an interface
  that is not prepared for untrusted data.  Received data that isn't
  based on fixed parameters ought to be carefully filtered or encoded
  to avoid being misinterpreted.

  Similar considerations apply to request data when it is stored and
  later processed, such as within log files, monitoring tools, or when
  included within a data format that allows embedded scripts.

17.5.  Attacks via Protocol Element Length

  Because HTTP uses mostly textual, character-delimited fields, parsers
  are often vulnerable to attacks based on sending very long (or very
  slow) streams of data, particularly where an implementation is
  expecting a protocol element with no predefined length (Section 2.3).

  To promote interoperability, specific recommendations are made for
  minimum size limits on fields (Section 5.4).  These are minimum
  recommendations, chosen to be supportable even by implementations
  with limited resources; it is expected that most implementations will
  choose substantially higher limits.

  A server can reject a message that has a target URI that is too long
  (Section 15.5.15) or request content that is too large
  (Section 15.5.14).  Additional status codes related to capacity
  limits have been defined by extensions to HTTP [RFC6585].

  Recipients ought to carefully limit the extent to which they process
  other protocol elements, including (but not limited to) request
  methods, response status phrases, field names, numeric values, and
  chunk lengths.  Failure to limit such processing can result in
  arbitrary code execution due to buffer or arithmetic overflows, and
  increased vulnerability to denial-of-service attacks.

17.6.  Attacks Using Shared-Dictionary Compression

  Some attacks on encrypted protocols use the differences in size
  created by dynamic compression to reveal confidential information;
  for example, [BREACH].  These attacks rely on creating a redundancy
  between attacker-controlled content and the confidential information,
  such that a dynamic compression algorithm using the same dictionary
  for both content will compress more efficiently when the attacker-
  controlled content matches parts of the confidential content.

  HTTP messages can be compressed in a number of ways, including using
  TLS compression, content codings, transfer codings, and other
  extension or version-specific mechanisms.

  The most effective mitigation for this risk is to disable compression
  on sensitive data, or to strictly separate sensitive data from
  attacker-controlled data so that they cannot share the same
  compression dictionary.  With careful design, a compression scheme
  can be designed in a way that is not considered exploitable in
  limited use cases, such as HPACK ([HPACK]).

17.7.  Disclosure of Personal Information

  Clients are often privy to large amounts of personal information,
  including both information provided by the user to interact with
  resources (e.g., the user's name, location, mail address, passwords,
  encryption keys, etc.) and information about the user's browsing
  activity over time (e.g., history, bookmarks, etc.).  Implementations
  need to prevent unintentional disclosure of personal information.

17.8.  Privacy of Server Log Information

  A server is in the position to save personal data about a user's
  requests over time, which might identify their reading patterns or
  subjects of interest.  In particular, log information gathered at an
  intermediary often contains a history of user agent interaction,
  across a multitude of sites, that can be traced to individual users.

  HTTP log information is confidential in nature; its handling is often
  constrained by laws and regulations.  Log information needs to be
  securely stored and appropriate guidelines followed for its analysis.
  Anonymization of personal information within individual entries
  helps, but it is generally not sufficient to prevent real log traces
  from being re-identified based on correlation with other access
  characteristics.  As such, access traces that are keyed to a specific
  client are unsafe to publish even if the key is pseudonymous.

  To minimize the risk of theft or accidental publication, log
  information ought to be purged of personally identifiable
  information, including user identifiers, IP addresses, and user-
  provided query parameters, as soon as that information is no longer
  necessary to support operational needs for security, auditing, or
  fraud control.

17.9.  Disclosure of Sensitive Information in URIs

  URIs are intended to be shared, not secured, even when they identify
  secure resources.  URIs are often shown on displays, added to
  templates when a page is printed, and stored in a variety of
  unprotected bookmark lists.  Many servers, proxies, and user agents
  log or display the target URI in places where it might be visible to
  third parties.  It is therefore unwise to include information within
  a URI that is sensitive, personally identifiable, or a risk to
  disclose.

  When an application uses client-side mechanisms to construct a target
  URI out of user-provided information, such as the query fields of a
  form using GET, potentially sensitive data might be provided that
  would not be appropriate for disclosure within a URI.  POST is often
  preferred in such cases because it usually doesn't construct a URI;
  instead, POST of a form transmits the potentially sensitive data in
  the request content.  However, this hinders caching and uses an
  unsafe method for what would otherwise be a safe request.
  Alternative workarounds include transforming the user-provided data
  prior to constructing the URI or filtering the data to only include
  common values that are not sensitive.  Likewise, redirecting the
  result of a query to a different (server-generated) URI can remove
  potentially sensitive data from later links and provide a cacheable
  response for later reuse.

  Since the Referer header field tells a target site about the context
  that resulted in a request, it has the potential to reveal
  information about the user's immediate browsing history and any
  personal information that might be found in the referring resource's
  URI.  Limitations on the Referer header field are described in
  Section 10.1.3 to address some of its security considerations.

17.10.  Application Handling of Field Names

  Servers often use non-HTTP gateway interfaces and frameworks to
  process a received request and produce content for the response.  For
  historical reasons, such interfaces often pass received field names
  as external variable names, using a name mapping suitable for
  environment variables.

  For example, the Common Gateway Interface (CGI) mapping of protocol-
  specific meta-variables, defined by Section 4.1.18 of [RFC3875], is
  applied to received header fields that do not correspond to one of
  CGI's standard variables; the mapping consists of prepending "HTTP_"
  to each name and changing all instances of hyphen ("-") to underscore
  ("_").  This same mapping has been inherited by many other
  application frameworks in order to simplify moving applications from
  one platform to the next.

  In CGI, a received Content-Length field would be passed as the meta-
  variable "CONTENT_LENGTH" with a string value matching the received
  field's value.  In contrast, a received "Content_Length" header field
  would be passed as the protocol-specific meta-variable
  "HTTP_CONTENT_LENGTH", which might lead to some confusion if an
  application mistakenly reads the protocol-specific meta-variable
  instead of the default one.  (This historical practice is why
  Section 16.3.2.1 discourages the creation of new field names that
  contain an underscore.)

  Unfortunately, mapping field names to different interface names can
  lead to security vulnerabilities if the mapping is incomplete or
  ambiguous.  For example, if an attacker were to send a field named
  "Transfer_Encoding", a naive interface might map that to the same
  variable name as the "Transfer-Encoding" field, resulting in a
  potential request smuggling vulnerability (Section 11.2 of
  [HTTP/1.1]).

  To mitigate the associated risks, implementations that perform such
  mappings are advised to make the mapping unambiguous and complete for
  the full range of potential octets received as a name (including
  those that are discouraged or forbidden by the HTTP grammar).  For
  example, a field with an unusual name character might result in the
  request being blocked, the specific field being removed, or the name
  being passed with a different prefix to distinguish it from other
  fields.

17.11.  Disclosure of Fragment after Redirects

  Although fragment identifiers used within URI references are not sent
  in requests, implementers ought to be aware that they will be visible
  to the user agent and any extensions or scripts running as a result
  of the response.  In particular, when a redirect occurs and the
  original request's fragment identifier is inherited by the new
  reference in Location (Section 10.2.2), this might have the effect of
  disclosing one site's fragment to another site.  If the first site
  uses personal information in fragments, it ought to ensure that
  redirects to other sites include a (possibly empty) fragment
  component in order to block that inheritance.

17.12.  Disclosure of Product Information

  The User-Agent (Section 10.1.5), Via (Section 7.6.3), and Server
  (Section 10.2.4) header fields often reveal information about the
  respective sender's software systems.  In theory, this can make it
  easier for an attacker to exploit known security holes; in practice,
  attackers tend to try all potential holes regardless of the apparent
  software versions being used.

  Proxies that serve as a portal through a network firewall ought to
  take special precautions regarding the transfer of header information
  that might identify hosts behind the firewall.  The Via header field
  allows intermediaries to replace sensitive machine names with
  pseudonyms.

17.13.  Browser Fingerprinting

  Browser fingerprinting is a set of techniques for identifying a
  specific user agent over time through its unique set of
  characteristics.  These characteristics might include information
  related to how it uses the underlying transport protocol, feature
  capabilities, and scripting environment, though of particular
  interest here is the set of unique characteristics that might be
  communicated via HTTP.  Fingerprinting is considered a privacy
  concern because it enables tracking of a user agent's behavior over
  time ([Bujlow]) without the corresponding controls that the user
  might have over other forms of data collection (e.g., cookies).  Many
  general-purpose user agents (i.e., Web browsers) have taken steps to
  reduce their fingerprints.

  There are a number of request header fields that might reveal
  information to servers that is sufficiently unique to enable
  fingerprinting.  The From header field is the most obvious, though it
  is expected that From will only be sent when self-identification is
  desired by the user.  Likewise, Cookie header fields are deliberately
  designed to enable re-identification, so fingerprinting concerns only
  apply to situations where cookies are disabled or restricted by the
  user agent's configuration.

  The User-Agent header field might contain enough information to
  uniquely identify a specific device, usually when combined with other
  characteristics, particularly if the user agent sends excessive
  details about the user's system or extensions.  However, the source
  of unique information that is least expected by users is proactive
  negotiation (Section 12.1), including the Accept, Accept-Charset,
  Accept-Encoding, and Accept-Language header fields.

  In addition to the fingerprinting concern, detailed use of the
  Accept-Language header field can reveal information the user might
  consider to be of a private nature.  For example, understanding a
  given language set might be strongly correlated to membership in a
  particular ethnic group.  An approach that limits such loss of
  privacy would be for a user agent to omit the sending of Accept-
  Language except for sites that have been explicitly permitted,
  perhaps via interaction after detecting a Vary header field that
  indicates language negotiation might be useful.

  In environments where proxies are used to enhance privacy, user
  agents ought to be conservative in sending proactive negotiation
  header fields.  General-purpose user agents that provide a high
  degree of header field configurability ought to inform users about
  the loss of privacy that might result if too much detail is provided.
  As an extreme privacy measure, proxies could filter the proactive
  negotiation header fields in relayed requests.

17.14.  Validator Retention

  The validators defined by this specification are not intended to
  ensure the validity of a representation, guard against malicious
  changes, or detect on-path attacks.  At best, they enable more
  efficient cache updates and optimistic concurrent writes when all
  participants are behaving nicely.  At worst, the conditions will fail
  and the client will receive a response that is no more harmful than
  an HTTP exchange without conditional requests.

  An entity tag can be abused in ways that create privacy risks.  For
  example, a site might deliberately construct a semantically invalid
  entity tag that is unique to the user or user agent, send it in a
  cacheable response with a long freshness time, and then read that
  entity tag in later conditional requests as a means of re-identifying
  that user or user agent.  Such an identifying tag would become a
  persistent identifier for as long as the user agent retained the
  original cache entry.  User agents that cache representations ought
  to ensure that the cache is cleared or replaced whenever the user
  performs privacy-maintaining actions, such as clearing stored cookies
  or changing to a private browsing mode.

17.15.  Denial-of-Service Attacks Using Range

  Unconstrained multiple range requests are susceptible to denial-of-
  service attacks because the effort required to request many
  overlapping ranges of the same data is tiny compared to the time,
  memory, and bandwidth consumed by attempting to serve the requested
  data in many parts.  Servers ought to ignore, coalesce, or reject
  egregious range requests, such as requests for more than two
  overlapping ranges or for many small ranges in a single set,
  particularly when the ranges are requested out of order for no
  apparent reason.  Multipart range requests are not designed to
  support random access.

17.16.  Authentication Considerations

  Everything about the topic of HTTP authentication is a security
  consideration, so the list of considerations below is not exhaustive.
  Furthermore, it is limited to security considerations regarding the
  authentication framework, in general, rather than discussing all of
  the potential considerations for specific authentication schemes
  (which ought to be documented in the specifications that define those
  schemes).  Various organizations maintain topical information and
  links to current research on Web application security (e.g.,
  [OWASP]), including common pitfalls for implementing and using the
  authentication schemes found in practice.

17.16.1.  Confidentiality of Credentials

  The HTTP authentication framework does not define a single mechanism
  for maintaining the confidentiality of credentials; instead, each
  authentication scheme defines how the credentials are encoded prior
  to transmission.  While this provides flexibility for the development
  of future authentication schemes, it is inadequate for the protection
  of existing schemes that provide no confidentiality on their own, or
  that do not sufficiently protect against replay attacks.
  Furthermore, if the server expects credentials that are specific to
  each individual user, the exchange of those credentials will have the
  effect of identifying that user even if the content within
  credentials remains confidential.

  HTTP depends on the security properties of the underlying transport-
  or session-level connection to provide confidential transmission of
  fields.  Services that depend on individual user authentication
  require a secured connection prior to exchanging credentials
  (Section 4.2.2).

17.16.2.  Credentials and Idle Clients

  Existing HTTP clients and user agents typically retain authentication
  information indefinitely.  HTTP does not provide a mechanism for the
  origin server to direct clients to discard these cached credentials,
  since the protocol has no awareness of how credentials are obtained
  or managed by the user agent.  The mechanisms for expiring or
  revoking credentials can be specified as part of an authentication
  scheme definition.

  Circumstances under which credential caching can interfere with the
  application's security model include but are not limited to:

  *  Clients that have been idle for an extended period, following
     which the server might wish to cause the client to re-prompt the
     user for credentials.

  *  Applications that include a session termination indication (such
     as a "logout" or "commit" button on a page) after which the server
     side of the application "knows" that there is no further reason
     for the client to retain the credentials.

  User agents that cache credentials are encouraged to provide a
  readily accessible mechanism for discarding cached credentials under
  user control.

17.16.3.  Protection Spaces

  Authentication schemes that solely rely on the "realm" mechanism for
  establishing a protection space will expose credentials to all
  resources on an origin server.  Clients that have successfully made
  authenticated requests with a resource can use the same
  authentication credentials for other resources on the same origin
  server.  This makes it possible for a different resource to harvest
  authentication credentials for other resources.

  This is of particular concern when an origin server hosts resources
  for multiple parties under the same origin (Section 11.5).  Possible
  mitigation strategies include restricting direct access to
  authentication credentials (i.e., not making the content of the
  Authorization request header field available), and separating
  protection spaces by using a different host name (or port number) for
  each party.

17.16.4.  Additional Response Fields

  Adding information to responses that are sent over an unencrypted
  channel can affect security and privacy.  The presence of the
  Authentication-Info and Proxy-Authentication-Info header fields alone
  indicates that HTTP authentication is in use.  Additional information
  could be exposed by the contents of the authentication-scheme
  specific parameters; this will have to be considered in the
  definitions of these schemes.

18.  IANA Considerations

  The change controller for the following registrations is: "IETF
  ([email protected]) - Internet Engineering Task Force".

18.1.  URI Scheme Registration

  IANA has updated the "Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) Schemes"
  registry [BCP35] at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/uri-schemes/>
  with the permanent schemes listed in Table 2 in Section 4.2.

18.2.  Method Registration

  IANA has updated the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method
  Registry" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-methods> with the
  registration procedure of Section 16.1.1 and the method names
  summarized in the following table.

                +=========+======+============+=========+
                | Method  | Safe | Idempotent | Section |
                +=========+======+============+=========+
                | CONNECT | no   | no         | 9.3.6   |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+
                | DELETE  | no   | yes        | 9.3.5   |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+
                | GET     | yes  | yes        | 9.3.1   |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+
                | HEAD    | yes  | yes        | 9.3.2   |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+
                | OPTIONS | yes  | yes        | 9.3.7   |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+
                | POST    | no   | no         | 9.3.3   |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+
                | PUT     | no   | yes        | 9.3.4   |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+
                | TRACE   | yes  | yes        | 9.3.8   |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+
                | *       | no   | no         | 18.2    |
                +---------+------+------------+---------+

                                 Table 7

  The method name "*" is reserved because using "*" as a method name
  would conflict with its usage as a wildcard in some fields (e.g.,
  "Access-Control-Request-Method").

18.3.  Status Code Registration

  IANA has updated the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Status Code
  Registry" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-status-codes>
  with the registration procedure of Section 16.2.1 and the status code
  values summarized in the following table.

           +=======+===============================+=========+
           | Value | Description                   | Section |
           +=======+===============================+=========+
           | 100   | Continue                      | 15.2.1  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 101   | Switching Protocols           | 15.2.2  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 200   | OK                            | 15.3.1  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 201   | Created                       | 15.3.2  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 202   | Accepted                      | 15.3.3  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 203   | Non-Authoritative Information | 15.3.4  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 204   | No Content                    | 15.3.5  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 205   | Reset Content                 | 15.3.6  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 206   | Partial Content               | 15.3.7  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 300   | Multiple Choices              | 15.4.1  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 301   | Moved Permanently             | 15.4.2  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 302   | Found                         | 15.4.3  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 303   | See Other                     | 15.4.4  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 304   | Not Modified                  | 15.4.5  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 305   | Use Proxy                     | 15.4.6  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 306   | (Unused)                      | 15.4.7  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 307   | Temporary Redirect            | 15.4.8  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 308   | Permanent Redirect            | 15.4.9  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 400   | Bad Request                   | 15.5.1  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 401   | Unauthorized                  | 15.5.2  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 402   | Payment Required              | 15.5.3  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 403   | Forbidden                     | 15.5.4  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 404   | Not Found                     | 15.5.5  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 405   | Method Not Allowed            | 15.5.6  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 406   | Not Acceptable                | 15.5.7  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 407   | Proxy Authentication Required | 15.5.8  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 408   | Request Timeout               | 15.5.9  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 409   | Conflict                      | 15.5.10 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 410   | Gone                          | 15.5.11 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 411   | Length Required               | 15.5.12 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 412   | Precondition Failed           | 15.5.13 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 413   | Content Too Large             | 15.5.14 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 414   | URI Too Long                  | 15.5.15 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 415   | Unsupported Media Type        | 15.5.16 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 416   | Range Not Satisfiable         | 15.5.17 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 417   | Expectation Failed            | 15.5.18 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 418   | (Unused)                      | 15.5.19 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 421   | Misdirected Request           | 15.5.20 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 422   | Unprocessable Content         | 15.5.21 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 426   | Upgrade Required              | 15.5.22 |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 500   | Internal Server Error         | 15.6.1  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 501   | Not Implemented               | 15.6.2  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 502   | Bad Gateway                   | 15.6.3  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 503   | Service Unavailable           | 15.6.4  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 504   | Gateway Timeout               | 15.6.5  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+
           | 505   | HTTP Version Not Supported    | 15.6.6  |
           +-------+-------------------------------+---------+

                                 Table 8

18.4.  Field Name Registration

  This specification updates the HTTP-related aspects of the existing
  registration procedures for message header fields defined in
  [RFC3864].  It replaces the old procedures as they relate to HTTP by
  defining a new registration procedure and moving HTTP field
  definitions into a separate registry.

  IANA has created a new registry titled "Hypertext Transfer Protocol
  (HTTP) Field Name Registry" as outlined in Section 16.3.1.

  IANA has moved all entries in the "Permanent Message Header Field
  Names" and "Provisional Message Header Field Names" registries (see
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/message-headers/>) with the
  protocol 'http' to this registry and has applied the following
  changes:

  1.  The 'Applicable Protocol' field has been omitted.

  2.  Entries that had a status of 'standard', 'experimental',
      'reserved', or 'informational' have been made to have a status of
      'permanent'.

  3.  Provisional entries without a status have been made to have a
      status of 'provisional'.

  4.  Permanent entries without a status (after confirmation that the
      registration document did not define one) have been made to have
      a status of 'provisional'.  The expert(s) can choose to update
      the entries' status if there is evidence that another is more
      appropriate.

  IANA has annotated the "Permanent Message Header Field Names" and
  "Provisional Message Header Field Names" registries with the
  following note to indicate that HTTP field name registrations have
  moved:

     |  *Note*
     |
     |  HTTP field name registrations have been moved to
     |  [https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-fields] per [RFC9110].

  IANA has updated the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Field Name
  Registry" with the field names listed in the following table.

  +===========================+============+=========+============+
  | Field Name                | Status     | Section | Comments   |
  +===========================+============+=========+============+
  | Accept                    | permanent  | 12.5.1  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Accept-Charset            | deprecated | 12.5.2  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Accept-Encoding           | permanent  | 12.5.3  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Accept-Language           | permanent  | 12.5.4  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Accept-Ranges             | permanent  | 14.3    |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Allow                     | permanent  | 10.2.1  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Authentication-Info       | permanent  | 11.6.3  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Authorization             | permanent  | 11.6.2  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Connection                | permanent  | 7.6.1   |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Content-Encoding          | permanent  | 8.4     |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Content-Language          | permanent  | 8.5     |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Content-Length            | permanent  | 8.6     |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Content-Location          | permanent  | 8.7     |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Content-Range             | permanent  | 14.4    |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Content-Type              | permanent  | 8.3     |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Date                      | permanent  | 6.6.1   |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | ETag                      | permanent  | 8.8.3   |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Expect                    | permanent  | 10.1.1  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | From                      | permanent  | 10.1.2  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Host                      | permanent  | 7.2     |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | If-Match                  | permanent  | 13.1.1  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | If-Modified-Since         | permanent  | 13.1.3  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | If-None-Match             | permanent  | 13.1.2  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | If-Range                  | permanent  | 13.1.5  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | If-Unmodified-Since       | permanent  | 13.1.4  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Last-Modified             | permanent  | 8.8.2   |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Location                  | permanent  | 10.2.2  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Max-Forwards              | permanent  | 7.6.2   |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Proxy-Authenticate        | permanent  | 11.7.1  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Proxy-Authentication-Info | permanent  | 11.7.3  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Proxy-Authorization       | permanent  | 11.7.2  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Range                     | permanent  | 14.2    |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Referer                   | permanent  | 10.1.3  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Retry-After               | permanent  | 10.2.3  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Server                    | permanent  | 10.2.4  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | TE                        | permanent  | 10.1.4  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Trailer                   | permanent  | 6.6.2   |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Upgrade                   | permanent  | 7.8     |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | User-Agent                | permanent  | 10.1.5  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Vary                      | permanent  | 12.5.5  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | Via                       | permanent  | 7.6.3   |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | WWW-Authenticate          | permanent  | 11.6.1  |            |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+
  | *                         | permanent  | 12.5.5  | (reserved) |
  +---------------------------+------------+---------+------------+

                               Table 9

  The field name "*" is reserved because using that name as an HTTP
  header field might conflict with its special semantics in the Vary
  header field (Section 12.5.5).

  IANA has updated the "Content-MD5" entry in the new registry to have
  a status of 'obsoleted' with references to Section 14.15 of [RFC2616]
  (for the definition of the header field) and Appendix B of [RFC7231]
  (which removed the field definition from the updated specification).

18.5.  Authentication Scheme Registration

  IANA has updated the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP)
  Authentication Scheme Registry" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/
  http-authschemes> with the registration procedure of Section 16.4.1.
  No authentication schemes are defined in this document.

18.6.  Content Coding Registration

  IANA has updated the "HTTP Content Coding Registry" at
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/> with the
  registration procedure of Section 16.6.1 and the content coding names
  summarized in the table below.

  +============+===========================================+=========+
  | Name       | Description                               | Section |
  +============+===========================================+=========+
  | compress   | UNIX "compress" data format [Welch]       | 8.4.1.1 |
  +------------+-------------------------------------------+---------+
  | deflate    | "deflate" compressed data ([RFC1951])     | 8.4.1.2 |
  |            | inside the "zlib" data format ([RFC1950]) |         |
  +------------+-------------------------------------------+---------+
  | gzip       | GZIP file format [RFC1952]                | 8.4.1.3 |
  +------------+-------------------------------------------+---------+
  | identity   | Reserved                                  | 12.5.3  |
  +------------+-------------------------------------------+---------+
  | x-compress | Deprecated (alias for compress)           | 8.4.1.1 |
  +------------+-------------------------------------------+---------+
  | x-gzip     | Deprecated (alias for gzip)               | 8.4.1.3 |
  +------------+-------------------------------------------+---------+

                                Table 10

18.7.  Range Unit Registration

  IANA has updated the "HTTP Range Unit Registry" at
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/> with the
  registration procedure of Section 16.5.1 and the range unit names
  summarized in the table below.

  +=================+==================================+=========+
  | Range Unit Name | Description                      | Section |
  +=================+==================================+=========+
  | bytes           | a range of octets                | 14.1.2  |
  +-----------------+----------------------------------+---------+
  | none            | reserved as keyword to indicate  | 14.3    |
  |                 | range requests are not supported |         |
  +-----------------+----------------------------------+---------+

                              Table 11

18.8.  Media Type Registration

  IANA has updated the "Media Types" registry at
  <https://www.iana.org/assignments/media-types> with the registration
  information in Section 14.6 for the media type "multipart/
  byteranges".

  IANA has updated the registry note about "q" parameters with a link
  to Section 12.5.1 of this document.

18.9.  Port Registration

  IANA has updated the "Service Name and Transport Protocol Port Number
  Registry" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/service-names-port-
  numbers/> for the services on ports 80 and 443 that use UDP or TCP
  to:

  1.  use this document as "Reference", and

  2.  when currently unspecified, set "Assignee" to "IESG" and
      "Contact" to "IETF_Chair".

18.10.  Upgrade Token Registration

  IANA has updated the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Upgrade
  Token Registry" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-upgrade-
  tokens> with the registration procedure described in Section 16.7 and
  the upgrade token names summarized in the following table.

  +======+===================+=========================+=========+
  | Name | Description       | Expected Version Tokens | Section |
  +======+===================+=========================+=========+
  | HTTP | Hypertext         | any DIGIT.DIGIT (e.g.,  | 2.5     |
  |      | Transfer Protocol | "2.0")                  |         |
  +------+-------------------+-------------------------+---------+

                              Table 12

19.  References

19.1.  Normative References

  [CACHING]  Fielding, R., Ed., Nottingham, M., Ed., and J. Reschke,
             Ed., "HTTP Caching", STD 98, RFC 9111,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC9111, June 2022,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc9111>.

  [RFC1950]  Deutsch, P. and J-L. Gailly, "ZLIB Compressed Data Format
             Specification version 3.3", RFC 1950,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC1950, May 1996,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1950>.

  [RFC1951]  Deutsch, P., "DEFLATE Compressed Data Format Specification
             version 1.3", RFC 1951, DOI 10.17487/RFC1951, May 1996,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1951>.

  [RFC1952]  Deutsch, P., "GZIP file format specification version 4.3",
             RFC 1952, DOI 10.17487/RFC1952, May 1996,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1952>.

  [RFC2046]  Freed, N. and N. Borenstein, "Multipurpose Internet Mail
             Extensions (MIME) Part Two: Media Types", RFC 2046,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC2046, November 1996,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2046>.

  [RFC2119]  Bradner, S., "Key words for use in RFCs to Indicate
             Requirement Levels", BCP 14, RFC 2119,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC2119, March 1997,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2119>.

  [RFC4647]  Phillips, A., Ed. and M. Davis, Ed., "Matching of Language
             Tags", BCP 47, RFC 4647, DOI 10.17487/RFC4647, September
             2006, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4647>.

  [RFC4648]  Josefsson, S., "The Base16, Base32, and Base64 Data
             Encodings", RFC 4648, DOI 10.17487/RFC4648, October 2006,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4648>.

  [RFC5234]  Crocker, D., Ed. and P. Overell, "Augmented BNF for Syntax
             Specifications: ABNF", STD 68, RFC 5234,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC5234, January 2008,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5234>.

  [RFC5280]  Cooper, D., Santesson, S., Farrell, S., Boeyen, S.,
             Housley, R., and W. Polk, "Internet X.509 Public Key
             Infrastructure Certificate and Certificate Revocation List
             (CRL) Profile", RFC 5280, DOI 10.17487/RFC5280, May 2008,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5280>.

  [RFC5322]  Resnick, P., Ed., "Internet Message Format", RFC 5322,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC5322, October 2008,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5322>.

  [RFC5646]  Phillips, A., Ed. and M. Davis, Ed., "Tags for Identifying
             Languages", BCP 47, RFC 5646, DOI 10.17487/RFC5646,
             September 2009, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5646>.

  [RFC6125]  Saint-Andre, P. and J. Hodges, "Representation and
             Verification of Domain-Based Application Service Identity
             within Internet Public Key Infrastructure Using X.509
             (PKIX) Certificates in the Context of Transport Layer
             Security (TLS)", RFC 6125, DOI 10.17487/RFC6125, March
             2011, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6125>.

  [RFC6365]  Hoffman, P. and J. Klensin, "Terminology Used in
             Internationalization in the IETF", BCP 166, RFC 6365,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC6365, September 2011,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6365>.

  [RFC7405]  Kyzivat, P., "Case-Sensitive String Support in ABNF",
             RFC 7405, DOI 10.17487/RFC7405, December 2014,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7405>.

  [RFC8174]  Leiba, B., "Ambiguity of Uppercase vs Lowercase in RFC
             2119 Key Words", BCP 14, RFC 8174, DOI 10.17487/RFC8174,
             May 2017, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8174>.

  [TCP]      Postel, J., "Transmission Control Protocol", STD 7,
             RFC 793, DOI 10.17487/RFC0793, September 1981,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc793>.

  [TLS13]    Rescorla, E., "The Transport Layer Security (TLS) Protocol
             Version 1.3", RFC 8446, DOI 10.17487/RFC8446, August 2018,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8446>.

  [URI]      Berners-Lee, T., Fielding, R., and L. Masinter, "Uniform
             Resource Identifier (URI): Generic Syntax", STD 66,
             RFC 3986, DOI 10.17487/RFC3986, January 2005,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc3986>.

  [USASCII]  American National Standards Institute, "Coded Character
             Set -- 7-bit American Standard Code for Information
             Interchange", ANSI X3.4, 1986.

  [Welch]    Welch, T., "A Technique for High-Performance Data
             Compression", IEEE Computer 17(6),
             DOI 10.1109/MC.1984.1659158, June 1984,
             <https://ieeexplore.ieee.org/document/1659158/>.

19.2.  Informative References

  [ALTSVC]   Nottingham, M., McManus, P., and J. Reschke, "HTTP
             Alternative Services", RFC 7838, DOI 10.17487/RFC7838,
             April 2016, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7838>.

  [BCP13]    Freed, N. and J. Klensin, "Multipurpose Internet Mail
             Extensions (MIME) Part Four: Registration Procedures",
             BCP 13, RFC 4289, December 2005.

             Freed, N., Klensin, J., and T. Hansen, "Media Type
             Specifications and Registration Procedures", BCP 13,
             RFC 6838, January 2013.

             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/bcp13>

  [BCP178]   Saint-Andre, P., Crocker, D., and M. Nottingham,
             "Deprecating the "X-" Prefix and Similar Constructs in
             Application Protocols", BCP 178, RFC 6648, June 2012.

             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/bcp178>

  [BCP35]    Thaler, D., Ed., Hansen, T., and T. Hardie, "Guidelines
             and Registration Procedures for URI Schemes", BCP 35,
             RFC 7595, June 2015.

             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/bcp35>

  [BREACH]   Gluck, Y., Harris, N., and A. Prado, "BREACH: Reviving the
             CRIME Attack", July 2013,
             <http://breachattack.com/resources/
             BREACH%20-%20SSL,%20gone%20in%2030%20seconds.pdf>.

  [Bujlow]   Bujlow, T., Carela-Español, V., Solé-Pareta, J., and P.
             Barlet-Ros, "A Survey on Web Tracking: Mechanisms,
             Implications, and Defenses", In Proceedings of the IEEE
             105(8), DOI 10.1109/JPROC.2016.2637878, August 2017,
             <https://doi.org/10.1109/JPROC.2016.2637878>.

  [COOKIE]   Barth, A., "HTTP State Management Mechanism", RFC 6265,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC6265, April 2011,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6265>.

  [Err1912]  RFC Errata, Erratum ID 1912, RFC 2978,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/errata/eid1912>.

  [Err5433]  RFC Errata, Erratum ID 5433, RFC 2978,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/errata/eid5433>.

  [Georgiev] Georgiev, M., Iyengar, S., Jana, S., Anubhai, R., Boneh,
             D., and V. Shmatikov, "The Most Dangerous Code in the
             World: Validating SSL Certificates in Non-Browser
             Software", In Proceedings of the 2012 ACM Conference on
             Computer and Communications Security (CCS '12), pp. 38-49,
             DOI 10.1145/2382196.2382204, October 2012,
             <https://doi.org/10.1145/2382196.2382204>.

  [HPACK]    Peon, R. and H. Ruellan, "HPACK: Header Compression for
             HTTP/2", RFC 7541, DOI 10.17487/RFC7541, May 2015,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7541>.

  [HTTP/1.0] Berners-Lee, T., Fielding, R., and H. Frystyk, "Hypertext
             Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.0", RFC 1945,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC1945, May 1996,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1945>.

  [HTTP/1.1] Fielding, R., Ed., Nottingham, M., Ed., and J. Reschke,
             Ed., "HTTP/1.1", STD 99, RFC 9112, DOI 10.17487/RFC9112,
             June 2022, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc9112>.

  [HTTP/2]   Thomson, M., Ed. and C. Benfield, Ed., "HTTP/2", RFC 9113,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC9113, June 2022,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc9113>.

  [HTTP/3]   Bishop, M., Ed., "HTTP/3", RFC 9114, DOI 10.17487/RFC9114,
             June 2022, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc9114>.

  [ISO-8859-1]
             International Organization for Standardization,
             "Information technology -- 8-bit single-byte coded graphic
             character sets -- Part 1: Latin alphabet No. 1", ISO/
             IEC 8859-1:1998, 1998.

  [Kri2001]  Kristol, D., "HTTP Cookies: Standards, Privacy, and
             Politics", ACM Transactions on Internet Technology 1(2),
             November 2001, <http://arxiv.org/abs/cs.SE/0105018>.

  [OWASP]    The Open Web Application Security Project,
             <https://www.owasp.org/>.

  [REST]     Fielding, R.T., "Architectural Styles and the Design of
             Network-based Software Architectures", Doctoral
             Dissertation, University of California, Irvine, September
             2000, <https://roy.gbiv.com/pubs/dissertation/top.htm>.

  [RFC1919]  Chatel, M., "Classical versus Transparent IP Proxies",
             RFC 1919, DOI 10.17487/RFC1919, March 1996,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1919>.

  [RFC2047]  Moore, K., "MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions)
             Part Three: Message Header Extensions for Non-ASCII Text",
             RFC 2047, DOI 10.17487/RFC2047, November 1996,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2047>.

  [RFC2068]  Fielding, R., Gettys, J., Mogul, J., Frystyk, H., and T.
             Berners-Lee, "Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1",
             RFC 2068, DOI 10.17487/RFC2068, January 1997,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2068>.

  [RFC2145]  Mogul, J. C., Fielding, R., Gettys, J., and H. Frystyk,
             "Use and Interpretation of HTTP Version Numbers",
             RFC 2145, DOI 10.17487/RFC2145, May 1997,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2145>.

  [RFC2295]  Holtman, K. and A. Mutz, "Transparent Content Negotiation
             in HTTP", RFC 2295, DOI 10.17487/RFC2295, March 1998,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2295>.

  [RFC2324]  Masinter, L., "Hyper Text Coffee Pot Control Protocol
             (HTCPCP/1.0)", RFC 2324, DOI 10.17487/RFC2324, 1 April
             1998, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2324>.

  [RFC2557]  Palme, J., Hopmann, A., and N. Shelness, "MIME
             Encapsulation of Aggregate Documents, such as HTML
             (MHTML)", RFC 2557, DOI 10.17487/RFC2557, March 1999,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2557>.

  [RFC2616]  Fielding, R., Gettys, J., Mogul, J., Frystyk, H.,
             Masinter, L., Leach, P., and T. Berners-Lee, "Hypertext
             Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1", RFC 2616,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC2616, June 1999,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2616>.

  [RFC2617]  Franks, J., Hallam-Baker, P., Hostetler, J., Lawrence, S.,
             Leach, P., Luotonen, A., and L. Stewart, "HTTP
             Authentication: Basic and Digest Access Authentication",
             RFC 2617, DOI 10.17487/RFC2617, June 1999,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2617>.

  [RFC2774]  Nielsen, H., Leach, P., and S. Lawrence, "An HTTP
             Extension Framework", RFC 2774, DOI 10.17487/RFC2774,
             February 2000, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2774>.

  [RFC2818]  Rescorla, E., "HTTP Over TLS", RFC 2818,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC2818, May 2000,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2818>.

  [RFC2978]  Freed, N. and J. Postel, "IANA Charset Registration
             Procedures", BCP 19, RFC 2978, DOI 10.17487/RFC2978,
             October 2000, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2978>.

  [RFC3040]  Cooper, I., Melve, I., and G. Tomlinson, "Internet Web
             Replication and Caching Taxonomy", RFC 3040,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC3040, January 2001,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc3040>.

  [RFC3864]  Klyne, G., Nottingham, M., and J. Mogul, "Registration
             Procedures for Message Header Fields", BCP 90, RFC 3864,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC3864, September 2004,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc3864>.

  [RFC3875]  Robinson, D. and K. Coar, "The Common Gateway Interface
             (CGI) Version 1.1", RFC 3875, DOI 10.17487/RFC3875,
             October 2004, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc3875>.

  [RFC4033]  Arends, R., Austein, R., Larson, M., Massey, D., and S.
             Rose, "DNS Security Introduction and Requirements",
             RFC 4033, DOI 10.17487/RFC4033, March 2005,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4033>.

  [RFC4559]  Jaganathan, K., Zhu, L., and J. Brezak, "SPNEGO-based
             Kerberos and NTLM HTTP Authentication in Microsoft
             Windows", RFC 4559, DOI 10.17487/RFC4559, June 2006,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4559>.

  [RFC5789]  Dusseault, L. and J. Snell, "PATCH Method for HTTP",
             RFC 5789, DOI 10.17487/RFC5789, March 2010,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5789>.

  [RFC5905]  Mills, D., Martin, J., Ed., Burbank, J., and W. Kasch,
             "Network Time Protocol Version 4: Protocol and Algorithms
             Specification", RFC 5905, DOI 10.17487/RFC5905, June 2010,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5905>.

  [RFC6454]  Barth, A., "The Web Origin Concept", RFC 6454,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC6454, December 2011,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6454>.

  [RFC6585]  Nottingham, M. and R. Fielding, "Additional HTTP Status
             Codes", RFC 6585, DOI 10.17487/RFC6585, April 2012,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6585>.

  [RFC7230]  Fielding, R., Ed. and J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
             Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Message Syntax and Routing",
             RFC 7230, DOI 10.17487/RFC7230, June 2014,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7230>.

  [RFC7231]  Fielding, R., Ed. and J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
             Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Semantics and Content", RFC 7231,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC7231, June 2014,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7231>.

  [RFC7232]  Fielding, R., Ed. and J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
             Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Conditional Requests", RFC 7232,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC7232, June 2014,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7232>.

  [RFC7233]  Fielding, R., Ed., Lafon, Y., Ed., and J. Reschke, Ed.,
             "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Range Requests",
             RFC 7233, DOI 10.17487/RFC7233, June 2014,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7233>.

  [RFC7234]  Fielding, R., Ed., Nottingham, M., Ed., and J. Reschke,
             Ed., "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Caching",
             RFC 7234, DOI 10.17487/RFC7234, June 2014,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7234>.

  [RFC7235]  Fielding, R., Ed. and J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
             Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Authentication", RFC 7235,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC7235, June 2014,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7235>.

  [RFC7538]  Reschke, J., "The Hypertext Transfer Protocol Status Code
             308 (Permanent Redirect)", RFC 7538, DOI 10.17487/RFC7538,
             April 2015, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7538>.

  [RFC7540]  Belshe, M., Peon, R., and M. Thomson, Ed., "Hypertext
             Transfer Protocol Version 2 (HTTP/2)", RFC 7540,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC7540, May 2015,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7540>.

  [RFC7578]  Masinter, L., "Returning Values from Forms: multipart/
             form-data", RFC 7578, DOI 10.17487/RFC7578, July 2015,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7578>.

  [RFC7615]  Reschke, J., "HTTP Authentication-Info and Proxy-
             Authentication-Info Response Header Fields", RFC 7615,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC7615, September 2015,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7615>.

  [RFC7616]  Shekh-Yusef, R., Ed., Ahrens, D., and S. Bremer, "HTTP
             Digest Access Authentication", RFC 7616,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC7616, September 2015,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7616>.

  [RFC7617]  Reschke, J., "The 'Basic' HTTP Authentication Scheme",
             RFC 7617, DOI 10.17487/RFC7617, September 2015,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7617>.

  [RFC7694]  Reschke, J., "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Client-
             Initiated Content-Encoding", RFC 7694,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC7694, November 2015,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7694>.

  [RFC8126]  Cotton, M., Leiba, B., and T. Narten, "Guidelines for
             Writing an IANA Considerations Section in RFCs", BCP 26,
             RFC 8126, DOI 10.17487/RFC8126, June 2017,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8126>.

  [RFC8187]  Reschke, J., "Indicating Character Encoding and Language
             for HTTP Header Field Parameters", RFC 8187,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC8187, September 2017,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8187>.

  [RFC8246]  McManus, P., "HTTP Immutable Responses", RFC 8246,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC8246, September 2017,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8246>.

  [RFC8288]  Nottingham, M., "Web Linking", RFC 8288,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC8288, October 2017,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8288>.

  [RFC8336]  Nottingham, M. and E. Nygren, "The ORIGIN HTTP/2 Frame",
             RFC 8336, DOI 10.17487/RFC8336, March 2018,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8336>.

  [RFC8615]  Nottingham, M., "Well-Known Uniform Resource Identifiers
             (URIs)", RFC 8615, DOI 10.17487/RFC8615, May 2019,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8615>.

  [RFC8941]  Nottingham, M. and P-H. Kamp, "Structured Field Values for
             HTTP", RFC 8941, DOI 10.17487/RFC8941, February 2021,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc8941>.

  [Sniffing] WHATWG, "MIME Sniffing",
             <https://mimesniff.spec.whatwg.org>.

  [WEBDAV]   Dusseault, L., Ed., "HTTP Extensions for Web Distributed
             Authoring and Versioning (WebDAV)", RFC 4918,
             DOI 10.17487/RFC4918, June 2007,
             <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4918>.

Appendix A.  Collected ABNF

  In the collected ABNF below, list rules are expanded per
  Section 5.6.1.

  Accept = [ ( media-range [ weight ] ) *( OWS "," OWS ( media-range [
   weight ] ) ) ]
  Accept-Charset = [ ( ( token / "*" ) [ weight ] ) *( OWS "," OWS ( (
   token / "*" ) [ weight ] ) ) ]
  Accept-Encoding = [ ( codings [ weight ] ) *( OWS "," OWS ( codings [
   weight ] ) ) ]
  Accept-Language = [ ( language-range [ weight ] ) *( OWS "," OWS (
   language-range [ weight ] ) ) ]
  Accept-Ranges = acceptable-ranges
  Allow = [ method *( OWS "," OWS method ) ]
  Authentication-Info = [ auth-param *( OWS "," OWS auth-param ) ]
  Authorization = credentials

  BWS = OWS

  Connection = [ connection-option *( OWS "," OWS connection-option )
   ]
  Content-Encoding = [ content-coding *( OWS "," OWS content-coding )
   ]
  Content-Language = [ language-tag *( OWS "," OWS language-tag ) ]
  Content-Length = 1*DIGIT
  Content-Location = absolute-URI / partial-URI
  Content-Range = range-unit SP ( range-resp / unsatisfied-range )
  Content-Type = media-type

  Date = HTTP-date

  ETag = entity-tag
  Expect = [ expectation *( OWS "," OWS expectation ) ]

  From = mailbox

  GMT = %x47.4D.54 ; GMT

  HTTP-date = IMF-fixdate / obs-date
  Host = uri-host [ ":" port ]

  IMF-fixdate = day-name "," SP date1 SP time-of-day SP GMT
  If-Match = "*" / [ entity-tag *( OWS "," OWS entity-tag ) ]
  If-Modified-Since = HTTP-date
  If-None-Match = "*" / [ entity-tag *( OWS "," OWS entity-tag ) ]
  If-Range = entity-tag / HTTP-date
  If-Unmodified-Since = HTTP-date

  Last-Modified = HTTP-date
  Location = URI-reference

  Max-Forwards = 1*DIGIT

  OWS = *( SP / HTAB )

  Proxy-Authenticate = [ challenge *( OWS "," OWS challenge ) ]
  Proxy-Authentication-Info = [ auth-param *( OWS "," OWS auth-param )
   ]
  Proxy-Authorization = credentials

  RWS = 1*( SP / HTAB )
  Range = ranges-specifier
  Referer = absolute-URI / partial-URI
  Retry-After = HTTP-date / delay-seconds

  Server = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) )

  TE = [ t-codings *( OWS "," OWS t-codings ) ]
  Trailer = [ field-name *( OWS "," OWS field-name ) ]

  URI-reference = <URI-reference, see [URI], Section 4.1>
  Upgrade = [ protocol *( OWS "," OWS protocol ) ]
  User-Agent = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) )

  Vary = [ ( "*" / field-name ) *( OWS "," OWS ( "*" / field-name ) )
   ]
  Via = [ ( received-protocol RWS received-by [ RWS comment ] ) *( OWS
   "," OWS ( received-protocol RWS received-by [ RWS comment ] ) ) ]

  WWW-Authenticate = [ challenge *( OWS "," OWS challenge ) ]

  absolute-URI = <absolute-URI, see [URI], Section 4.3>
  absolute-path = 1*( "/" segment )
  acceptable-ranges = range-unit *( OWS "," OWS range-unit )
  asctime-date = day-name SP date3 SP time-of-day SP year
  auth-param = token BWS "=" BWS ( token / quoted-string )
  auth-scheme = token
  authority = <authority, see [URI], Section 3.2>

  challenge = auth-scheme [ 1*SP ( token68 / [ auth-param *( OWS ","
   OWS auth-param ) ] ) ]
  codings = content-coding / "identity" / "*"
  comment = "(" *( ctext / quoted-pair / comment ) ")"
  complete-length = 1*DIGIT
  connection-option = token
  content-coding = token
  credentials = auth-scheme [ 1*SP ( token68 / [ auth-param *( OWS ","
   OWS auth-param ) ] ) ]
  ctext = HTAB / SP / %x21-27 ; '!'-'''
   / %x2A-5B ; '*'-'['
   / %x5D-7E ; ']'-'~'
   / obs-text

  date1 = day SP month SP year
  date2 = day "-" month "-" 2DIGIT
  date3 = month SP ( 2DIGIT / ( SP DIGIT ) )
  day = 2DIGIT
  day-name = %x4D.6F.6E ; Mon
   / %x54.75.65 ; Tue
   / %x57.65.64 ; Wed
   / %x54.68.75 ; Thu
   / %x46.72.69 ; Fri
   / %x53.61.74 ; Sat
   / %x53.75.6E ; Sun
  day-name-l = %x4D.6F.6E.64.61.79 ; Monday
   / %x54.75.65.73.64.61.79 ; Tuesday
   / %x57.65.64.6E.65.73.64.61.79 ; Wednesday
   / %x54.68.75.72.73.64.61.79 ; Thursday
   / %x46.72.69.64.61.79 ; Friday
   / %x53.61.74.75.72.64.61.79 ; Saturday
   / %x53.75.6E.64.61.79 ; Sunday
  delay-seconds = 1*DIGIT

  entity-tag = [ weak ] opaque-tag
  etagc = "!" / %x23-7E ; '#'-'~'
   / obs-text
  expectation = token [ "=" ( token / quoted-string ) parameters ]

  field-content = field-vchar [ 1*( SP / HTAB / field-vchar )
   field-vchar ]
  field-name = token
  field-value = *field-content
  field-vchar = VCHAR / obs-text
  first-pos = 1*DIGIT

  hour = 2DIGIT
  http-URI = "http://" authority path-abempty [ "?" query ]
  https-URI = "https://" authority path-abempty [ "?" query ]

  incl-range = first-pos "-" last-pos
  int-range = first-pos "-" [ last-pos ]

  language-range = <language-range, see [RFC4647], Section 2.1>
  language-tag = <Language-Tag, see [RFC5646], Section 2.1>
  last-pos = 1*DIGIT

  mailbox = <mailbox, see [RFC5322], Section 3.4>
  media-range = ( "*/*" / ( type "/*" ) / ( type "/" subtype ) )
   parameters
  media-type = type "/" subtype parameters
  method = token
  minute = 2DIGIT
  month = %x4A.61.6E ; Jan
   / %x46.65.62 ; Feb
   / %x4D.61.72 ; Mar
   / %x41.70.72 ; Apr
   / %x4D.61.79 ; May
   / %x4A.75.6E ; Jun
   / %x4A.75.6C ; Jul
   / %x41.75.67 ; Aug
   / %x53.65.70 ; Sep
   / %x4F.63.74 ; Oct
   / %x4E.6F.76 ; Nov
   / %x44.65.63 ; Dec

  obs-date = rfc850-date / asctime-date
  obs-text = %x80-FF
  opaque-tag = DQUOTE *etagc DQUOTE
  other-range = 1*( %x21-2B ; '!'-'+'
   / %x2D-7E ; '-'-'~'
   )

  parameter = parameter-name "=" parameter-value
  parameter-name = token
  parameter-value = ( token / quoted-string )
  parameters = *( OWS ";" OWS [ parameter ] )
  partial-URI = relative-part [ "?" query ]
  path-abempty = <path-abempty, see [URI], Section 3.3>
  port = <port, see [URI], Section 3.2.3>
  product = token [ "/" product-version ]
  product-version = token
  protocol = protocol-name [ "/" protocol-version ]
  protocol-name = token
  protocol-version = token
  pseudonym = token

  qdtext = HTAB / SP / "!" / %x23-5B ; '#'-'['
   / %x5D-7E ; ']'-'~'
   / obs-text
  query = <query, see [URI], Section 3.4>
  quoted-pair = "\" ( HTAB / SP / VCHAR / obs-text )
  quoted-string = DQUOTE *( qdtext / quoted-pair ) DQUOTE
  qvalue = ( "0" [ "." *3DIGIT ] ) / ( "1" [ "." *3"0" ] )

  range-resp = incl-range "/" ( complete-length / "*" )
  range-set = range-spec *( OWS "," OWS range-spec )
  range-spec = int-range / suffix-range / other-range
  range-unit = token
  ranges-specifier = range-unit "=" range-set
  received-by = pseudonym [ ":" port ]
  received-protocol = [ protocol-name "/" ] protocol-version
  relative-part = <relative-part, see [URI], Section 4.2>
  rfc850-date = day-name-l "," SP date2 SP time-of-day SP GMT

  second = 2DIGIT
  segment = <segment, see [URI], Section 3.3>
  subtype = token
  suffix-length = 1*DIGIT
  suffix-range = "-" suffix-length

  t-codings = "trailers" / ( transfer-coding [ weight ] )
  tchar = "!" / "#" / "$" / "%" / "&" / "'" / "*" / "+" / "-" / "." /
   "^" / "_" / "`" / "|" / "~" / DIGIT / ALPHA
  time-of-day = hour ":" minute ":" second
  token = 1*tchar
  token68 = 1*( ALPHA / DIGIT / "-" / "." / "_" / "~" / "+" / "/" )
   *"="
  transfer-coding = token *( OWS ";" OWS transfer-parameter )
  transfer-parameter = token BWS "=" BWS ( token / quoted-string )
  type = token

  unsatisfied-range = "*/" complete-length
  uri-host = <host, see [URI], Section 3.2.2>

  weak = %x57.2F ; W/
  weight = OWS ";" OWS "q=" qvalue

  year = 4DIGIT

Appendix B.  Changes from Previous RFCs

B.1.  Changes from RFC 2818

  None.

B.2.  Changes from RFC 7230

  The sections introducing HTTP's design goals, history, architecture,
  conformance criteria, protocol versioning, URIs, message routing, and
  header fields have been moved here.

  The requirement on semantic conformance has been replaced with
  permission to ignore or work around implementation-specific failures.
  (Section 2.2)

  The description of an origin and authoritative access to origin
  servers has been extended for both "http" and "https" URIs to account
  for alternative services and secured connections that are not
  necessarily based on TCP.  (Sections 4.2.1, 4.2.2, 4.3.1, and 7.3.3)

  Explicit requirements have been added to check the target URI
  scheme's semantics and reject requests that don't meet any associated
  requirements.  (Section 7.4)

  Parameters in media type, media range, and expectation can be empty
  via one or more trailing semicolons.  (Section 5.6.6)

  "Field value" now refers to the value after multiple field lines are
  combined with commas -- by far the most common use.  To refer to a
  single header line's value, use "field line value".  (Section 6.3)

  Trailer field semantics now transcend the specifics of chunked
  transfer coding.  The use of trailer fields has been further limited
  to allow generation as a trailer field only when the sender knows the
  field defines that usage and to allow merging into the header section
  only if the recipient knows the corresponding field definition
  permits and defines how to merge.  In all other cases,
  implementations are encouraged either to store the trailer fields
  separately or to discard them instead of merging.  (Section 6.5.1)

  The priority of the absolute form of the request URI over the Host
  header field by origin servers has been made explicit to align with
  proxy handling.  (Section 7.2)

  The grammar definition for the Via field's "received-by" was expanded
  in RFC 7230 due to changes in the URI grammar for host [URI] that are
  not desirable for Via. For simplicity, we have removed uri-host from
  the received-by production because it can be encompassed by the
  existing grammar for pseudonym.  In particular, this change removed
  comma from the allowed set of characters for a host name in received-
  by.  (Section 7.6.3)

B.3.  Changes from RFC 7231

  Minimum URI lengths to be supported by implementations are now
  recommended.  (Section 4.1)

  The following have been clarified: CR and NUL in field values are to
  be rejected or mapped to SP, and leading and trailing whitespace
  needs to be stripped from field values before they are consumed.
  (Section 5.5)

  Parameters in media type, media range, and expectation can be empty
  via one or more trailing semicolons.  (Section 5.6.6)

  An abstract data type for HTTP messages has been introduced to define
  the components of a message and their semantics as an abstraction
  across multiple HTTP versions, rather than in terms of the specific
  syntax form of HTTP/1.1 in [HTTP/1.1], and reflect the contents after
  the message is parsed.  This makes it easier to distinguish between
  requirements on the content (what is conveyed) versus requirements on
  the messaging syntax (how it is conveyed) and avoids baking
  limitations of early protocol versions into the future of HTTP.
  (Section 6)

  The terms "payload" and "payload body" have been replaced with
  "content", to better align with its usage elsewhere (e.g., in field
  names) and to avoid confusion with frame payloads in HTTP/2 and
  HTTP/3.  (Section 6.4)

  The term "effective request URI" has been replaced with "target URI".
  (Section 7.1)

  Restrictions on client retries have been loosened to reflect
  implementation behavior.  (Section 9.2.2)

  The fact that request bodies on GET, HEAD, and DELETE are not
  interoperable has been clarified.  (Sections 9.3.1, 9.3.2, and 9.3.5)

  The use of the Content-Range header field (Section 14.4) as a request
  modifier on PUT is allowed.  (Section 9.3.4)

  A superfluous requirement about setting Content-Length has been
  removed from the description of the OPTIONS method.  (Section 9.3.7)

  The normative requirement to use the "message/http" media type in
  TRACE responses has been removed.  (Section 9.3.8)

  List-based grammar for Expect has been restored for compatibility
  with RFC 2616.  (Section 10.1.1)

  Accept and Accept-Encoding are allowed in response messages; the
  latter was introduced by [RFC7694].  (Section 12.3)

  "Accept Parameters" (accept-params and accept-ext ABNF production)
  have been removed from the definition of the Accept field.
  (Section 12.5.1)

  The Accept-Charset field is now deprecated.  (Section 12.5.2)

  The semantics of "*" in the Vary header field when other values are
  present was clarified.  (Section 12.5.5)

  Range units are compared in a case-insensitive fashion.
  (Section 14.1)

  The use of the Accept-Ranges field is not restricted to origin
  servers.  (Section 14.3)

  The process of creating a redirected request has been clarified.
  (Section 15.4)

  Status code 308 (previously defined in [RFC7538]) has been added so
  that it's defined closer to status codes 301, 302, and 307.
  (Section 15.4.9)

  Status code 421 (previously defined in Section 9.1.2 of [RFC7540])
  has been added because of its general applicability. 421 is no longer
  defined as heuristically cacheable since the response is specific to
  the connection (not the target resource).  (Section 15.5.20)

  Status code 422 (previously defined in Section 11.2 of [WEBDAV]) has
  been added because of its general applicability.  (Section 15.5.21)

B.4.  Changes from RFC 7232

  Previous revisions of HTTP imposed an arbitrary 60-second limit on
  the determination of whether Last-Modified was a strong validator to
  guard against the possibility that the Date and Last-Modified values
  are generated from different clocks or at somewhat different times
  during the preparation of the response.  This specification has
  relaxed that to allow reasonable discretion.  (Section 8.8.2.2)

  An edge-case requirement on If-Match and If-Unmodified-Since has been
  removed that required a validator not to be sent in a 2xx response if
  validation fails because the change request has already been applied.
  (Sections 13.1.1 and 13.1.4)

  The fact that If-Unmodified-Since does not apply to a resource
  without a concept of modification time has been clarified.
  (Section 13.1.4)

  Preconditions can now be evaluated before the request content is
  processed rather than waiting until the response would otherwise be
  successful.  (Section 13.2)

B.5.  Changes from RFC 7233

  Refactored the range-unit and ranges-specifier grammars to simplify
  and reduce artificial distinctions between bytes and other
  (extension) range units, removing the overlapping grammar of other-
  range-unit by defining range units generically as a token and placing
  extensions within the scope of a range-spec (other-range).  This
  disambiguates the role of list syntax (commas) in all range sets,
  including extension range units, for indicating a range-set of more
  than one range.  Moving the extension grammar into range specifiers
  also allows protocol specific to byte ranges to be specified
  separately.

  It is now possible to define Range handling on extension methods.
  (Section 14.2)

  Described use of the Content-Range header field (Section 14.4) as a
  request modifier to perform a partial PUT.  (Section 14.5)

B.6.  Changes from RFC 7235

  None.

B.7.  Changes from RFC 7538

  None.

B.8.  Changes from RFC 7615

  None.

B.9.  Changes from RFC 7694

  This specification includes the extension defined in [RFC7694] but
  leaves out examples and deployment considerations.

Acknowledgements

  Aside from the current editors, the following individuals deserve
  special recognition for their contributions to early aspects of HTTP
  and its core specifications: Marc Andreessen, Tim Berners-Lee, Robert
  Cailliau, Daniel W. Connolly, Bob Denny, John Franks, Jim Gettys,
  Jean-François Groff, Phillip M. Hallam-Baker, Koen Holtman, Jeffery
  L. Hostetler, Shel Kaphan, Dave Kristol, Yves Lafon, Scott
  D. Lawrence, Paul J. Leach, Håkon W. Lie, Ari Luotonen, Larry
  Masinter, Rob McCool, Jeffrey C. Mogul, Lou Montulli, David Morris,
  Henrik Frystyk Nielsen, Dave Raggett, Eric Rescorla, Tony Sanders,
  Lawrence C. Stewart, Marc VanHeyningen, and Steve Zilles.

  This document builds on the many contributions that went into past
  specifications of HTTP, including [HTTP/1.0], [RFC2068], [RFC2145],
  [RFC2616], [RFC2617], [RFC2818], [RFC7230], [RFC7231], [RFC7232],
  [RFC7233], [RFC7234], and [RFC7235].  The acknowledgements within
  those documents still apply.

  Since 2014, the following contributors have helped improve this
  specification by reporting bugs, asking smart questions, drafting or
  reviewing text, and evaluating issues:

  Alan Egerton, Alex Rousskov, Amichai Rothman, Amos Jeffries, Anders
  Kaseorg, Andreas Gebhardt, Anne van Kesteren, Armin Abfalterer, Aron
  Duby, Asanka Herath, Asbjørn Ulsberg, Asta Olofsson, Attila Gulyas,
  Austin Wright, Barry Pollard, Ben Burkert, Benjamin Kaduk, Björn
  Höhrmann, Brad Fitzpatrick, Chris Pacejo, Colin Bendell, Cory
  Benfield, Cory Nelson, Daisuke Miyakawa, Dale Worley, Daniel
  Stenberg, Danil Suits, David Benjamin, David Matson, David Schinazi,
  Дилян Палаузов (Dilyan Palauzov), Eric Anderson, Eric Rescorla, Éric
  Vyncke, Erik Kline, Erwin Pe, Etan Kissling, Evert Pot, Evgeny
  Vrublevsky, Florian Best, Francesca Palombini, Igor Lubashev, James
  Callahan, James Peach, Jeffrey Yasskin, Kalin Gyokov, Kannan Goundan,
  奥 一穂 (Kazuho Oku), Ken Murchison, Krzysztof Maczyński, Lars Eggert,
  Lucas Pardue, Martin Duke, Martin Dürst, Martin Thomson, Martynas
  Jusevičius, Matt Menke, Matthias Pigulla, Mattias Grenfeldt, Michael
  Osipov, Mike Bishop, Mike Pennisi, Mike Taylor, Mike West, Mohit
  Sethi, Murray Kucherawy, Nathaniel J. Smith, Nicholas Hurley, Nikita
  Prokhorov, Patrick McManus, Piotr Sikora, Poul-Henning Kamp, Rick van
  Rein, Robert Wilton, Roberto Polli, Roman Danyliw, Samuel Williams,
  Semyon Kholodnov, Simon Pieters, Simon Schüppel, Stefan Eissing,
  Taylor Hunt, Todd Greer, Tommy Pauly, Vasiliy Faronov, Vladimir
  Lashchev, Wenbo Zhu, William A. Rowe Jr., Willy Tarreau, Xingwei Liu,
  Yishuai Li, and Zaheduzzaman Sarker.

Index

  1 2 3 4 5 A B C D E F G H I L M N O P R S T U V W X

     1

        100 Continue (status code)  *_Section 15.2.1_*
        100-continue (expect value)  *_Section 10.1.1_*
        101 Switching Protocols (status code)  *_Section 15.2.2_*
        1xx Informational (status code class)  *_Section 15.2_*

     2

        200 OK (status code)  *_Section 15.3.1_*
        201 Created (status code)  *_Section 15.3.2_*
        202 Accepted (status code)  *_Section 15.3.3_*
        203 Non-Authoritative Information (status code)  *_Section 15.3
           .4_*
        204 No Content (status code)  *_Section 15.3.5_*
        205 Reset Content (status code)  *_Section 15.3.6_*
        206 Partial Content (status code)  *_Section 15.3.7_*
        2xx Successful (status code class)  *_Section 15.3_*

     3

        300 Multiple Choices (status code)  *_Section 15.4.1_*
        301 Moved Permanently (status code)  *_Section 15.4.2_*
        302 Found (status code)  *_Section 15.4.3_*
        303 See Other (status code)  *_Section 15.4.4_*
        304 Not Modified (status code)  *_Section 15.4.5_*
        305 Use Proxy (status code)  *_Section 15.4.6_*
        306 (Unused) (status code)  *_Section 15.4.7_*
        307 Temporary Redirect (status code)  *_Section 15.4.8_*
        308 Permanent Redirect (status code)  *_Section 15.4.9_*
        3xx Redirection (status code class)  *_Section 15.4_*

     4

        400 Bad Request (status code)  *_Section 15.5.1_*
        401 Unauthorized (status code)  *_Section 15.5.2_*
        402 Payment Required (status code)  *_Section 15.5.3_*
        403 Forbidden (status code)  *_Section 15.5.4_*
        404 Not Found (status code)  *_Section 15.5.5_*
        405 Method Not Allowed (status code)  *_Section 15.5.6_*
        406 Not Acceptable (status code)  *_Section 15.5.7_*
        407 Proxy Authentication Required (status code)  *_Section 15.5
           .8_*
        408 Request Timeout (status code)  *_Section 15.5.9_*
        409 Conflict (status code)  *_Section 15.5.10_*
        410 Gone (status code)  *_Section 15.5.11_*
        411 Length Required (status code)  *_Section 15.5.12_*
        412 Precondition Failed (status code)  *_Section 15.5.13_*
        413 Content Too Large (status code)  *_Section 15.5.14_*
        414 URI Too Long (status code)  *_Section 15.5.15_*
        415 Unsupported Media Type (status code)  *_Section 15.5.16_*
        416 Range Not Satisfiable (status code)  *_Section 15.5.17_*
        417 Expectation Failed (status code)  *_Section 15.5.18_*
        418 (Unused) (status code)  *_Section 15.5.19_*
        421 Misdirected Request (status code)  *_Section 15.5.20_*
        422 Unprocessable Content (status code)  *_Section 15.5.21_*
        426 Upgrade Required (status code)  *_Section 15.5.22_*
        4xx Client Error (status code class)  *_Section 15.5_*

     5

        500 Internal Server Error (status code)  *_Section 15.6.1_*
        501 Not Implemented (status code)  *_Section 15.6.2_*
        502 Bad Gateway (status code)  *_Section 15.6.3_*
        503 Service Unavailable (status code)  *_Section 15.6.4_*
        504 Gateway Timeout (status code)  *_Section 15.6.5_*
        505 HTTP Version Not Supported (status code)  *_Section 15.6.6_
           *
        5xx Server Error (status code class)  *_Section 15.6_*

     A

        accelerator  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 6_*
        Accept header field  *_Section 12.5.1_*
        Accept-Charset header field  *_Section 12.5.2_*
        Accept-Encoding header field  *_Section 12.5.3_*
        Accept-Language header field  *_Section 12.5.4_*
        Accept-Ranges header field  *_Section 14.3_*
        Allow header field  *_Section 10.2.1_*
        Authentication-Info header field  *_Section 11.6.3_*
        authoritative response  *_Section 17.1_*
        Authorization header field  *_Section 11.6.2_*

     B

        browser  *_Section 3.5_*

     C

        cache  *_Section 3.8_*
        cacheable  *_Section 3.8, Paragraph 4_*
        client  *_Section 3.3_*
        clock  *_Section 5.6.7_*
        complete  *_Section 6.1_*
        compress (Coding Format)  Section 8.4.1.1
        compress (content coding)  *_Section 8.4.1_*
        conditional request  *_Section 13_*
        CONNECT method  *_Section 9.3.6_*
        connection  *_Section 3.3_*
        Connection header field  *_Section 7.6.1_*
        content  Section 6.4
        content coding  *_Section 8.4.1_*
        content negotiation  Section 1.3, Paragraph 4
        Content-Encoding header field  *_Section 8.4_*
        Content-Language header field  *_Section 8.5_*
        Content-Length header field  *_Section 8.6_*
        Content-Location header field  *_Section 8.7_*
        Content-MD5 header field  *_Section 18.4, Paragraph 10_*
        Content-Range header field  *_Section 14.4_*; Section 14.5
        Content-Type header field  *_Section 8.3_*
        control data  *_Section 6.2_*

     D

        Date header field  *_Section 6.6.1_*
        deflate (Coding Format)  Section 8.4.1.2
        deflate (content coding)  *_Section 8.4.1_*
        DELETE method  *_Section 9.3.5_*
        Delimiters  Section 5.6.2, Paragraph 3
        downstream  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 4_*

     E

        effective request URI  *_Section 7.1, Paragraph 8.1_*
        ETag field  *_Section 8.8.3_*
        Expect header field  *_Section 10.1.1_*

     F

        field  *_Section 5_*; Section 6.3
        field line  Section 5.2, Paragraph 1
        field line value  Section 5.2, Paragraph 1
        field name  Section 5.2, Paragraph 1
        field value  Section 5.2, Paragraph 2
        Fields
           *  *_Section 18.4, Paragraph 9_*
           Accept  *_Section 12.5.1_*
           Accept-Charset  *_Section 12.5.2_*
           Accept-Encoding  *_Section 12.5.3_*
           Accept-Language  *_Section 12.5.4_*
           Accept-Ranges  *_Section 14.3_*
           Allow  *_Section 10.2.1_*
           Authentication-Info  *_Section 11.6.3_*
           Authorization  *_Section 11.6.2_*
           Connection  *_Section 7.6.1_*
           Content-Encoding  *_Section 8.4_*
           Content-Language  *_Section 8.5_*
           Content-Length  *_Section 8.6_*
           Content-Location  *_Section 8.7_*
           Content-MD5  *_Section 18.4, Paragraph 10_*
           Content-Range  *_Section 14.4_*; Section 14.5
           Content-Type  *_Section 8.3_*
           Date  *_Section 6.6.1_*
           ETag  *_Section 8.8.3_*
           Expect  *_Section 10.1.1_*
           From  *_Section 10.1.2_*
           Host  *_Section 7.2_*
           If-Match  *_Section 13.1.1_*
           If-Modified-Since  *_Section 13.1.3_*
           If-None-Match  *_Section 13.1.2_*
           If-Range  *_Section 13.1.5_*
           If-Unmodified-Since  *_Section 13.1.4_*
           Last-Modified  *_Section 8.8.2_*
           Location  *_Section 10.2.2_*
           Max-Forwards  *_Section 7.6.2_*
           Proxy-Authenticate  *_Section 11.7.1_*
           Proxy-Authentication-Info  *_Section 11.7.3_*
           Proxy-Authorization  *_Section 11.7.2_*
           Range  *_Section 14.2_*
           Referer  *_Section 10.1.3_*
           Retry-After  *_Section 10.2.3_*
           Server  *_Section 10.2.4_*
           TE  *_Section 10.1.4_*
           Trailer  *_Section 6.6.2_*
           Upgrade  *_Section 7.8_*
           User-Agent  *_Section 10.1.5_*
           Vary  *_Section 12.5.5_*
           Via  *_Section 7.6.3_*
           WWW-Authenticate  *_Section 11.6.1_*
        Fragment Identifiers  Section 4.2.5
        From header field  *_Section 10.1.2_*

     G

        gateway  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 6_*
        GET method  *_Section 9.3.1_*
        Grammar
           ALPHA  *_Section 2.1_*
           Accept  *_Section 12.5.1_*
           Accept-Charset  *_Section 12.5.2_*
           Accept-Encoding  *_Section 12.5.3_*
           Accept-Language  *_Section 12.5.4_*
           Accept-Ranges  *_Section 14.3_*
           Allow  *_Section 10.2.1_*
           Authentication-Info  *_Section 11.6.3_*
           Authorization  *_Section 11.6.2_*
           BWS  *_Section 5.6.3_*
           CR  *_Section 2.1_*
           CRLF  *_Section 2.1_*
           CTL  *_Section 2.1_*
           Connection  *_Section 7.6.1_*
           Content-Encoding  *_Section 8.4_*
           Content-Language  *_Section 8.5_*
           Content-Length  *_Section 8.6_*
           Content-Location  *_Section 8.7_*
           Content-Range  *_Section 14.4_*
           Content-Type  *_Section 8.3_*
           DIGIT  *_Section 2.1_*
           DQUOTE  *_Section 2.1_*
           Date  *_Section 6.6.1_*
           ETag  *_Section 8.8.3_*
           Expect  *_Section 10.1.1_*
           From  *_Section 10.1.2_*
           GMT  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           HEXDIG  *_Section 2.1_*
           HTAB  *_Section 2.1_*
           HTTP-date  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           Host  *_Section 7.2_*
           IMF-fixdate  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           If-Match  *_Section 13.1.1_*
           If-Modified-Since  *_Section 13.1.3_*
           If-None-Match  *_Section 13.1.2_*
           If-Range  *_Section 13.1.5_*
           If-Unmodified-Since  *_Section 13.1.4_*
           LF  *_Section 2.1_*
           Last-Modified  *_Section 8.8.2_*
           Location  *_Section 10.2.2_*
           Max-Forwards  *_Section 7.6.2_*
           OCTET  *_Section 2.1_*
           OWS  *_Section 5.6.3_*
           Proxy-Authenticate  *_Section 11.7.1_*
           Proxy-Authentication-Info  *_Section 11.7.3_*
           Proxy-Authorization  *_Section 11.7.2_*
           RWS  *_Section 5.6.3_*
           Range  *_Section 14.2_*
           Referer  *_Section 10.1.3_*
           Retry-After  *_Section 10.2.3_*
           SP  *_Section 2.1_*
           Server  *_Section 10.2.4_*
           TE  *_Section 10.1.4_*
           Trailer  *_Section 6.6.2_*
           URI-reference  *_Section 4.1_*
           Upgrade  *_Section 7.8_*
           User-Agent  *_Section 10.1.5_*
           VCHAR  *_Section 2.1_*
           Vary  *_Section 12.5.5_*
           Via  *_Section 7.6.3_*
           WWW-Authenticate  *_Section 11.6.1_*
           absolute-URI  *_Section 4.1_*
           absolute-path  *_Section 4.1_*
           acceptable-ranges  *_Section 14.3_*
           asctime-date  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           auth-param  *_Section 11.2_*
           auth-scheme  *_Section 11.1_*
           authority  *_Section 4.1_*
           challenge  *_Section 11.3_*
           codings  *_Section 12.5.3_*
           comment  *_Section 5.6.5_*
           complete-length  *_Section 14.4_*
           connection-option  *_Section 7.6.1_*
           content-coding  *_Section 8.4.1_*
           credentials  *_Section 11.4_*
           ctext  *_Section 5.6.5_*
           date1  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           day  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           day-name  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           day-name-l  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           delay-seconds  *_Section 10.2.3_*
           entity-tag  *_Section 8.8.3_*
           etagc  *_Section 8.8.3_*
           field-content  *_Section 5.5_*
           field-name  *_Section 5.1_*; Section 6.6.2
           field-value  *_Section 5.5_*
           field-vchar  *_Section 5.5_*
           first-pos  *_Section 14.1.1_*; Section 14.4
           hour  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           http-URI  *_Section 4.2.1_*
           https-URI  *_Section 4.2.2_*
           incl-range  *_Section 14.4_*
           int-range  *_Section 14.1.1_*
           language-range  *_Section 12.5.4_*
           language-tag  *_Section 8.5.1_*
           last-pos  *_Section 14.1.1_*; Section 14.4
           media-range  *_Section 12.5.1_*
           media-type  *_Section 8.3.1_*
           method  *_Section 9.1_*
           minute  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           month  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           obs-date  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           obs-text  *_Section 5.5_*
           opaque-tag  *_Section 8.8.3_*
           other-range  *_Section 14.1.1_*
           parameter  *_Section 5.6.6_*
           parameter-name  *_Section 5.6.6_*
           parameter-value  *_Section 5.6.6_*
           parameters  *_Section 5.6.6_*
           partial-URI  *_Section 4.1_*
           port  *_Section 4.1_*
           product  *_Section 10.1.5_*
           product-version  *_Section 10.1.5_*
           protocol-name  *_Section 7.6.3_*
           protocol-version  *_Section 7.6.3_*
           pseudonym  *_Section 7.6.3_*
           qdtext  *_Section 5.6.4_*
           query  *_Section 4.1_*
           quoted-pair  *_Section 5.6.4_*
           quoted-string  *_Section 5.6.4_*
           qvalue  *_Section 12.4.2_*
           range-resp  *_Section 14.4_*
           range-set  *_Section 14.1.1_*
           range-spec  *_Section 14.1.1_*
           range-unit  *_Section 14.1_*
           ranges-specifier  *_Section 14.1.1_*
           received-by  *_Section 7.6.3_*
           received-protocol  *_Section 7.6.3_*
           rfc850-date  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           second  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           segment  *_Section 4.1_*
           subtype  *_Section 8.3.1_*
           suffix-length  *_Section 14.1.1_*
           suffix-range  *_Section 14.1.1_*
           t-codings  *_Section 10.1.4_*
           tchar  *_Section 5.6.2_*
           time-of-day  *_Section 5.6.7_*
           token  *_Section 5.6.2_*
           token68  *_Section 11.2_*
           transfer-coding  *_Section 10.1.4_*
           transfer-parameter  *_Section 10.1.4_*
           type  *_Section 8.3.1_*
           unsatisfied-range  *_Section 14.4_*
           uri-host  *_Section 4.1_*
           weak  *_Section 8.8.3_*
           weight  *_Section 12.4.2_*
           year  *_Section 5.6.7_*
        gzip (Coding Format)  Section 8.4.1.3
        gzip (content coding)  *_Section 8.4.1_*

     H

        HEAD method  *_Section 9.3.2_*
        Header Fields
           Accept  *_Section 12.5.1_*
           Accept-Charset  *_Section 12.5.2_*
           Accept-Encoding  *_Section 12.5.3_*
           Accept-Language  *_Section 12.5.4_*
           Accept-Ranges  *_Section 14.3_*
           Allow  *_Section 10.2.1_*
           Authentication-Info  *_Section 11.6.3_*
           Authorization  *_Section 11.6.2_*
           Connection  *_Section 7.6.1_*
           Content-Encoding  *_Section 8.4_*
           Content-Language  *_Section 8.5_*
           Content-Length  *_Section 8.6_*
           Content-Location  *_Section 8.7_*
           Content-MD5  *_Section 18.4, Paragraph 10_*
           Content-Range  *_Section 14.4_*; Section 14.5
           Content-Type  *_Section 8.3_*
           Date  *_Section 6.6.1_*
           ETag  *_Section 8.8.3_*
           Expect  *_Section 10.1.1_*
           From  *_Section 10.1.2_*
           Host  *_Section 7.2_*
           If-Match  *_Section 13.1.1_*
           If-Modified-Since  *_Section 13.1.3_*
           If-None-Match  *_Section 13.1.2_*
           If-Range  *_Section 13.1.5_*
           If-Unmodified-Since  *_Section 13.1.4_*
           Last-Modified  *_Section 8.8.2_*
           Location  *_Section 10.2.2_*
           Max-Forwards  *_Section 7.6.2_*
           Proxy-Authenticate  *_Section 11.7.1_*
           Proxy-Authentication-Info  *_Section 11.7.3_*
           Proxy-Authorization  *_Section 11.7.2_*
           Range  *_Section 14.2_*
           Referer  *_Section 10.1.3_*
           Retry-After  *_Section 10.2.3_*
           Server  *_Section 10.2.4_*
           TE  *_Section 10.1.4_*
           Trailer  *_Section 6.6.2_*
           Upgrade  *_Section 7.8_*
           User-Agent  *_Section 10.1.5_*
           Vary  *_Section 12.5.5_*
           Via  *_Section 7.6.3_*
           WWW-Authenticate  *_Section 11.6.1_*
        header section  *_Section 6.3_*
        Host header field  *_Section 7.2_*
        http URI scheme  *_Section 4.2.1_*
        https URI scheme  *_Section 4.2.2_*

     I

        idempotent  *_Section 9.2.2_*
        If-Match header field  *_Section 13.1.1_*
        If-Modified-Since header field  *_Section 13.1.3_*
        If-None-Match header field  *_Section 13.1.2_*
        If-Range header field  *_Section 13.1.5_*
        If-Unmodified-Since header field  *_Section 13.1.4_*
        inbound  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 4_*
        incomplete  *_Section 6.1_*
        interception proxy  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 10_*
        intermediary  *_Section 3.7_*

     L

        Last-Modified header field  *_Section 8.8.2_*
        list-based field  Section 5.5, Paragraph 7
        Location header field  *_Section 10.2.2_*

     M

        Max-Forwards header field  *_Section 7.6.2_*
        Media Type
           multipart/byteranges  *_Section 14.6_*
           multipart/x-byteranges  Section 14.6, Paragraph 4, Item 3
        message  Section 3.4; *_Section 6_*
        message abstraction  *_Section 6_*
        messages  *_Section 3.4_*
        metadata  *_Section 8.8_*
        Method
           *  *_Section 18.2, Paragraph 3_*
           CONNECT  *_Section 9.3.6_*
           DELETE  *_Section 9.3.5_*
           GET  *_Section 9.3.1_*
           HEAD  *_Section 9.3.2_*
           OPTIONS  *_Section 9.3.7_*
           POST  *_Section 9.3.3_*
           PUT  *_Section 9.3.4_*
           TRACE  *_Section 9.3.8_*
        multipart/byteranges Media Type  *_Section 14.6_*
        multipart/x-byteranges Media Type  Section 14.6, Paragraph 4,
           Item 3

     N

        non-transforming proxy  *_Section 7.7_*

     O

        OPTIONS method  *_Section 9.3.7_*
        origin  *_Section 4.3.1_*; Section 11.5
        origin server  *_Section 3.6_*
        outbound  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 4_*

     P

        phishing  *_Section 17.1_*
        POST method  *_Section 9.3.3_*
        Protection Space  Section 11.5
        proxy  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 5_*
        Proxy-Authenticate header field  *_Section 11.7.1_*
        Proxy-Authentication-Info header field  *_Section 11.7.3_*
        Proxy-Authorization header field  *_Section 11.7.2_*
        PUT method  *_Section 9.3.4_*

     R

        Range header field  *_Section 14.2_*
        Realm  Section 11.5
        recipient  *_Section 3.4_*
        Referer header field  *_Section 10.1.3_*
        representation  *_Section 3.2_*
        request  *_Section 3.4_*
        request target  *_Section 7.1_*
        resource  *_Section 3.1_*; Section 4
        response  *_Section 3.4_*
        Retry-After header field  *_Section 10.2.3_*
        reverse proxy  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 6_*

     S

        safe  *_Section 9.2.1_*
        satisfiable range  *_Section 14.1.1_*
        secured  *_Section 4.2.2_*
        selected representation  *_Section 3.2, Paragraph 4_*;
           Section 8.8; Section 13.1
        self-descriptive  *_Section 6_*
        sender  *_Section 3.4_*
        server  *_Section 3.3_*
        Server header field  *_Section 10.2.4_*
        singleton field  Section 5.5, Paragraph 6
        spider  *_Section 3.5_*
        Status Code  Section 15
        Status Codes
           Final  Section 15, Paragraph 7
           Informational  Section 15, Paragraph 7
           Interim  Section 15, Paragraph 7
        Status Codes Classes
           1xx Informational  *_Section 15.2_*
           2xx Successful  *_Section 15.3_*
           3xx Redirection  *_Section 15.4_*
           4xx Client Error  *_Section 15.5_*
           5xx Server Error  *_Section 15.6_*

     T

        target resource  *_Section 7.1_*
        target URI  *_Section 7.1_*
        TE header field  *_Section 10.1.4_*
        TRACE method  *_Section 9.3.8_*
        Trailer Fields  *_Section 6.5_*
           ETag  *_Section 8.8.3_*
        Trailer header field  *_Section 6.6.2_*
        trailer section  *_Section 6.5_*
        trailers  *_Section 6.5_*
        transforming proxy  *_Section 7.7_*
        transparent proxy  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 10_*
        tunnel  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 8_*

     U

        unsatisfiable range  *_Section 14.1.1_*
        Upgrade header field  *_Section 7.8_*
        upstream  *_Section 3.7, Paragraph 4_*
        URI  *_Section 4_*
           origin  *_Section 4.3.1_*
        URI reference  *_Section 4.1_*
        URI scheme
           http  *_Section 4.2.1_*
           https  *_Section 4.2.2_*
        user agent  *_Section 3.5_*
        User-Agent header field  *_Section 10.1.5_*

     V

        validator  *_Section 8.8_*
           strong  *_Section 8.8.1_*
           weak  *_Section 8.8.1_*
        Vary header field  *_Section 12.5.5_*
        Via header field  *_Section 7.6.3_*

     W

        WWW-Authenticate header field  *_Section 11.6.1_*

     X

        x-compress (content coding)  *_Section 8.4.1_*
        x-gzip (content coding)  *_Section 8.4.1_*

Authors' Addresses

  Roy T. Fielding (editor)
  Adobe
  345 Park Ave
  San Jose, CA 95110
  United States of America
  Email: [email protected]
  URI:   https://roy.gbiv.com/


  Mark Nottingham (editor)
  Fastly
  Prahran
  Australia
  Email: [email protected]
  URI:   https://www.mnot.net/


  Julian Reschke (editor)
  greenbytes GmbH
  Hafenweg 16
  48155 Münster
  Germany
  Email: [email protected]
  URI:   https://greenbytes.de/tech/webdav/